]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/gnus.texi
Specify info encoding and language.
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @include gnus-overrides.texi
4
5 @setfilename ../../info/gnus
6 @settitle Gnus Manual
7 @syncodeindex fn cp
8 @syncodeindex vr cp
9 @syncodeindex pg cp
10
11 @documentencoding UTF-8
12 @documentlanguage en
13
14 @copying
15 Copyright @copyright{} 1995--2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
16
17 @quotation
18 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
19 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
20 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
21 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
22 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
23 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
24
25 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
26 modify this GNU manual.''
27 @end quotation
28 @end copying
29
30 @iftex
31 @iflatex
32 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
33 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
34 \usepackage{pagestyle}
35 \usepackage{epsfig}
36 \usepackage{pixidx}
37 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
38
39 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
40 \else
41 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
42 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
43 \pdfcompresslevel=9
44 \fi
45
46 \makeindex
47 \begin{document}
48
49 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
50 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
51 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
52 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
53
54 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
55
56 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
57 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
58 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
59 \else
60 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
61 \fi
62 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
63 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
64
65 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
75 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
78 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
79 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
80 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
81 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
85 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
92
93 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
95 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
96 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
97 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
98 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
99 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
100 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
101 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
104 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
106
107 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
109 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
110 }
111
112 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
113
114 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
115 {\mbox{}}
116 }
117
118 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
119 \gnusdimen 0pt
120
121 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
122 \gnuscleardoublepage
123 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
124 \chapter{#2}
125 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
126 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
127 \thispagestyle{empty}
128 \hspace*{-2cm}
129 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
130 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
131 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
132 \end{picture}
133 \clearpage
134 }
135
136 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
137 \begin{figure}
138 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
139 #3
140 \end{picture}
141 \caption{#1}
142 \end{figure}
143 }
144
145 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
146 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
147 }
148
149 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
150 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
151 }
152
153 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
154 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
155 }
156
157 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
158 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
159 }
160
161 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
162
163 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
164 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
165 \section{#1}
166 }
167
168 \newenvironment{codelist}%
169 {\begin{list}{}{
170 }
171 }{\end{list}}
172
173 \newenvironment{asislist}%
174 {\begin{list}{}{
175 }
176 }{\end{list}}
177
178 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
179 {\begin{list}{}{
180 \labelwidth=0cm
181 }
182 }{\end{list}}
183
184 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
185 {\begin{list}{}{
186 }
187 }{\end{list}}
188
189 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
190 {\begin{list}{}{
191 }
192 }{\end{list}}
193
194 \newenvironment{samplist}%
195 {\begin{list}{}{
196 }
197 }{\end{list}}
198
199 \newenvironment{varlist}%
200 {\begin{list}{}{
201 }
202 }{\end{list}}
203
204 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
205 {\begin{list}{}{
206 }
207 }{\end{list}}
208
209 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
210 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
211 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
212
213 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
214 {
215 {
216 \ifodd\count0
217 {
218 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
219 }
220 \else
221 {
222 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
223 }
224 }
225 \fi
226 }
227 }
228 {
229 \ifodd\count0
230 \mbox{} \hfill
231 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
232 \else
233 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
234 \hfill \mbox{}
235 \fi
236 }
237
238 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
239 {
240 {
241 \ifodd\count0
242 {
243 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
244 }
245 \else
246 {
247 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
248 }
249 \fi
250 }
251 }
252 {
253 \ifodd\count0
254 \mbox{} \hfill
255 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
256 \else
257 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
258 \hfill \mbox{}
259 \fi
260 }
261
262 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
263 {
264 {
265 \ifodd\count0
266 {
267 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
268 }
269 \else
270 {
271 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
272 }
273 \fi
274 }
275 }
276 {
277 \ifodd\count0
278 \mbox{} \hfill
279 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
280 \else
281 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
282 \hfill \mbox{}
283 \fi
284 }
285
286 \pagenumbering{roman}
287 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
288
289 @end iflatex
290 @end iftex
291
292 @iftex
293 @iflatex
294
295 \begin{titlepage}
296 {
297
298 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
299 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
300 \parindent=0cm
301 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
302
303 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
304 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
305 \vfill
306 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
307 \vfill
308 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
309 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
310 \newpage
311 }
312
313 \mbox{}
314 \vfill
315
316 \thispagestyle{empty}
317
318 @c @insertcopying
319 \newpage
320 \end{titlepage}
321 @end iflatex
322 @end iftex
323
324 @dircategory Emacs network features
325 @direntry
326 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
327 @end direntry
328 @iftex
329 @finalout
330 @end iftex
331
332
333 @titlepage
334 @ifset WEBHACKDEVEL
335 @title Gnus Manual (DEVELOPMENT VERSION)
336 @end ifset
337 @ifclear WEBHACKDEVEL
338 @title Gnus Manual
339 @end ifclear
340
341 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
342 @page
343 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
344 @insertcopying
345 @end titlepage
346
347 @summarycontents
348 @contents
349
350 @node Top
351 @top The Gnus Newsreader
352
353 @ifinfo
354
355 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
356 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
357 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
358 luck.
359
360 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
361 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
362
363 @ifnottex
364 @insertcopying
365 @end ifnottex
366
367 @end ifinfo
368
369 @iftex
370
371 @iflatex
372 \tableofcontents
373 \gnuscleardoublepage
374 @end iflatex
375
376 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
377 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
378
379 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
380 being accused of plagiarism:
381
382 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
383 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
384 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
385 can even read news with it!
386
387 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
388 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
389 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
390 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
391 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
392 the program.
393
394 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
395 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
396
397 @heading Other related manuals
398 @itemize
399 @item Message manual: Composing messages
400 @item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
401 @item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
402 @item EasyPG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
403 @item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
404 @end itemize
405
406 @end iftex
407
408 @menu
409 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
410 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
411 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
412 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
413 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
414 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
415 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
416 * Searching:: Mail and News search engines.
417 * Various:: General purpose settings.
418 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
419 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
420 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
421 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
422 * Key Index:: Key Index.
423
424 @c Doesn't work right in html.
425 @c FIXME Do this in a more standard way.
426 @ifinfo
427 Other related manuals
428
429 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
430 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
431 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
432 * EasyPG:(epa). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
433 * SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
434 @end ifinfo
435
436 @detailmenu
437 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
438
439 Starting Gnus
440
441 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
442 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
443 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
444 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
445 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
446 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
447 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
448 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
449 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
450 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
451
452 New Groups
453
454 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
455 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
456 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
457
458 Group Buffer
459
460 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
461 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
462 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
463 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
464 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
465 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
466 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
467 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
468 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
469 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
470 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
471 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
472 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
473 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
474 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
475 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
476 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
477 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
478
479 Group Buffer Format
480
481 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
482 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
483 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
484
485 Group Topics
486
487 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
488 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
489 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
490 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
491 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
492
493 Misc Group Stuff
494
495 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
496 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
497 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
498 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
499 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
500
501 Summary Buffer
502
503 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
504 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
505 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
506 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
507 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
508 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
509 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
510 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
511 * Threading:: How threads are made.
512 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
513 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
514 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
515 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
516 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
517 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
518 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
519 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
520 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
521 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
522 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
523 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
524 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
525 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
526 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
527 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
528 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
529 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
530 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
531 or reselecting the current group.
532 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
533 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
534 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
535 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
536
537 Summary Buffer Format
538
539 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
540 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
541 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
542 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
543
544 Choosing Articles
545
546 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
547 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
548
549 Reply, Followup and Post
550
551 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
552 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
553 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
554 * Canceling and Superseding::
555
556 Marking Articles
557
558 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
559 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
560 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
561 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
562 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
563 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
564
565 Threading
566
567 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
568 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
569
570 Customizing Threading
571
572 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
573 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
574 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
575 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
576
577 Decoding Articles
578
579 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
580 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
581 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
582 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
583 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
584 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
585
586 Decoding Variables
587
588 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
589 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
590 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
591
592 Article Treatment
593
594 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
595 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
596 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
597 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
598 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
599 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
600 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
601 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
602 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys, Gravatars
603 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
604 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
605
606 Alternative Approaches
607
608 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
609 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
610
611 Various Summary Stuff
612
613 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
614 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
615 * Summary Generation Commands::
616 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
617
618 Article Buffer
619
620 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
621 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
622 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
623 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
624 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
625
626 Composing Messages
627
628 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
629 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
630 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
631 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
632 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
633 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
634 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
635 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
636 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
637
638 Select Methods
639
640 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
641 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
642 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
643 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
644 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
645 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
646 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
647 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
648 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
649
650 Server Buffer
651
652 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
653 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
654 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
655 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
656 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
657 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
658 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
659
660 Getting News
661
662 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
663 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
664
665 @acronym{NNTP}
666
667 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
668 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
669 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
670
671 Getting Mail
672
673 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
674 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
675 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
676 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
677 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
678 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
679 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
680 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
681 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
682 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
683 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
684 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
685 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
686
687 Mail Sources
688
689 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
690 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
691 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
692
693 Choosing a Mail Back End
694
695 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
696 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
697 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
698 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
699 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
700 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
701 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
702
703 Browsing the Web
704
705 * Archiving Mail::
706 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
707 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
708 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
709
710 Other Sources
711
712 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
713 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
714 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
715 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
716 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
717
718 Document Groups
719
720 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
721
722 Combined Groups
723
724 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
725
726 Email Based Diary
727
728 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
729 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
730 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
731
732 The NNDiary Back End
733
734 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
735 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
736 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
737
738 The Gnus Diary Library
739
740 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
741 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
742 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
743 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
744
745 Gnus Unplugged
746
747 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
748 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
749 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
750 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
751 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
752 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
753 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
754 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
755 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
756 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
757 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
758 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
759 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
760 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
761
762 Agent Categories
763
764 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
765 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
766 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
767
768 Agent Commands
769
770 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
771 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
772 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
773
774 Scoring
775
776 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
777 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
778 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
779 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
780 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
781 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
782 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
783 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
784 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
785 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
786 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
787 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
788 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
789 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
790 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
791 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
792
793 Advanced Scoring
794
795 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
796 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
797 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
798
799 Searching
800
801 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
802 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
803
804 nnir
805
806 * What is nnir?:: What does nnir do.
807 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
808 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up nnir.
809
810 Setting up nnir
811
812 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
813
814 Various
815
816 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
817 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
818 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
819 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
820 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
821 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
822 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
823 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
824 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
825 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
826 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
827 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
828 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
829 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
830 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
831 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
832 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
833 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
834 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
835
836 Formatting Variables
837
838 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
839 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
840 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
841 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
842 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
843 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
844 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
845 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
846
847 Image Enhancements
848
849 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
850 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
851 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
852 meant to be shown.
853 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
854 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
855 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
856
857 Thwarting Email Spam
858
859 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
860 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
861 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
862 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
863
864 Spam Package
865
866 * Spam Package Introduction::
867 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
868 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
869 * Spam and Ham Processors::
870 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
871 * Spam Back Ends::
872 * Extending the Spam package::
873 * Spam Statistics Package::
874
875 Spam Statistics Package
876
877 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
878 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
879 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
880
881 Appendices
882
883 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
884 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
885 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
886 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
887 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
888 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
889 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
890 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
891 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
892
893 History
894
895 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
896 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
897 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
898 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
899 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
900 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
901 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
902 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
903
904 New Features
905
906 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
907 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
908 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
909 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
910 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
911 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
912 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13
913 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
914
915 Customization
916
917 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
918 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
919 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
920 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
921
922 Gnus Reference Guide
923
924 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
925 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
926 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
927 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
928 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
929 * Group Info:: The group info format.
930 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
931 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
932 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
933
934 Back End Interface
935
936 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
937 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
938 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
939 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
940 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
941 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
942
943 Various File Formats
944
945 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
946 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
947
948 Emacs for Heathens
949
950 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
951 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
952
953 @end detailmenu
954 @end menu
955
956 @node Starting Up
957 @chapter Starting Gnus
958 @cindex starting up
959
960 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
961 Heathens} first.
962
963 @kindex M-x gnus
964 @findex gnus
965 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
966 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
967 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
968 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
969 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
970 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
971
972 @findex gnus-other-frame
973 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
974 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
975 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
976
977 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
978 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
979 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
980
981 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
982 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
983
984 @menu
985 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
986 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
987 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
988 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
989 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
990 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
991 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
992 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
993 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
994 @end menu
995
996
997 @node Finding the News
998 @section Finding the News
999 @cindex finding news
1000
1001 First of all, you should know that there is a special buffer called
1002 @code{*Server*} that lists all the servers Gnus knows about. You can
1003 press @kbd{^} from the Group buffer to see it. In the Server buffer,
1004 you can press @kbd{RET} on a defined server to see all the groups it
1005 serves (subscribed or not!). You can also add or delete servers, edit
1006 a foreign server's definition, agentize or de-agentize a server, and
1007 do many other neat things. @xref{Server Buffer}.
1008 @xref{Foreign Groups}. @xref{Agent Basics}.
1009
1010 @vindex gnus-select-method
1011 @c @head
1012 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1013 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1014 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1015 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1016 secondary or foreign groups.
1017
1018 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1019 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1020
1021 @lisp
1022 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1023 @end lisp
1024
1025 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1026
1027 @lisp
1028 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1029 @end lisp
1030
1031 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1032 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1033 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1034 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1035
1036 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1037 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1038 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1039 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1040 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1041 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1042 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1043 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1044 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1045
1046 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1047 @kindex B (Group)
1048 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1049 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1050 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1051 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1052 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1053 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1054
1055 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1056 @c @head
1057 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1058 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1059 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1060 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1061 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1062 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1063 groups are.
1064
1065 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1066 you would typically set this variable to
1067
1068 @lisp
1069 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1070 @end lisp
1071
1072
1073
1074 @node The Server is Down
1075 @section The Server is Down
1076 @cindex server errors
1077
1078 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1079 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1080 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1081
1082 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1083 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1084 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1085 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1086 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1087 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1088 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1089
1090 @findex gnus-no-server
1091 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1092 @c @head
1093 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1094 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1095 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1096 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1097 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1098 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1099 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1100
1101
1102 @node Slave Gnusae
1103 @section Slave Gnusae
1104 @cindex slave
1105
1106 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1107 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1108 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1109 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1110
1111 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1112 @file{.newsrc} file.
1113
1114 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1115 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1116 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1117 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1118 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1119 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1120 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1121
1122 @findex gnus-slave
1123 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1124 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1125 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1126 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1127 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1128 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1129 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1130 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1131
1132 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1133 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1134
1135 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1136 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1137 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1138 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1139 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1140
1141
1142
1143 @node New Groups
1144 @section New Groups
1145 @cindex new groups
1146 @cindex subscription
1147
1148 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1149 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1150 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1151 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1152 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1153 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1154 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1155 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1156 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1157
1158 @menu
1159 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1160 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1161 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1162 @end menu
1163
1164
1165 @node Checking New Groups
1166 @subsection Checking New Groups
1167
1168 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing
1169 the list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of
1170 subscribed and dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method.
1171 If @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will
1172 ask the server for new groups since the last time. This is both
1173 faster and cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list
1174 of killed groups (@pxref{Group Levels}) altogether, so you may set
1175 @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to @code{nil}, which will save time both
1176 at startup, at exit, and all over. Saves disk space, too. Why isn't
1177 this the default, then? Unfortunately, not all servers support this
1178 command.
1179
1180 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1181 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1182 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1183 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1184 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1185 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1186 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1187 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1188 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1189 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1190 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1191
1192 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1193 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1194 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1195 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1196 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1197 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1198
1199
1200 @node Subscription Methods
1201 @subsection Subscription Methods
1202
1203 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1204 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1205 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1206
1207 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1208 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1209
1210 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1211
1212 @table @code
1213
1214 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1215 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1216 Make all new groups zombies (@pxref{Group Levels}). This is the
1217 default. You can browse the zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either
1218 kill them all off properly (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them
1219 (with @kbd{u}).
1220
1221 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1222 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1223 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1224 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1225
1226 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1227 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1228 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1229
1230 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1231 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1232 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1233 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1234 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1235 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1236 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1237 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1238 up. Or something like that.
1239
1240 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1241 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1242 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1243 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1244 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1245
1246 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1247 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1248 Kill all new groups.
1249
1250 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1251 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1252 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1253 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1254 topic parameter that looks like
1255
1256 @example
1257 "nnml"
1258 @end example
1259
1260 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1261 that topic.
1262
1263 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1264 top-level topic.
1265
1266 @end table
1267
1268 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1269 A closely related variable is
1270 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1271 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1272 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1273 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1274 hierarchy or not.
1275
1276 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1277 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1278 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1279 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1280
1281
1282 @node Filtering New Groups
1283 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1284
1285 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1286 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1287 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1288
1289 @example
1290 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1291 @end example
1292
1293 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1294 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1295 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1296 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1297 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1298 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1299 subscribing these groups.
1300 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1301 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1302
1303 The ``options -n'' format is very simplistic. The syntax above is all
1304 that is supports: you can force-subscribe hierarchies, or you can
1305 deny hierarchies, and that's it.
1306
1307 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1308 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1309 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1310 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1311 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1312 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1313 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1314 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1315
1316 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1317 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1318 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1319 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1320 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1321 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1322 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1323 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1324 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, @code{nnimap}, and
1325 @code{nnmaildir}) subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this
1326 variable to @code{nil}.
1327
1328 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-categories
1329 As if that wasn't enough, @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-categories} also
1330 allows you to specify that new groups should be subscribed based on the
1331 category their select methods belong to. The default is @samp{(mail
1332 post-mail)}, meaning that all new groups from mail-like backends
1333 should be subscribed automatically.
1334
1335 New groups that match these variables are subscribed using
1336 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1337
1338
1339 @node Changing Servers
1340 @section Changing Servers
1341 @cindex changing servers
1342
1343 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1344 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1345 very flaky and you want to use another.
1346
1347 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1348 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1349
1350 @emph{Wrong!}
1351
1352 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1353 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1354 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1355 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1356 worthless.
1357
1358 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1359 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1360 You can use the @kbd{M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups}
1361 command to clear out all data that you have on your native groups.
1362 Use with caution.
1363
1364 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1365 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1366 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1367 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1368
1369 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1370 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1371 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1372 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1373 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1374 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1375 cache for all groups).
1376
1377
1378 @node Startup Files
1379 @section Startup Files
1380 @cindex startup files
1381 @cindex .newsrc
1382 @cindex .newsrc.el
1383 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1384
1385 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1386 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1387 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1388 read.
1389
1390 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1391 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1392 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1393 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1394 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1395 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1396 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1397
1398 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1399 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1400 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1401 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1402 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1403 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1404
1405 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1406 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1407 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1408 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1409 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1410 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1411 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1412 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1413 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1414 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1415 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1416 news reader.
1417
1418 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1419 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1420 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1421 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1422 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1423 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1424 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1425 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1426 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1427 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1428 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1429 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1430
1431 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1432 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1433 @vindex version-control
1434 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1435 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1436 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1437 If you want to keep multiple numbered backups of this file, set
1438 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1439 @code{version-control} variable.
1440
1441 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1442 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1443 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1444 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1445 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1446 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1447 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1448 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1449 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1450 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1451
1452 @lisp
1453 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1454 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1455
1456 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1457 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1458 @end lisp
1459
1460 @vindex gnus-init-file
1461 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1462 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1463 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1464 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1465 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1466 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1467 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1468 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1469 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1470 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1471 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1472 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1473 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1474
1475
1476 @node Auto Save
1477 @section Auto Save
1478 @cindex dribble file
1479 @cindex auto-save
1480
1481 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1482 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1483 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1484 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1485 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1486 this file.
1487
1488 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1489 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1490 saved.
1491
1492 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1493 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1494 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1495
1496 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1497 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1498 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1499 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1500 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1501 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1502
1503 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1504 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1505 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1506
1507
1508 @node The Active File
1509 @section The Active File
1510 @cindex active file
1511 @cindex ignored groups
1512
1513 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1514 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1515 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1516
1517 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1518 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1519 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1520 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1521 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1522 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1523 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1524
1525 @c This variable is
1526 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1527 @c if you set it to anything else.
1528
1529 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1530 @c @head
1531 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1532 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1533 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1534
1535 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1536 you actually subscribe to.
1537
1538 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1539 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1540 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1541 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1542
1543 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1544 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1545 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1546 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1547 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1548 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1549
1550 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1551 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1552 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1553 variable.
1554
1555 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1556 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1557 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1558 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1559 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1560 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1561
1562 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1563 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1564
1565 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1566 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1567
1568 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1569 secondary select methods.
1570
1571
1572 @node Startup Variables
1573 @section Startup Variables
1574
1575 @table @code
1576
1577 @item gnus-load-hook
1578 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1579 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1580 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1581 times you start Gnus.
1582
1583 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1584 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1585 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
1586
1587 @item gnus-before-resume-hook
1588 @vindex gnus-before-resume-hook
1589 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is resumed after a suspend.
1590
1591 @item gnus-startup-hook
1592 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1593 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1594
1595 @item gnus-started-hook
1596 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1597 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1598 successfully.
1599
1600 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1601 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1602 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1603 generating the group buffer.
1604
1605 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1606 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1607 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1608 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1609 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1610 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1611 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1612 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1613
1614 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1615 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1616 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1617 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1618 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1619 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1620
1621 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1622 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1623 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1624
1625 @item gnus-use-backend-marks
1626 @vindex gnus-use-backend-marks
1627 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will store article marks both in the
1628 @file{.newsrc.eld} file and in the backends. This will slow down
1629 group operation some.
1630
1631 @end table
1632
1633
1634 @node Group Buffer
1635 @chapter Group Buffer
1636 @cindex group buffer
1637
1638 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1639 @c
1640 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1641 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1642 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1643 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1644 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1645 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1646 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1647 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1648 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1649 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1650 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1651 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1652 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1653 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1654 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1655 @c human rights at 9...
1656
1657
1658 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1659 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1660 long as Gnus is active.
1661
1662 @iftex
1663 @iflatex
1664 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1665 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1666 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1667 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1668 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1669 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1670 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1671 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1672 }
1673 @end iflatex
1674 @end iftex
1675
1676 @menu
1677 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1678 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1679 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1680 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1681 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1682 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1683 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1684 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1685 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1686 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1687 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1688 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1689 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1690 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1691 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1692 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1693 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
1694 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1695 @end menu
1696
1697
1698 @node Group Buffer Format
1699 @section Group Buffer Format
1700
1701 @menu
1702 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1703 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1704 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1705 @end menu
1706
1707 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1708 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1709 available in Emacs.
1710
1711 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1712 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1713 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1714 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1715 Emacs version.
1716
1717 @node Group Line Specification
1718 @subsection Group Line Specification
1719 @cindex group buffer format
1720
1721 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1722 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1723
1724 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1725
1726 @example
1727 25: news.announce.newusers
1728 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1729 @end example
1730
1731 Quite simple, huh?
1732
1733 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1734 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1735 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1736 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1737
1738 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1739 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1740 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1741 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1742 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C@.
1743 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1744
1745 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1746
1747 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1748 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1749 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1750 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1751 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1752
1753 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1754 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1755 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1756
1757 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1758
1759 @table @samp
1760
1761 @item M
1762 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1763
1764 @item S
1765 Whether the group is subscribed.
1766
1767 @item L
1768 Level of subscribedness.
1769
1770 @item N
1771 Number of unread articles.
1772
1773 @item I
1774 Number of dormant articles.
1775
1776 @item T
1777 Number of ticked articles.
1778
1779 @item R
1780 Number of read articles.
1781
1782 @item U
1783 Number of unseen articles.
1784
1785 @item t
1786 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1787 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1788
1789 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1790 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1791 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1792 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1793 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1794 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1795 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1796
1797 The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1798 compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1799 renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1800 getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1801 future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1802 date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1803 server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
1804
1805 @item y
1806 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1807
1808 @item i
1809 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1810
1811 @item g
1812 Full group name.
1813
1814 @item G
1815 Group name.
1816
1817 @item C
1818 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1819 comment element in the group parameters.
1820
1821 @item D
1822 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1823 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1824 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1825 command.
1826
1827 @item o
1828 @samp{m} if moderated.
1829
1830 @item O
1831 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1832
1833 @item s
1834 Select method.
1835
1836 @item B
1837 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1838
1839 @item n
1840 Select from where.
1841
1842 @item z
1843 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1844 used.
1845
1846 @item P
1847 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1848
1849 @item c
1850 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1851 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1852 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1853 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1854 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1855
1856 @item m
1857 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1858 @cindex %
1859 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1860 the group lately.
1861
1862 @item p
1863 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1864
1865 @item d
1866 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1867 Timestamp}).
1868
1869 @item F
1870 The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1871 agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1872 megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1873 of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1874
1875 @item u
1876 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1877 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1878 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1879 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1880 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1881 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1882 specifier.
1883 @end table
1884
1885 @cindex *
1886 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1887 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1888 group, or a bogus native group.
1889
1890
1891 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1892 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1893 @cindex group mode line
1894
1895 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1896 The mode line can be changed by setting
1897 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1898 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1899
1900 @table @samp
1901 @item S
1902 The native news server.
1903 @item M
1904 The native select method.
1905 @end table
1906
1907
1908 @node Group Highlighting
1909 @subsection Group Highlighting
1910 @cindex highlighting
1911 @cindex group highlighting
1912
1913 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1914 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1915 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1916 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1917 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1918
1919 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1920 background is dark:
1921
1922 @lisp
1923 (cond (window-system
1924 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1925 (defface my-group-face-1
1926 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1927 (defface my-group-face-2
1928 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1929 "Second group face")
1930 (defface my-group-face-3
1931 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1932 (defface my-group-face-4
1933 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1934 (defface my-group-face-5
1935 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1936
1937 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1938 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1939 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1940 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1941 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1942 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1943 @end lisp
1944
1945 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1946
1947 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1948 include:
1949
1950 @table @code
1951 @item group
1952 The group name.
1953 @item unread
1954 The number of unread articles in the group.
1955 @item method
1956 The select method.
1957 @item mailp
1958 Whether the group is a mail group.
1959 @item level
1960 The level of the group.
1961 @item score
1962 The score of the group.
1963 @item ticked
1964 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1965 @item total
1966 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1967 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1968 @item topic
1969 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1970 topic being inserted.
1971 @end table
1972
1973 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1974 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1975 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1976
1977 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1978 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1979 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1980 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
1981
1982
1983 @node Group Maneuvering
1984 @section Group Maneuvering
1985 @cindex group movement
1986
1987 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1988 expected, hopefully.
1989
1990 @table @kbd
1991
1992 @item n
1993 @kindex n (Group)
1994 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1995 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1996 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1997
1998 @item p
1999 @itemx DEL
2000 @kindex DEL (Group)
2001 @kindex p (Group)
2002 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2003 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2004 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2005
2006 @item N
2007 @kindex N (Group)
2008 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2009 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2010
2011 @item P
2012 @kindex P (Group)
2013 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2014 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2015
2016 @item M-n
2017 @kindex M-n (Group)
2018 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2019 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2020 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2021
2022 @item M-p
2023 @kindex M-p (Group)
2024 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2025 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2026 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2027 @end table
2028
2029 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2030
2031 @table @kbd
2032
2033 @item j
2034 @kindex j (Group)
2035 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2036 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2037 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2038 like living groups.
2039
2040 @item ,
2041 @kindex , (Group)
2042 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2043 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2044 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2045
2046 @item .
2047 @kindex . (Group)
2048 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2049 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2050 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2051 @end table
2052
2053 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2054 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2055 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2056 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2057 is @code{t}.
2058
2059 @vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2060 If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2061 exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2062 Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2063 @code{t}.
2064
2065 @node Selecting a Group
2066 @section Selecting a Group
2067 @cindex group selection
2068
2069 @table @kbd
2070
2071 @item SPACE
2072 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2073 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2074 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2075 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2076 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2077 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2078 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2079 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2080 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2081 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2082
2083 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2084 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2085 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2086
2087 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2088 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2089 ones.
2090
2091 @item RET
2092 @kindex RET (Group)
2093 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2094 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2095 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2096 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2097 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2098 entry.
2099
2100 @item M-RET
2101 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2102 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2103 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2104 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2105 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2106 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2107 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2108 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2109 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2110 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2111
2112 @item M-SPACE
2113 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2114 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2115 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2116 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2117 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2118
2119 @item C-M-RET
2120 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2121 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2122 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2123 doing any processing of its contents
2124 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2125 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2126 manner will have no permanent effects.
2127
2128 @end table
2129
2130 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2131 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2132 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2133 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2134 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2135 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2136 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2137 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2138 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2139 most recently will be fetched.
2140
2141 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2142 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2143 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2144 newsgroups.
2145
2146 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2147 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2148 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2149 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2150 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2151 are actually only the articles 1--10 and 29999900--30000000, Gnus doesn't
2152 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2153 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2154 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2155 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2156 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2157 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2158 get only the articles 29990001--30000000 (if the latest article number is
2159 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2160 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2161 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2162 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2163
2164 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2165 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2166 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2167 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2168 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2169 Which article this is controlled by the
2170 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2171 variable are:
2172
2173 @table @code
2174
2175 @item unread
2176 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2177
2178 @item first
2179 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2180
2181 @item unseen
2182 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2183
2184 @item unseen-or-unread
2185 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2186 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2187 unread article.
2188
2189 @item best
2190 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2191
2192 @end table
2193
2194 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2195 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2196
2197 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2198 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2199 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2200 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2201 selected.
2202
2203
2204 @node Subscription Commands
2205 @section Subscription Commands
2206 @cindex subscription
2207
2208 The following commands allow for managing your subscriptions in the
2209 Group buffer. If you want to subscribe to many groups, it's probably
2210 more convenient to go to the @ref{Server Buffer}, and choose the
2211 server there using @kbd{RET} or @kbd{SPC}. Then you'll have the
2212 commands listed in @ref{Browse Foreign Server} at hand.
2213
2214 @table @kbd
2215
2216 @item S t
2217 @itemx u
2218 @kindex S t (Group)
2219 @kindex u (Group)
2220 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2221 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2222 Toggle subscription to the current group
2223 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2224
2225 @item S s
2226 @itemx U
2227 @kindex S s (Group)
2228 @kindex U (Group)
2229 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2230 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2231 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2232 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2233
2234 @item S k
2235 @itemx C-k
2236 @kindex S k (Group)
2237 @kindex C-k (Group)
2238 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2239 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2240 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2241
2242 @item S y
2243 @itemx C-y
2244 @kindex S y (Group)
2245 @kindex C-y (Group)
2246 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2247 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2248
2249 @item C-x C-t
2250 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2251 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2252 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2253 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2254 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2255
2256 @item S w
2257 @itemx C-w
2258 @kindex S w (Group)
2259 @kindex C-w (Group)
2260 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2261 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2262
2263 @item S z
2264 @kindex S z (Group)
2265 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2266 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2267
2268 @item S C-k
2269 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2270 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2271 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2272 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2273 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2274 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2275 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2276 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2277 @file{.newsrc} file.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2282
2283
2284 @node Group Data
2285 @section Group Data
2286
2287 @table @kbd
2288
2289 @item c
2290 @kindex c (Group)
2291 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2292 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2293 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2294 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2295 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2296 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2297 the group buffer.
2298
2299 @item C
2300 @kindex C (Group)
2301 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2302 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2303 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2304
2305 @item M-c
2306 @kindex M-c (Group)
2307 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2308 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2309 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2310
2311 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2312 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2313 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2314 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2315 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2316 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2317 caution.
2318
2319 @end table
2320
2321
2322 @node Group Levels
2323 @section Group Levels
2324 @cindex group level
2325 @cindex level
2326
2327 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2328 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2329 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2330 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2331 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2332
2333 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2334
2335 @table @kbd
2336
2337 @item S l
2338 @kindex S l (Group)
2339 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2340 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2341 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2342 prompted for a level.
2343 @end table
2344
2345 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2346 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2347 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2348 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2349 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2350 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2351 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2352 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2353 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2354 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2355 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2356 same, but zombie and killed groups store no information on what articles
2357 you have read, etc. This distinction between dead and living
2358 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2359 reasons of efficiency.
2360
2361 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2362 low levels (e.g., 1 or 2).
2363
2364 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2365 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2366 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2367 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2368 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2369 groups are hidden, in a way.
2370
2371 @cindex zombie groups
2372 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2373 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2374 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2375 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2376 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2377 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2378
2379 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2380 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2381 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2382 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2383 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2384 list of killed groups.)
2385
2386 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2387 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2388 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2389
2390 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2391 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2392 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2393 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2394 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2395 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2396 relevant valid ranges.
2397
2398 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2399 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2400 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2401 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2402 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2403 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2404 rest.
2405
2406 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2407 one with the best level.
2408
2409 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2410 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2411 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2412 by default.
2413 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2414 be called and the result will be used as value.
2415
2416
2417 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2418 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2419 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2420 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2421 listed.
2422
2423 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2424 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2425 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2426 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2427
2428 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2429 Gnus will normally just activate (i.e., query the server about) groups
2430 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2431 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2432 to 5. The default is 6.
2433
2434
2435 @node Group Score
2436 @section Group Score
2437 @cindex group score
2438 @cindex group rank
2439 @cindex rank
2440
2441 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2442 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2443 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2444 reason?
2445
2446 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2447 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2448 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2449 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2450 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2451 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2452 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2453 least significant part.))
2454
2455 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2456 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2457 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2458 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2459 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2460 action after each summary exit, you can add
2461 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2462 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2463 slow things down somewhat.
2464
2465
2466 @node Marking Groups
2467 @section Marking Groups
2468 @cindex marking groups
2469
2470 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2471 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2472 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2473 bidding on those groups.
2474
2475 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2476 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2477 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2478
2479 @table @kbd
2480
2481 @item #
2482 @kindex # (Group)
2483 @itemx M m
2484 @kindex M m (Group)
2485 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2486 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2487
2488 @item M-#
2489 @kindex M-# (Group)
2490 @itemx M u
2491 @kindex M u (Group)
2492 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2493 Remove the mark from the current group
2494 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2495
2496 @item M U
2497 @kindex M U (Group)
2498 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2499 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2500
2501 @item M w
2502 @kindex M w (Group)
2503 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2504 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2505
2506 @item M b
2507 @kindex M b (Group)
2508 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2509 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2510
2511 @item M r
2512 @kindex M r (Group)
2513 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2514 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2515 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2516 @end table
2517
2518 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2519
2520 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2521 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2522 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2523 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2524 the command to be executed.
2525
2526
2527 @node Foreign Groups
2528 @section Foreign Groups
2529 @cindex foreign groups
2530
2531 If you recall how to subscribe to servers (@pxref{Finding the News})
2532 you will remember that @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} and
2533 @code{gnus-select-method} let you write a definition in Emacs Lisp of
2534 what servers you want to see when you start up. The alternate
2535 approach is to use foreign servers and groups. ``Foreign'' here means
2536 they are not coming from the select methods. All foreign server
2537 configuration and subscriptions are stored only in the
2538 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file.
2539
2540 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2541 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2542 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2543 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2544 consulted.
2545
2546 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2547 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2548 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2549
2550 @table @kbd
2551
2552 @item G m
2553 @kindex G m (Group)
2554 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2555 @cindex making groups
2556 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2557 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2558 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2559
2560 @item G M
2561 @kindex G M (Group)
2562 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2563 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2564 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2565
2566 @item G r
2567 @kindex G r (Group)
2568 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2569 @cindex renaming groups
2570 Rename the current group to something else
2571 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2572 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2573 on some back ends.
2574
2575 @item G c
2576 @kindex G c (Group)
2577 @cindex customizing
2578 @findex gnus-group-customize
2579 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2580
2581 @item G e
2582 @kindex G e (Group)
2583 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2584 @cindex renaming groups
2585 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2586 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2587
2588 @item G p
2589 @kindex G p (Group)
2590 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2591 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2592 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2593
2594 @item G E
2595 @kindex G E (Group)
2596 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2597 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2598 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2599
2600 @item G d
2601 @kindex G d (Group)
2602 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2603 @cindex nndir
2604 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2605 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2606
2607 @item G h
2608 @kindex G h (Group)
2609 @cindex help group
2610 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2611 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2612
2613 @item G D
2614 @kindex G D (Group)
2615 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2616 @cindex nneething
2617 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2618 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2619 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2620
2621 @item G f
2622 @kindex G f (Group)
2623 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2624 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2625 @cindex nndoc
2626 Make a group based on some file or other
2627 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2628 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2629 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2630 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2631 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2632 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2633 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2634 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2635 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2636
2637 @item G u
2638 @kindex G u (Group)
2639 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2640 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2641 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2642 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2643
2644 @item G w
2645 @kindex G w (Group)
2646 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2647 @cindex Google
2648 @cindex nnweb
2649 @cindex gmane
2650 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2651 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2652 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2653 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2654 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2655 @xref{Web Searches}.
2656
2657 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2658 to a particular group by using a match string like
2659 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2660
2661 @item G R
2662 @kindex G R (Group)
2663 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2664 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2665 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL@.
2666 @xref{RSS}.
2667
2668 @item G DEL
2669 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2670 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2671 This function will delete the current group
2672 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2673 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2674 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2675 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2676 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2677
2678 @item G V
2679 @kindex G V (Group)
2680 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2681 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2682 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2683
2684 @item G v
2685 @kindex G v (Group)
2686 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2687 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2688 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2689 @end table
2690
2691 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2692 methods.
2693
2694 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2695 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2696 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2697 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2698 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2699 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2700 newsgroups.
2701
2702
2703 The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2704 only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2705
2706 @table @code
2707 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2708 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2709 @vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2710 Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2711 HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2712 Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2713 the article range.
2714
2715 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2716 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2717 This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2718 the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2719 given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include:
2720 @indicateurl{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2721 @indicateurl{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2722 @indicateurl{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2723 @indicateurl{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2724 @indicateurl{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2725
2726 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2727 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2728 Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2729 bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2730 specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2731
2732 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2733 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2734 Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2735 @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2736 @end table
2737
2738 Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2739 Buttons}.
2740
2741 Here is an example:
2742 @lisp
2743 (require 'gnus-art)
2744 (add-to-list
2745 'gnus-button-alist
2746 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2747 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2748 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2749 @end lisp
2750
2751
2752 @node Group Parameters
2753 @section Group Parameters
2754 @cindex group parameters
2755
2756 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2757
2758 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2759 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2760 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2761 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2762 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2763 Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2764 @code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2765
2766 Here's an example group parameter list:
2767
2768 @example
2769 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2770 (auto-expire . t))
2771 @end example
2772
2773 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2774 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2775 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2776 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2777
2778 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2779 is an alist of regexps and values.
2780
2781 The following group parameters can be used:
2782
2783 @table @code
2784 @item to-address
2785 @cindex to-address
2786 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2787
2788 @example
2789 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2790 @end example
2791
2792 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2793 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2794 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2795 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2796 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2797
2798 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2799 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2800 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2801 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2802 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2803 list address instead.
2804
2805 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2806
2807 @item to-list
2808 @cindex to-list
2809 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2810
2811 @example
2812 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2813 @end example
2814
2815 It is totally ignored
2816 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2817 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2818
2819 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2820 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2821 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2822 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2823 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2824
2825 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2826 @cindex mail list groups
2827 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2828 entering summary buffer.
2829
2830 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2831
2832 @anchor{subscribed}
2833 @item subscribed
2834 @cindex subscribed
2835 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2836 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2837 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2838 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2839 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2840 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2841 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2842 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2843
2844 @lisp
2845 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2846 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2847 @end lisp
2848
2849 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2850 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2851
2852 @item visible
2853 @cindex visible
2854 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2855 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2856 of whether it has any unread articles.
2857
2858 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2859 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2860
2861 @item broken-reply-to
2862 @cindex broken-reply-to
2863 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2864 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2865 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2866 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2867 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2868 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2869
2870 @item to-group
2871 @cindex to-group
2872 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2873 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2874
2875 @item newsgroup
2876 @cindex newsgroup
2877 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2878 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2879 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2880 news group.
2881
2882 @item gcc-self
2883 @cindex gcc-self
2884 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2885 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2886 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2887 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2888 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2889 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2890 (@pxref{Archived Messages}), with the exception for messages to resend.
2891
2892 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2893 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2894 doesn't accept articles.
2895
2896 @item auto-expire
2897 @cindex auto-expire
2898 @cindex expiring mail
2899 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2900 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2901 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2902
2903 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2904
2905 @item total-expire
2906 @cindex total-expire
2907 @cindex expiring mail
2908 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2909 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2910 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2911 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2912 expiry.
2913
2914 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2915
2916 @item expiry-wait
2917 @cindex expiry-wait
2918 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2919 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2920 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2921 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2922 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2923 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2924 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2925
2926 @item expiry-target
2927 @cindex expiry-target
2928 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2929 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2930
2931 @item score-file
2932 @cindex score file group parameter
2933 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2934 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2935 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2936
2937 @item adapt-file
2938 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2939 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2940 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2941 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2942
2943 @item admin-address
2944 @cindex admin-address
2945 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2946 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2947 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2948 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2949
2950 @item display
2951 @cindex display
2952 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2953 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2954
2955 @table @code
2956 @item all
2957 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2958
2959 @item an integer
2960 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2961 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2962
2963 @item default
2964 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2965 ticked articles.
2966
2967 @item an array
2968 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2969
2970 Here are some examples:
2971
2972 @table @code
2973 @item [unread]
2974 Display only unread articles.
2975
2976 @item [not expire]
2977 Display everything except expirable articles.
2978
2979 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2980 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2981 responded to.
2982 @end table
2983
2984 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2985 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2986 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2987 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2988 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, and @code{unseen}.
2989
2990 @end table
2991
2992 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2993 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2994 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2995
2996 @item comment
2997 @cindex comment
2998 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2999 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
3000 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
3001
3002 @item charset
3003 @cindex charset
3004 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3005 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3006 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3007
3008 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3009
3010 @item ignored-charsets
3011 @cindex ignored-charset
3012 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3013 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3014 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3015
3016 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3017
3018 @item posting-style
3019 @cindex posting-style
3020 You can store additional posting style information for this group
3021 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3022 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3023 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3024 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3025
3026 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3027 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3028 like this in the group parameters:
3029
3030 @example
3031 (posting-style
3032 (name "Funky Name")
3033 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
3034 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3035 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3036 @end example
3037
3038 If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3039 (@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3040 the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3041 groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3042 group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3043 entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3044 to.
3045
3046
3047 @item post-method
3048 @cindex post-method
3049 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3050 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3051
3052 @item mail-source
3053 @cindex mail-source
3054 If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3055 @code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3056 mail source for this group.
3057
3058 @item banner
3059 @cindex banner
3060 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3061 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3062 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3063 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3064 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3065
3066 @item sieve
3067 @cindex sieve
3068 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3069 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3070 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3071 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3072
3073 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3074 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3075 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3076 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3077
3078 @example
3079 if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3080 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3081 @}
3082 @end example
3083
3084 To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3085 like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3086 When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3087 like the following is generated:
3088
3089 @example
3090 if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3091 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3092 @}
3093 @end example
3094
3095 You can also use regexp expansions in the rules:
3096
3097 @example
3098 (sieve header :regex "list-id" "<c++std-\\1.accu.org>")
3099 @end example
3100
3101 See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3102 interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3103
3104 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3105 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3106
3107 @item (agent parameters)
3108 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of its parameters to
3109 control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3110 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3111 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3112 minimize the configuration effort.
3113
3114 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3115 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3116 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3117 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3118 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3119 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3120 @code{eval}ed there.
3121
3122 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3123 if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3124 only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3125 variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3126 form needs to be set to it.
3127
3128 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3129 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3130 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3131 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3132 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3133 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3134 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3135
3136 @lisp
3137 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3138 @end lisp
3139
3140 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3141 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3142 the subject fields of articles. E.g., if the news group
3143
3144 @example
3145 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3146 @end example
3147
3148 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3149 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3150 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3151 into the group parameters for the group.
3152
3153 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3154 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3155 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3156 @code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3157 (meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
3158
3159 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3160 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3161 following is added to a group parameter
3162
3163 @lisp
3164 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3165 (lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3166 @end lisp
3167
3168 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3169 expired.
3170
3171 @end table
3172
3173 @vindex gnus-parameters
3174 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3175 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3176 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3177 For example:
3178
3179 @lisp
3180 (setq gnus-parameters
3181 '(("mail\\..*"
3182 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3183 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3184 (gnus-summary-line-format
3185 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3186 (gcc-self . t)
3187 (display . all))
3188
3189 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3190 (to-group . "\\1"))
3191
3192 ("mail\\.me"
3193 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3194
3195 ("list\\..*"
3196 (total-expire . t)
3197 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3198 @end lisp
3199
3200 All clauses that matches the group name will be used, but the last
3201 setting ``wins''. So if you have two clauses that both match the
3202 group name, and both set, say @code{display}, the last setting will
3203 override the first.
3204
3205 Parameters that are strings will be subjected to regexp substitution,
3206 as the @code{to-group} example shows.
3207
3208 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3209 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3210 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3211 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3212 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3213 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3214 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3215 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3216 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3217 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3218 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3219 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3220
3221 You can define different sorting to different groups via
3222 @code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3223 group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3224 @acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3225 Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3226 news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3227 weekly news RSS feed
3228 @url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3229 @xref{RSS}.
3230
3231 @lisp
3232 (setq
3233 gnus-parameters
3234 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3235 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3236 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3237 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3238 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3239 ("nnrss.*debian"
3240 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3241 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3242 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3243 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3244 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3245 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3246 @end lisp
3247
3248
3249 @node Listing Groups
3250 @section Listing Groups
3251 @cindex group listing
3252
3253 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3254
3255 @table @kbd
3256
3257 @item l
3258 @itemx A s
3259 @kindex A s (Group)
3260 @kindex l (Group)
3261 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3262 List all groups that have unread articles
3263 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3264 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3265 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3266 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3267 groups).
3268
3269 @item L
3270 @itemx A u
3271 @kindex A u (Group)
3272 @kindex L (Group)
3273 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3274 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3275 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3276 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3277 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3278 unsubscribed groups).
3279
3280 @item A l
3281 @kindex A l (Group)
3282 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3283 List all unread groups on a specific level
3284 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3285 with no unread articles.
3286
3287 @item A k
3288 @kindex A k (Group)
3289 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3290 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3291 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3292 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3293 from the server.
3294
3295 @item A z
3296 @kindex A z (Group)
3297 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3298 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3299
3300 @item A m
3301 @kindex A m (Group)
3302 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3303 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3304 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3305
3306 @item A M
3307 @kindex A M (Group)
3308 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3309 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3310
3311 @item A A
3312 @kindex A A (Group)
3313 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3314 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3315 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3316 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3317 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3318 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3319 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3320 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3321
3322 @item A a
3323 @kindex A a (Group)
3324 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3325 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3326 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3327
3328 @item A d
3329 @kindex A d (Group)
3330 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3331 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3332 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3333
3334 @item A c
3335 @kindex A c (Group)
3336 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3337 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3338
3339 @item A ?
3340 @kindex A ? (Group)
3341 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3342 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3343
3344 @item A !
3345 @kindex A ! (Group)
3346 @findex gnus-group-list-ticked
3347 List all groups with ticked articles (@code{gnus-group-list-ticked}).
3348
3349 @item A /
3350 @kindex A / (Group)
3351 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3352 Further limit groups within the current selection
3353 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}). If you've first limited to groups
3354 with dormant articles with @kbd{A ?}, you can then further limit with
3355 @kbd{A / c}, which will then limit to groups with cached articles,
3356 giving you the groups that have both dormant articles and cached
3357 articles.
3358
3359 @item A f
3360 @kindex A f (Group)
3361 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3362 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3363
3364 @item A p
3365 @kindex A p (Group)
3366 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3367 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3368
3369 @end table
3370
3371 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3372 @cindex visible group parameter
3373 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3374 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3375 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3376 get the same effect.
3377
3378 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3379 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3380 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3381 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3382 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3383
3384
3385 @node Sorting Groups
3386 @section Sorting Groups
3387 @cindex sorting groups
3388
3389 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3390 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3391 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3392 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3393 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3394 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3395 include:
3396
3397 @table @code
3398
3399 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3400 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3401 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3402
3403 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3404 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3405 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3406
3407 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3408 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3409 Sort by group level.
3410
3411 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3412 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3413 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3414
3415 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3416 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3417 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3418 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3419
3420 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3421 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3422 Sort by number of unread articles.
3423
3424 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3425 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3426 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3427
3428 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3429 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3430 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3431
3432
3433 @end table
3434
3435 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3436 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3437 the last one.
3438
3439
3440 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3441 some sorting criteria:
3442
3443 @table @kbd
3444 @item G S a
3445 @kindex G S a (Group)
3446 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3447 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3448 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3449
3450 @item G S u
3451 @kindex G S u (Group)
3452 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3453 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3454 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3455
3456 @item G S l
3457 @kindex G S l (Group)
3458 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3459 Sort the group buffer by group level
3460 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3461
3462 @item G S v
3463 @kindex G S v (Group)
3464 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3465 Sort the group buffer by group score
3466 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3467
3468 @item G S r
3469 @kindex G S r (Group)
3470 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3471 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3472 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3473
3474 @item G S m
3475 @kindex G S m (Group)
3476 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3477 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3478 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3479
3480 @item G S n
3481 @kindex G S n (Group)
3482 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3483 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3484 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3485
3486 @end table
3487
3488 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3489 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3490
3491 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3492 commands will sort in reverse order.
3493
3494 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3495
3496 @table @kbd
3497 @item G P a
3498 @kindex G P a (Group)
3499 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3500 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3501 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3502
3503 @item G P u
3504 @kindex G P u (Group)
3505 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3506 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3507 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3508
3509 @item G P l
3510 @kindex G P l (Group)
3511 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3512 Sort the groups by group level
3513 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3514
3515 @item G P v
3516 @kindex G P v (Group)
3517 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3518 Sort the groups by group score
3519 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3520
3521 @item G P r
3522 @kindex G P r (Group)
3523 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3524 Sort the groups by group rank
3525 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3526
3527 @item G P m
3528 @kindex G P m (Group)
3529 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3530 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3531 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3532
3533 @item G P n
3534 @kindex G P n (Group)
3535 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3536 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3537 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3538
3539 @item G P s
3540 @kindex G P s (Group)
3541 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3542 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3543
3544 @end table
3545
3546 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3547 move groups around.
3548
3549
3550 @node Group Maintenance
3551 @section Group Maintenance
3552 @cindex bogus groups
3553
3554 @table @kbd
3555 @item b
3556 @kindex b (Group)
3557 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3558 Find bogus groups and delete them
3559 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3560
3561 @item F
3562 @kindex F (Group)
3563 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3564 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3565 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3566 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3567 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3568 zombies.
3569
3570 @item C-c C-x
3571 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3572 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3573 @cindex expiring mail
3574 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3575 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3576 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3577 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3578
3579 @item C-c C-M-x
3580 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3581 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3582 @cindex expiring mail
3583 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3584 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3585
3586 @end table
3587
3588
3589 @node Browse Foreign Server
3590 @section Browse Foreign Server
3591 @cindex foreign servers
3592 @cindex browsing servers
3593
3594 @table @kbd
3595 @item B
3596 @kindex B (Group)
3597 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3598 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3599 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3600 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3601 @end table
3602
3603 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3604 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3605 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3606 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3607
3608 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3609
3610 @table @kbd
3611 @item n
3612 @kindex n (Browse)
3613 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3614 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3615
3616 @item p
3617 @kindex p (Browse)
3618 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3619 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3620
3621 @item SPACE
3622 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3623 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3624 Enter the current group and display the first article
3625 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3626
3627 @item RET
3628 @kindex RET (Browse)
3629 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3630 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3631
3632 @item u
3633 @kindex u (Browse)
3634 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3635 @vindex gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method
3636 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3637 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}). You
3638 can affect the way the new group is entered into the Group buffer
3639 using the variable @code{gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method}. See
3640 @pxref{Subscription Methods} for available options.
3641
3642 @item l
3643 @itemx q
3644 @kindex q (Browse)
3645 @kindex l (Browse)
3646 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3647 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3648
3649 @item d
3650 @kindex d (Browse)
3651 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3652 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3653
3654 @item ?
3655 @kindex ? (Browse)
3656 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3657 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3658 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3659
3660 @item DEL
3661 @kindex DEL (Browse)
3662 @findex gnus-browse-delete-group
3663 This function will delete the current group
3664 (@code{gnus-browse-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function
3665 will actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly
3666 remove the group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only
3667 if you are absolutely sure of what you are doing.
3668 @end table
3669
3670
3671 @node Exiting Gnus
3672 @section Exiting Gnus
3673 @cindex exiting Gnus
3674
3675 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3676
3677 @table @kbd
3678 @item z
3679 @kindex z (Group)
3680 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3681 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3682 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3683 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3684
3685 @item q
3686 @kindex q (Group)
3687 @findex gnus-group-exit
3688 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3689 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3690
3691 @item Q
3692 @kindex Q (Group)
3693 @findex gnus-group-quit
3694 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3695 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3696 @end table
3697
3698 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3699 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3700 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3701 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3702 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3703 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3704 exiting Gnus.
3705
3706 Note:
3707
3708 @quotation
3709 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3710 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3711 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3712 plastic chair.
3713 @end quotation
3714
3715
3716 @node Group Topics
3717 @section Group Topics
3718 @cindex topics
3719
3720 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3721 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3722 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3723 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3724 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3725 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3726
3727 @iftex
3728 @iflatex
3729 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3730 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3731 }
3732 @end iflatex
3733 @end iftex
3734
3735 Here's an example:
3736
3737 @example
3738 Gnus
3739 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3740 3: comp.emacs
3741 2: alt.religion.emacs
3742 Naughty Emacs
3743 452: alt.sex.emacs
3744 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3745 Misc
3746 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3747 13: comp.sources.unix
3748 @end example
3749
3750 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3751 @kindex t (Group)
3752 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3753 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3754 is a toggling command.)
3755
3756 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3757 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3758 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3759 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3760 Hot and bothered?
3761
3762 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3763 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3764 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3765
3766 @lisp
3767 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3768 @end lisp
3769
3770 @menu
3771 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3772 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3773 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3774 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3775 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3776 @end menu
3777
3778
3779 @node Topic Commands
3780 @subsection Topic Commands
3781 @cindex topic commands
3782
3783 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3784 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3785 definitions slightly.
3786
3787 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3788 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3789 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3790 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3791 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3792 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3793
3794 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3795 the way you like.
3796
3797 @table @kbd
3798
3799 @item T n
3800 @kindex T n (Topic)
3801 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3802 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3803 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3804
3805 @item T TAB
3806 @itemx TAB
3807 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3808 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3809 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3810 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3811 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3812 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3813
3814 @item M-TAB
3815 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3816 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3817 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3818 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3819
3820 @end table
3821
3822 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3823 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3824 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3825 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3826
3827 @table @kbd
3828
3829 @item C-k
3830 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3831 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3832 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3833 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3834
3835 @item C-y
3836 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3837 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3838 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3839 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3840 before all groups.
3841
3842 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3843 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3844 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3845 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3846 paste. Like I said---E-Z.
3847
3848 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3849 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3850
3851 @end table
3852
3853 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3854 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3855 key.
3856
3857 @table @kbd
3858
3859 @item RET
3860 @kindex RET (Topic)
3861 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3862 @itemx SPACE
3863 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3864 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3865 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3866 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3867 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3868 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3869
3870 @end table
3871
3872 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3873
3874 @table @kbd
3875
3876 @item T m
3877 @kindex T m (Topic)
3878 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3879 Move the current group to some other topic
3880 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3881 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3882
3883 @item T j
3884 @kindex T j (Topic)
3885 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3886 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3887
3888 @item T c
3889 @kindex T c (Topic)
3890 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3891 Copy the current group to some other topic
3892 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3893 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3894
3895 @item T h
3896 @kindex T h (Topic)
3897 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3898 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3899 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3900
3901 @item T s
3902 @kindex T s (Topic)
3903 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3904 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3905 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3906
3907 @item T D
3908 @kindex T D (Topic)
3909 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3910 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3911 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3912 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3913 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3914 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3915 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3916 topic.
3917
3918 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3919 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3920
3921 @item T M
3922 @kindex T M (Topic)
3923 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3924 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3925 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3926
3927 @item T C
3928 @kindex T C (Topic)
3929 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3930 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3931 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3932
3933 @item T H
3934 @kindex T H (Topic)
3935 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3936 Toggle hiding empty topics
3937 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3938
3939 @item T #
3940 @kindex T # (Topic)
3941 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3942 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3943 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3944 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3945
3946 @item T M-#
3947 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3948 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3949 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3950 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3951 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3952
3953 @item C-c C-x
3954 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3955 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3956 @cindex expiring mail
3957 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3958 expiry process (if any)
3959 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3960
3961 @item T r
3962 @kindex T r (Topic)
3963 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3964 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3965
3966 @item T DEL
3967 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3968 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3969 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3970
3971 @item A T
3972 @kindex A T (Topic)
3973 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3974 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3975 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3976
3977 @item T M-n
3978 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3979 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3980 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3981
3982 @item T M-p
3983 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3984 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3985 Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3986
3987 @item G p
3988 @kindex G p (Topic)
3989 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3990 @cindex group parameters
3991 @cindex topic parameters
3992 @cindex parameters
3993 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3994 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3995
3996 @end table
3997
3998
3999 @node Topic Variables
4000 @subsection Topic Variables
4001 @cindex topic variables
4002
4003 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
4004 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
4005
4006 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
4007 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
4008 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4009 Valid elements are:
4010
4011 @table @samp
4012 @item i
4013 Indentation.
4014 @item n
4015 Topic name.
4016 @item v
4017 Visibility.
4018 @item l
4019 Level.
4020 @item g
4021 Number of groups in the topic.
4022 @item a
4023 Number of unread articles in the topic.
4024 @item A
4025 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4026 @end table
4027
4028 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4029 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4030 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4031 The default is 2.
4032
4033 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4034 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4035
4036 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4037 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4038 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4039
4040
4041 @node Topic Sorting
4042 @subsection Topic Sorting
4043 @cindex topic sorting
4044
4045 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4046 commands:
4047
4048
4049 @table @kbd
4050 @item T S a
4051 @kindex T S a (Topic)
4052 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4053 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4054 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4055
4056 @item T S u
4057 @kindex T S u (Topic)
4058 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4059 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4060 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4061
4062 @item T S l
4063 @kindex T S l (Topic)
4064 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4065 Sort the current topic by group level
4066 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4067
4068 @item T S v
4069 @kindex T S v (Topic)
4070 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4071 Sort the current topic by group score
4072 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4073
4074 @item T S r
4075 @kindex T S r (Topic)
4076 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4077 Sort the current topic by group rank
4078 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4079
4080 @item T S m
4081 @kindex T S m (Topic)
4082 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4083 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4084 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4085
4086 @item T S e
4087 @kindex T S e (Topic)
4088 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4089 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4090 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4091
4092 @item T S s
4093 @kindex T S s (Topic)
4094 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4095 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4096 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4097 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4098
4099 @end table
4100
4101 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4102 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4103 sorting.
4104
4105
4106 @node Topic Topology
4107 @subsection Topic Topology
4108 @cindex topic topology
4109 @cindex topology
4110
4111 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4112
4113 @example
4114 @group
4115 Gnus
4116 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4117 3: comp.emacs
4118 2: alt.religion.emacs
4119 Naughty Emacs
4120 452: alt.sex.emacs
4121 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4122 Misc
4123 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4124 13: comp.sources.unix
4125 @end group
4126 @end example
4127
4128 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4129 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4130 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4131 follows:
4132
4133 @lisp
4134 (("Gnus" visible)
4135 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4136 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4137 (("Misc" visible)))
4138 @end lisp
4139
4140 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4141 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4142 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4143 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4144 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4145 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4146
4147 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4148 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4149 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4150
4151
4152 @node Topic Parameters
4153 @subsection Topic Parameters
4154 @cindex topic parameters
4155
4156 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4157 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4158 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4159 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4160 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4161
4162 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4163 parameters:
4164
4165 @table @code
4166 @item subscribe
4167 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4168 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4169 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4170 topic.
4171
4172 @item subscribe-level
4173 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4174 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4175 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4176
4177 @end table
4178
4179 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4180 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4181 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4182 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4183
4184 @example
4185 @group
4186 Gnus
4187 Emacs
4188 3: comp.emacs
4189 2: alt.religion.emacs
4190 452: alt.sex.emacs
4191 Relief
4192 452: alt.sex.emacs
4193 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4194 Misc
4195 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4196 13: comp.sources.unix
4197 452: alt.sex.emacs
4198 @end group
4199 @end example
4200
4201 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4202 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4203 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4204 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4205 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4206 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4207
4208 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4209 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4210 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4211 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4212 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4213
4214 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4215 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4216 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4217 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4218 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4219 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4220 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4221 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4222
4223
4224 @node Non-ASCII Group Names
4225 @section Accessing groups of non-English names
4226 @cindex non-ascii group names
4227
4228 There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4229 expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4230 certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4231 spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4232 course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4233 supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4234 back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4235 back end.
4236
4237 Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4238 side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4239 charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4240 Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4241 article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4242 with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4243 non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4244 the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4245
4246 @table @code
4247 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4248 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4249 An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4250 @code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4251 method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4252
4253 @lisp
4254 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4255 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4256 @end lisp
4257
4258 Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4259 ones specified for the same groups with the
4260 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4261
4262 A select method can be very long, like:
4263
4264 @lisp
4265 (nntp "gmane"
4266 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4267 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4268 (nntp-open-connection-function
4269 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4270 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4271 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4272 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4273 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4274 @end lisp
4275
4276 In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4277 variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4278 the server name.
4279
4280 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4281 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4282 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4283 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4284 @code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4285 otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4286
4287 @lisp
4288 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4289 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4290 (".*" . utf-8)))
4291 @end lisp
4292
4293 Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4294 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4295 @end table
4296
4297 Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4298 and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4299 other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4300 you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4301 all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4302 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4303
4304 There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
4305 names:
4306
4307 @table @code
4308 @item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4309 @vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4310 The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4311 default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4312 named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4313 @code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4314
4315 The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the agent, and
4316 the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4317 directories. This variable overrides the value of
4318 @code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4319 when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
4320
4321 In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4322 is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
4323 file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
4324 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
4325 is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4326 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4327
4328 Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4329 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4330 to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4331 to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4332
4333 The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4334 does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4335 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4336 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4337
4338 If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4339 initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4340 want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4341 typical case where you have to customize
4342 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4343 a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4344 system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4345 may be initialized to an appropriate value.
4346 @end table
4347
4348 Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4349 group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4350 names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4351 header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4352
4353
4354 @node Misc Group Stuff
4355 @section Misc Group Stuff
4356
4357 @menu
4358 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4359 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4360 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4361 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4362 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4363 @end menu
4364
4365 @table @kbd
4366
4367 @item v
4368 @kindex v (Group)
4369 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4370 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4371 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4372
4373 @lisp
4374 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4375 (lambda ()
4376 (interactive)
4377 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4378 @end lisp
4379
4380 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4381 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4382
4383 @item ^
4384 @kindex ^ (Group)
4385 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4386 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4387 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4388
4389 @item a
4390 @kindex a (Group)
4391 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4392 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4393 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4394 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4395 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4396 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4397 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4398
4399 @item m
4400 @kindex m (Group)
4401 @findex gnus-group-mail
4402 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4403 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4404 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4405 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4406
4407 @item i
4408 @kindex i (Group)
4409 @findex gnus-group-news
4410 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4411 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4412 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4413
4414 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4415 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4416 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4417 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4418 for this to work though.
4419
4420 @item G z
4421 @kindex G z (Group)
4422 @findex gnus-group-compact-group
4423
4424 Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4425 Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4426 gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4427 count.
4428
4429 @end table
4430
4431 Variables for the group buffer:
4432
4433 @table @code
4434
4435 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4436 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4437 is called after the group buffer has been
4438 created.
4439
4440 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4441 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4442 is called after the group buffer is
4443 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4444 unnatural way.
4445
4446 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4447 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4448 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4449 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4450
4451 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4452 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4453 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4454 whether they are empty or not.
4455
4456 @end table
4457
4458 @node Scanning New Messages
4459 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4460 @cindex new messages
4461 @cindex scanning new news
4462
4463 @table @kbd
4464
4465 @item g
4466 @kindex g (Group)
4467 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4468 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4469 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4470 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4471 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4472 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4473 back end(s).
4474
4475 @item M-g
4476 @kindex M-g (Group)
4477 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4478 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4479 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4480 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4481 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4482 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4483 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4484
4485 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4486 @cindex activating groups
4487 @item C-c M-g
4488 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4489 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4490
4491 @item R
4492 @kindex R (Group)
4493 @cindex restarting
4494 @findex gnus-group-restart
4495 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4496 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4497 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4498
4499 @end table
4500
4501 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4502 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4503
4504 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4505 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4506 news.
4507
4508
4509 @node Group Information
4510 @subsection Group Information
4511 @cindex group information
4512 @cindex information on groups
4513
4514 @table @kbd
4515
4516
4517 @item H d
4518 @itemx C-c C-d
4519 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4520 @kindex H d (Group)
4521 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4522 @cindex describing groups
4523 @cindex group description
4524 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4525 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4526 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4527
4528 @item M-d
4529 @kindex M-d (Group)
4530 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4531 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4532 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4533
4534 @item H v
4535 @itemx V
4536 @kindex V (Group)
4537 @kindex H v (Group)
4538 @cindex version
4539 @findex gnus-version
4540 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4541
4542 @item ?
4543 @kindex ? (Group)
4544 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4545 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4546
4547 @item C-c C-i
4548 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4549 @cindex info
4550 @cindex manual
4551 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4552 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4553 @end table
4554
4555
4556 @node Group Timestamp
4557 @subsection Group Timestamp
4558 @cindex timestamps
4559 @cindex group timestamps
4560
4561 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4562 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4563 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4564
4565 @lisp
4566 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4567 @end lisp
4568
4569 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4570
4571 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4572 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4573
4574 @lisp
4575 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4576 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4577 @end lisp
4578
4579 This will result in lines looking like:
4580
4581 @example
4582 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4583 0: custom 19961002T012713
4584 @end example
4585
4586 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4587 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4588 something like:
4589
4590 @lisp
4591 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4592 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4593 @end lisp
4594
4595 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4596 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4597 trick:
4598
4599 @lisp
4600 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4601 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4602 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4603 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4604 (if time
4605 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4606 "")))
4607 @end lisp
4608
4609 To see what variables are dynamically bound (like
4610 @code{gnus-tmp-group}), you have to look at the source code. The
4611 variable names aren't guaranteed to be stable over Gnus versions,
4612 either.
4613
4614
4615 @node File Commands
4616 @subsection File Commands
4617 @cindex file commands
4618
4619 @table @kbd
4620
4621 @item r
4622 @kindex r (Group)
4623 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4624 @vindex gnus-init-file
4625 @cindex reading init file
4626 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4627 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4628
4629 @item s
4630 @kindex s (Group)
4631 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4632 @cindex saving .newsrc
4633 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4634 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4635 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4636
4637 @c @item Z
4638 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4639 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4640 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4641
4642 @end table
4643
4644
4645 @node Sieve Commands
4646 @subsection Sieve Commands
4647 @cindex group sieve commands
4648
4649 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4650 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4651 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4652 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4653 script that can be transferred to the server somehow.
4654
4655 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4656 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4657 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4658 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4659 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4660 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4661 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4662 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4663 regenerate the Sieve script.
4664
4665 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4666 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4667 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4668 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4669 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4670 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4671 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4672 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4673 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4674 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4675
4676 @example
4677 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4678 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4679 stop;
4680 @}
4681 @end example
4682
4683 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4684
4685 @table @kbd
4686
4687 @item D g
4688 @kindex D g (Group)
4689 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4690 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4691 @cindex generating sieve script
4692 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4693 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4694
4695 @item D u
4696 @kindex D u (Group)
4697 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4698 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4699 @cindex updating sieve script
4700 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4701 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4702 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4703
4704 @end table
4705
4706
4707 @node Summary Buffer
4708 @chapter Summary Buffer
4709 @cindex summary buffer
4710
4711 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4712 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4713
4714 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4715 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4716
4717 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4718
4719 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4720 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4721 available in Emacs.
4722
4723 @kindex v (Summary)
4724 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4725 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4726 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4727 @lisp
4728 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4729 @end lisp
4730
4731 @menu
4732 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4733 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4734 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4735 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4736 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4737 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4738 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4739 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4740 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4741 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4742 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4743 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4744 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4745 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4746 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4747 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4748 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4749 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4750 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4751 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4752 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4753 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4754 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4755 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4756 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4757 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4758 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4759 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4760 or reselecting the current group.
4761 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4762 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4763 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4764 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4765 @end menu
4766
4767
4768 @node Summary Buffer Format
4769 @section Summary Buffer Format
4770 @cindex summary buffer format
4771
4772 @iftex
4773 @iflatex
4774 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4775 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4776 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4777 }
4778 @end iflatex
4779 @end iftex
4780
4781 @menu
4782 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4783 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4784 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4785 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4786 @end menu
4787
4788 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4789 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4790 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4791 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4792 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4793 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4794 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4795 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4796 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4797 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4798 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4799
4800 @lisp
4801 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4802 'mail-extract-address-components)
4803 @end lisp
4804
4805 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4806 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4807 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4808 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4809
4810
4811 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4812 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4813
4814 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4815 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4816 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4817 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4818 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4819
4820 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4821 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4822 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4823 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4824 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4825 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4826
4827 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4828
4829 The following format specification characters and extended format
4830 specification(s) are understood:
4831
4832 @table @samp
4833 @item N
4834 Article number.
4835 @item S
4836 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4837 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4838 @item s
4839 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4840 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4841 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4842 @item F
4843 Full @code{From} header.
4844 @item n
4845 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4846 @item f
4847 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4848 From Newsgroups}).
4849 @item a
4850 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4851 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4852 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4853 may be more thorough.
4854 @item A
4855 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4856 the @code{a} spec.
4857 @item L
4858 Number of lines in the article.
4859 @item c
4860 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4861 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4862 @item k
4863 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4864 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4865 @item I
4866 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4867 @item B
4868 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4869 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4870
4871 @example
4872 >
4873 +->
4874 | +->
4875 | | \->
4876 | | \->
4877 | \->
4878 +->
4879 \->
4880 @end example
4881
4882 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4883 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4884 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4885 line-drawing glyphs.
4886 @table @code
4887 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4888 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4889 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4890 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4891
4892 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4893 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4894 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4895 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4896
4897 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4898 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4899 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4900 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4901
4902 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4903 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4904 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4905
4906 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4907 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4908 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4909
4910 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4911 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4912 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4913
4914 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4915 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4916 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4917
4918 @end table
4919
4920 @item T
4921 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4922 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4923 @item [
4924 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4925 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4926 @item ]
4927 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4928 for adopted articles.
4929 @item >
4930 One space for each thread level.
4931 @item <
4932 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4933 @item U
4934 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4935
4936 @item R
4937 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4938 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4939 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4940
4941 @item i
4942 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4943 @item z
4944 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4945 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4946 default level. If the difference between
4947 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4948 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4949 @item V
4950 Total thread score.
4951 @item x
4952 @code{Xref}.
4953 @item D
4954 @code{Date}.
4955 @item d
4956 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4957 @item o
4958 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4959 @item M
4960 @code{Message-ID}.
4961 @item r
4962 @code{References}.
4963 @item t
4964 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4965 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4966 @item e
4967 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4968 article has any children.
4969 @item P
4970 The line number.
4971 @item O
4972 Download mark.
4973 @item *
4974 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4975 @item &user-date;
4976 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4977 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4978 @item u
4979 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4980 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4981 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4982 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4983 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4984 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4985 @end table
4986
4987 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4988 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4989 There can only be one such area.
4990
4991 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4992 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4993 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4994 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4995 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4996 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4997
4998 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4999 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
5000
5001 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
5002
5003
5004 @node To From Newsgroups
5005 @subsection To From Newsgroups
5006 @cindex To
5007 @cindex Newsgroups
5008
5009 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
5010 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
5011 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
5012 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
5013 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
5014
5015 @enumerate
5016 @item
5017 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
5018 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
5019 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
5020 instance:
5021
5022 @lisp
5023 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5024 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5025 @end lisp
5026
5027 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5028 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5029
5030 @item
5031 @findex gnus-extra-header
5032 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5033 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5034 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5035
5036 @example
5037 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5038 @end example
5039
5040 @item
5041 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5042 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5043 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5044 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5045 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5046 headers are used instead.
5047
5048 To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5049 has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5050 @code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5051 @samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5052 customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5053 @code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5054
5055 @end enumerate
5056
5057 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5058 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5059 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5060 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5061 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5062 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g., nnml) to cause
5063 regeneration.
5064
5065 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5066 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5067 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5068 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5069
5070 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5071 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
5072
5073 @lisp
5074 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5075 '(To Newsgroups))
5076 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5077 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
5078 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5079 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5080 "Your Name Here")
5081 @end lisp
5082
5083 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5084 to fit your needs.)
5085
5086 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5087 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5088 support:
5089
5090 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5091 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5092 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5093
5094 @example
5095 Newsgroups:full
5096 @end example
5097
5098 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5099 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5100
5101
5102 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5103 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5104
5105 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5106 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5107 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5108 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5109
5110 Here are the elements you can play with:
5111
5112 @table @samp
5113 @item G
5114 Group name.
5115 @item p
5116 Unprefixed group name.
5117 @item A
5118 Current article number.
5119 @item z
5120 Current article score.
5121 @item V
5122 Gnus version.
5123 @item U
5124 Number of unread articles in this group.
5125 @item e
5126 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5127 summary buffer.
5128 @item Z
5129 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5130 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5131 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5132 and no unselected ones.
5133 @item g
5134 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5135 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5136 @item S
5137 Subject of the current article.
5138 @item u
5139 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5140 @item s
5141 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5142 @item d
5143 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5144 @item t
5145 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5146 @item r
5147 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5148 @item E
5149 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5150 @end table
5151
5152
5153 @node Summary Highlighting
5154 @subsection Summary Highlighting
5155
5156 @table @code
5157
5158 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5159 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5160 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5161 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5162 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5163
5164 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
5165 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5166 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5167 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5168
5169 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
5170 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5171 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5172 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5173
5174 @item gnus-summary-highlight
5175 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5176 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5177 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5178 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5179 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5180 to something like
5181 @lisp
5182 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5183 ((> score default) . bold))
5184 @end lisp
5185 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5186 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
5187 @end table
5188
5189
5190 @node Summary Maneuvering
5191 @section Summary Maneuvering
5192 @cindex summary movement
5193
5194 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5195 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5196
5197 None of these commands select articles.
5198
5199 @table @kbd
5200 @item G M-n
5201 @itemx M-n
5202 @kindex M-n (Summary)
5203 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
5204 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5205 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5206 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5207
5208 @item G M-p
5209 @itemx M-p
5210 @kindex M-p (Summary)
5211 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
5212 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5213 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5214 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5215
5216 @item G g
5217 @kindex G g (Summary)
5218 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5219 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5220 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5221 @end table
5222
5223 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5224 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5225 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5226 to the group buffer.
5227
5228 Variables related to summary movement:
5229
5230 @table @code
5231
5232 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5233 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5234 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5235 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5236 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5237 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5238 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5239 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5240 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5241 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5242 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5243 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5244 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5245 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5246
5247 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5248 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5249 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5250 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5251 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5252 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5253 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5254
5255 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5256
5257 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5258 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5259 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5260 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5261 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5262
5263 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5264 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5265 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5266 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5267 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5268 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5269 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5270 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5271 threads.
5272
5273 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5274 the given number of lines from the top.
5275
5276 @item gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5277 @vindex gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5278 If non-@code{nil}, don't go to the next article when hitting
5279 @kbd{SPC}, and you're at the end of the article.
5280
5281 @end table
5282
5283
5284 @node Choosing Articles
5285 @section Choosing Articles
5286 @cindex selecting articles
5287
5288 @menu
5289 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5290 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5291 @end menu
5292
5293
5294 @node Choosing Commands
5295 @subsection Choosing Commands
5296
5297 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5298 and they all select and display an article.
5299
5300 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5301 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5302
5303 @table @kbd
5304 @item SPACE
5305 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5306 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5307 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5308 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5309
5310 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5311 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5312 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5313
5314 @item G n
5315 @itemx n
5316 @kindex n (Summary)
5317 @kindex G n (Summary)
5318 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5319 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5320 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5321
5322 @item G p
5323 @itemx p
5324 @kindex p (Summary)
5325 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5326 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5327 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5328
5329 @item G N
5330 @itemx N
5331 @kindex N (Summary)
5332 @kindex G N (Summary)
5333 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5334 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5335
5336 @item G P
5337 @itemx P
5338 @kindex P (Summary)
5339 @kindex G P (Summary)
5340 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5341 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5342
5343 @item G C-n
5344 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5345 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5346 Go to the next article with the same subject
5347 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5348
5349 @item G C-p
5350 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5351 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5352 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5353 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5354
5355 @item G f
5356 @itemx .
5357 @kindex G f (Summary)
5358 @kindex . (Summary)
5359 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5360 Go to the first unread article
5361 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5362
5363 @item G b
5364 @itemx ,
5365 @kindex G b (Summary)
5366 @kindex , (Summary)
5367 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5368 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5369 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5370 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5371
5372 @item G l
5373 @itemx l
5374 @kindex l (Summary)
5375 @kindex G l (Summary)
5376 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5377 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5378
5379 @item G o
5380 @kindex G o (Summary)
5381 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5382 @cindex history
5383 @cindex article history
5384 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5385 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5386 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5387 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5388 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5389 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5390
5391 @item G j
5392 @itemx j
5393 @kindex j (Summary)
5394 @kindex G j (Summary)
5395 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5396 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5397 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5398
5399 @end table
5400
5401
5402 @node Choosing Variables
5403 @subsection Choosing Variables
5404
5405 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5406
5407 @table @code
5408 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5409 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5410 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5411 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5412 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5413 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5414
5415 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5416 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5417 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5418 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5419 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5420 hook will do so.
5421
5422 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5423 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5424 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5425 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5426 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5427 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5428 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5429 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5430 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5431 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5432 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5433 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5434 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5435 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5436
5437 @end table
5438
5439
5440 @node Paging the Article
5441 @section Scrolling the Article
5442 @cindex article scrolling
5443
5444 @table @kbd
5445
5446 @item SPACE
5447 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5448 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5449 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5450 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5451 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5452
5453 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5454 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5455 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5456 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5457 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5458 what is considered uninteresting with
5459 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5460 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5461
5462 @item DEL
5463 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5464 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5465 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5466
5467 @item RET
5468 @kindex RET (Summary)
5469 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5470 Scroll the current article one line forward
5471 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5472
5473 @item M-RET
5474 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5475 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5476 Scroll the current article one line backward
5477 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5478
5479 @item A g
5480 @itemx g
5481 @kindex A g (Summary)
5482 @kindex g (Summary)
5483 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5484 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5485 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5486 given a prefix, show a completely ``raw'' article, just the way it
5487 came from the server. If given a prefix twice (i.e., @kbd{C-u C-u
5488 g'}), fetch the current article, but don't run any of the article
5489 treatment functions.
5490
5491 @cindex charset, view article with different charset
5492 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5493 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5494 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5495
5496 @lisp
5497 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5498 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5499 (2 . big5)))
5500 @end lisp
5501
5502 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5503
5504 @item A <
5505 @itemx <
5506 @kindex < (Summary)
5507 @kindex A < (Summary)
5508 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5509 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5510 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5511
5512 @item A >
5513 @itemx >
5514 @kindex > (Summary)
5515 @kindex A > (Summary)
5516 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5517 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5518
5519 @item A s
5520 @itemx s
5521 @kindex A s (Summary)
5522 @kindex s (Summary)
5523 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5524 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5525 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5526
5527 @item h
5528 @kindex h (Summary)
5529 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5530 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5531
5532 @end table
5533
5534
5535 @node Reply Followup and Post
5536 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5537
5538 @menu
5539 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5540 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5541 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5542 * Canceling and Superseding::
5543 @end menu
5544
5545
5546 @node Summary Mail Commands
5547 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5548 @cindex mail
5549 @cindex composing mail
5550
5551 Commands for composing a mail message:
5552
5553 @table @kbd
5554
5555 @item S r
5556 @itemx r
5557 @kindex S r (Summary)
5558 @kindex r (Summary)
5559 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5560 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5561 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5562 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5563 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5564
5565 @item S R
5566 @itemx R
5567 @kindex R (Summary)
5568 @kindex S R (Summary)
5569 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5570 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5571 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5572 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5573 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5574
5575 @item S w
5576 @kindex S w (Summary)
5577 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5578 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5579 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5580 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5581 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5582 present, that's used instead.
5583
5584 @item S W
5585 @kindex S W (Summary)
5586 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5587 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5588 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5589 the process/prefix convention, but only uses the headers from the
5590 first article to determine the recipients.
5591
5592 @item S L
5593 @kindex S L (Summary)
5594 @findex gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original
5595 When replying to a message from a mailing list, send a reply to that
5596 message to the mailing list, and include the original message
5597 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original}).
5598
5599 @item S v
5600 @kindex S v (Summary)
5601 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5602 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5603 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5604 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5605 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5606 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5607
5608 @item S V
5609 @kindex S V (Summary)
5610 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5611 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5612 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5613 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5614
5615 @item S B r
5616 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5617 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5618 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5619 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5620 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5621 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5622 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5623 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5624
5625 @item S B R
5626 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5627 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5628 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5629 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5630 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5631
5632 @item S o m
5633 @itemx C-c C-f
5634 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5635 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5636 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5637 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5638 Forward the current article to some other person
5639 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5640 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5641 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5642 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5643 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5644 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5645 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5646 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5647 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5648 section.
5649
5650 @item S m
5651 @itemx m
5652 @kindex m (Summary)
5653 @kindex S m (Summary)
5654 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5655 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5656 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5657 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5658 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5659
5660 @item S i
5661 @kindex S i (Summary)
5662 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5663 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5664 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5665 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5666
5667 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5668 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5669 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5670 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5671 for this to work though.
5672
5673 @item S D b
5674 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5675 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5676 @cindex bouncing mail
5677 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5678 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5679 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5680 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5681 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5682 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5683 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5684 very well fail, though.
5685
5686 @item S D r
5687 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5688 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5689 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5690 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5691 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5692 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5693 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5694 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5695 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5696 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5697
5698 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5699 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5700 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5701 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5702 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5703
5704 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5705 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5706
5707 @item S D e
5708 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5709 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5710
5711 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5712 if it were a new message before resending.
5713
5714 @item S O m
5715 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5716 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5717 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5718 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5719 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5720
5721 @item S M-c
5722 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5723 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5724 @cindex crossposting
5725 @cindex excessive crossposting
5726 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5727 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5728
5729 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5730 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5731 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5732 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5733 command understands the process/prefix convention
5734 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5735
5736 @end table
5737
5738 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5739 Manual}, for more information.
5740
5741
5742 @node Summary Post Commands
5743 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5744 @cindex post
5745 @cindex composing news
5746
5747 Commands for posting a news article:
5748
5749 @table @kbd
5750 @item S p
5751 @itemx a
5752 @kindex a (Summary)
5753 @kindex S p (Summary)
5754 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5755 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5756 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5757 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5758 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5759
5760 @item S f
5761 @itemx f
5762 @kindex f (Summary)
5763 @kindex S f (Summary)
5764 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5765 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5766 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5767
5768 @item S F
5769 @itemx F
5770 @kindex S F (Summary)
5771 @kindex F (Summary)
5772 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5773 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5774 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5775 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5776 process/prefix convention.
5777
5778 @item S n
5779 @kindex S n (Summary)
5780 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5781 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5782 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5783
5784 @item S N
5785 @kindex S N (Summary)
5786 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5787 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5788 message through mail and include the original message
5789 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5790 the process/prefix convention.
5791
5792 @item S o p
5793 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5794 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5795 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5796 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5797 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5798 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5799 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5800 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5801 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5802 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5803 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5804 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5805 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5806
5807 @item S O p
5808 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5809 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5810 @cindex digests
5811 @cindex making digests
5812 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5813 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5814 process/prefix convention.
5815
5816 @item S u
5817 @kindex S u (Summary)
5818 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5819 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5820 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5821 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5822 @end table
5823
5824 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5825 Manual}, for more information.
5826
5827
5828 @node Summary Message Commands
5829 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5830
5831 @table @kbd
5832 @item S y
5833 @kindex S y (Summary)
5834 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5835 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5836 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5837 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5838 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5839
5840 @end table
5841
5842
5843 @node Canceling and Superseding
5844 @subsection Canceling Articles
5845 @cindex canceling articles
5846 @cindex superseding articles
5847
5848 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5849 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5850
5851 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5852
5853 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5854 @kindex C (Summary)
5855 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5856 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5857 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5858 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5859 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5860 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5861
5862 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5863 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5864 question.
5865
5866 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5867 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5868 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5869
5870 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5871 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5872 message, Message Manual}).
5873
5874 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5875 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5876 your original article.
5877
5878 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5879 @kindex S (Summary)
5880 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5881 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5882 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5883 usual way.
5884
5885 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5886 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5887 have posted almost the same article twice.
5888
5889 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5890 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5891 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5892 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5893 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5894 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5895 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5896 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5897 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5898 canceled/superseded.
5899
5900 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5901
5902 @node Delayed Articles
5903 @section Delayed Articles
5904 @cindex delayed sending
5905 @cindex send delayed
5906
5907 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5908 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5909 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5910 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5911
5912 @lisp
5913 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5914 @end lisp
5915
5916 @findex gnus-delay-article
5917 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5918 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5919 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5920 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5921
5922 @itemize @bullet
5923 @item
5924 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5925 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5926 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5927 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5928
5929 @item
5930 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5931 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5932 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5933
5934 @item
5935 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5936 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5937 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5938 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5939 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5940 that means a time tomorrow.
5941 @end itemize
5942
5943 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5944 couple of variables:
5945
5946 @table @code
5947 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5948 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5949 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5950 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5951
5952 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5953 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5954 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5955 formats described above.
5956
5957 @item gnus-delay-group
5958 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5959 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5960 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5961 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5962
5963 @item gnus-delay-header
5964 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5965 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5966 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5967 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5968 @end table
5969
5970 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5971 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5972 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5973 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5974 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5975
5976 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5977 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5978 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5979 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5980 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5981 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5982 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5983
5984 @table @code
5985 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5986 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5987 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5988 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5989 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5990 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5991 argument is ignored.
5992
5993 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5994 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5995 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5996 @end table
5997
5998 When delaying an article with @kbd{C-c C-j}, Message mode will
5999 automatically add a @code{"Date"} header with the current time. In
6000 many cases you probably want the @code{"Date"} header to reflect the
6001 time the message is sent instead. To do this, you have to delete
6002 @code{Date} from @code{message-draft-headers}.
6003
6004
6005 @node Marking Articles
6006 @section Marking Articles
6007 @cindex article marking
6008 @cindex article ticking
6009 @cindex marks
6010
6011 There are several marks you can set on an article.
6012
6013 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
6014 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
6015 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
6016
6017 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
6018
6019 @ifinfo
6020 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
6021 @end ifinfo
6022
6023 @menu
6024 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6025 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6026 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6027 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6028 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6029 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6030 @end menu
6031
6032
6033 @node Unread Articles
6034 @subsection Unread Articles
6035
6036 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6037 other.
6038
6039 @table @samp
6040 @item !
6041 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6042 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6043
6044 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6045 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6046 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6047 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6048 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6049 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6050 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6051
6052 @item ?
6053 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6054 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6055
6056 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6057 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6058 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6059 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6060 messages.
6061
6062 @item SPACE
6063 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
6064 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6065
6066 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6067 @end table
6068
6069
6070 @node Read Articles
6071 @subsection Read Articles
6072 @cindex expirable mark
6073
6074 All the following marks mark articles as read.
6075
6076 @table @samp
6077
6078 @item r
6079 @vindex gnus-del-mark
6080 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6081 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6082
6083 @item R
6084 @vindex gnus-read-mark
6085 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6086
6087 @item O
6088 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6089 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6090 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6091
6092 @item K
6093 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
6094 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6095
6096 @item X
6097 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6098 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6099
6100 @item Y
6101 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6102 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6103
6104 @item C
6105 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6106 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6107
6108 @item G
6109 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6110 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6111
6112 @item Q
6113 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6114 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6115 Threading}.
6116
6117 @item M
6118 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6119 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6120 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6121
6122 @end table
6123
6124 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6125 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6126
6127 One more special mark, though:
6128
6129 @table @samp
6130 @item E
6131 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6132 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6133
6134 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6135 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6136 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6137 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6138 any time.
6139 @end table
6140
6141
6142 @node Other Marks
6143 @subsection Other Marks
6144 @cindex process mark
6145 @cindex bookmarks
6146
6147 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6148 read or not.
6149
6150 @itemize @bullet
6151
6152 @item
6153 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6154 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6155 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6156 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6157 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6158
6159 @item
6160 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
6161 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6162 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6163 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6164
6165 @item
6166 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6167 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6168 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6169
6170 @item
6171 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
6172 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6173 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6174
6175 @item
6176 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
6177 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6178 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6179 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6180
6181 @item
6182 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6183 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6184 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6185
6186 @item
6187 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6188 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6189 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6190 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6191 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6192 use.)
6193
6194 @item
6195 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6196 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6197 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6198 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6199 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6200 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6201
6202 @item
6203 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6204 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6205 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6206 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6207 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6208 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6209 use.)
6210
6211 @item
6212 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6213 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6214 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6215 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6216 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6217
6218 @item
6219 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6220 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6221 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6222 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6223 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6224 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6225
6226 @end itemize
6227
6228 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6229 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6230 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6231
6232 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6233 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6234 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6235
6236
6237 @node Setting Marks
6238 @subsection Setting Marks
6239 @cindex setting marks
6240
6241 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6242
6243 @table @kbd
6244 @item M c
6245 @itemx M-u
6246 @kindex M c (Summary)
6247 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6248 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6249 @cindex mark as unread
6250 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6251 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6252 article as unread.
6253
6254 @item M t
6255 @itemx !
6256 @kindex ! (Summary)
6257 @kindex M t (Summary)
6258 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6259 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6260 @xref{Article Caching}.
6261
6262 @item M ?
6263 @itemx ?
6264 @kindex ? (Summary)
6265 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6266 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6267 Mark the current article as dormant
6268 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6269
6270 @item M d
6271 @itemx d
6272 @kindex M d (Summary)
6273 @kindex d (Summary)
6274 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6275 Mark the current article as read
6276 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6277
6278 @item D
6279 @kindex D (Summary)
6280 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6281 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6282 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6283
6284 @item M k
6285 @itemx k
6286 @kindex k (Summary)
6287 @kindex M k (Summary)
6288 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6289 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6290 and then select the next unread article
6291 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6292
6293 @item M K
6294 @itemx C-k
6295 @kindex M K (Summary)
6296 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6297 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6298 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6299 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6300
6301 @item M C
6302 @kindex M C (Summary)
6303 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6304 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6305 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6306
6307 @item M C-c
6308 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6309 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6310 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6311 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6312
6313 @item M H
6314 @kindex M H (Summary)
6315 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6316 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6317 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6318
6319 @item M h
6320 @kindex M h (Summary)
6321 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6322 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6323 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6324
6325 @item C-w
6326 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6327 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6328 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6329 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6330
6331 @item M V k
6332 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6333 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6334 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6335 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6336
6337 @item M e
6338 @itemx E
6339 @kindex M e (Summary)
6340 @kindex E (Summary)
6341 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6342 Mark the current article as expirable
6343 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6344
6345 @item M b
6346 @kindex M b (Summary)
6347 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6348 Set a bookmark in the current article
6349 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6350
6351 @item M B
6352 @kindex M B (Summary)
6353 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6354 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6355 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6356
6357 @item M V c
6358 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6359 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6360 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6361 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6362
6363 @item M V u
6364 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6365 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6366 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6367 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6368
6369 @item M V m
6370 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6371 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6372 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6373 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6374 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6375 @end table
6376
6377 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6378 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6379 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6380 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6381 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6382 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6383 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6384 The default is @code{t}.
6385
6386
6387 @node Generic Marking Commands
6388 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6389
6390 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) to
6391 go to the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6392 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article.
6393 And even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6394 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6395 well.
6396
6397 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6398 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6399 command should do.
6400
6401 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6402 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6403 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6404 to list in this manual.
6405
6406 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6407 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6408 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6409 article, you could say something like:
6410
6411 @lisp
6412 @group
6413 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6414 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6415 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6416 @end group
6417 @end lisp
6418
6419 @noindent
6420 or
6421
6422 @lisp
6423 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6424 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6425 @end lisp
6426
6427
6428 @node Setting Process Marks
6429 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6430 @cindex setting process marks
6431
6432 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6433 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6434 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6435 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6436 articles into the cache. For more information,
6437 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6438
6439 @table @kbd
6440
6441 @item M P p
6442 @itemx #
6443 @kindex # (Summary)
6444 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6445 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6446 Mark the current article with the process mark
6447 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6448 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6449
6450 @item M P u
6451 @itemx M-#
6452 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6453 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6454 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6455 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6456
6457 @item M P U
6458 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6459 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6460 Remove the process mark from all articles
6461 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6462
6463 @item M P i
6464 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6465 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6466 Invert the list of process marked articles
6467 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6468
6469 @item M P R
6470 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6471 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6472 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6473 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6474
6475 @item M P G
6476 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6477 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6478 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6479 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6480
6481 @item M P r
6482 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6483 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6484 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6485
6486 @item M P g
6487 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6488 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6489 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6490
6491 @item M P t
6492 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6493 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6494 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6495 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6496
6497 @item M P T
6498 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6499 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6500 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6501 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6502
6503 @item M P v
6504 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6505 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6506 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6507 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6508
6509 @item M P s
6510 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6511 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6512 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6513
6514 @item M P S
6515 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6516 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6517 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6518 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6519
6520 @item M P a
6521 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6522 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6523 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6524
6525 @item M P b
6526 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6527 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6528 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6529 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6530
6531 @item M P k
6532 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6533 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6534 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6535 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6536
6537 @item M P y
6538 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6539 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6540 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6541 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6542
6543 @item M P w
6544 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6545 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6546 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6547 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6548
6549 @end table
6550
6551 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6552 set process marks based on article body contents.
6553
6554
6555 @node Limiting
6556 @section Limiting
6557 @cindex limiting
6558
6559 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6560 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6561 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6562 buffer.
6563
6564 Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
6565 the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
6566 articles.
6567
6568 @table @kbd
6569
6570 @item / /
6571 @itemx / s
6572 @kindex / / (Summary)
6573 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6574 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6575 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6576 matching articles.
6577
6578 @item / a
6579 @kindex / a (Summary)
6580 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6581 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6582 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6583 matching articles.
6584
6585 @item / R
6586 @kindex / R (Summary)
6587 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6588 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6589 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6590 matching articles.
6591
6592 @item / A
6593 @kindex / A (Summary)
6594 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6595 Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6596 header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6597 given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
6598
6599 @item / S
6600 @kindex / S (Summary)
6601 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6602 Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6603 threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6604 limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
6605
6606 @item / x
6607 @kindex / x (Summary)
6608 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6609 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6610 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6611 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6612 matching articles.
6613
6614 @item / u
6615 @itemx x
6616 @kindex / u (Summary)
6617 @kindex x (Summary)
6618 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6619 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6620 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6621 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6622 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6623
6624 @item / m
6625 @kindex / m (Summary)
6626 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6627 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6628 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6629
6630 @item / t
6631 @kindex / t (Summary)
6632 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6633 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6634 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6635 articles younger than that number of days.
6636
6637 @item / n
6638 @kindex / n (Summary)
6639 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6640 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6641 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6642 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6643
6644 @item / w
6645 @kindex / w (Summary)
6646 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6647 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6648 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6649 the stack.
6650
6651 @item / .
6652 @kindex / . (Summary)
6653 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6654 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6655 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6656
6657 @item / v
6658 @kindex / v (Summary)
6659 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6660 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6661 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6662
6663 @item / p
6664 @kindex / p (Summary)
6665 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6666 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6667 group parameter predicate
6668 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6669 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6670
6671 @item / r
6672 @kindex / r (Summary)
6673 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6674 Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6675 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6676 replied articles.
6677
6678 @item / E
6679 @itemx M S
6680 @kindex M S (Summary)
6681 @kindex / E (Summary)
6682 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6683 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6684 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6685
6686 @item / D
6687 @kindex / D (Summary)
6688 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6689 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6690 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6691
6692 @item / *
6693 @kindex / * (Summary)
6694 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6695 Include all cached articles in the limit
6696 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6697
6698 @item / d
6699 @kindex / d (Summary)
6700 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6701 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6702 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6703
6704 @item / M
6705 @kindex / M (Summary)
6706 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6707 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6708
6709 @item / T
6710 @kindex / T (Summary)
6711 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6712 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6713
6714 @item / c
6715 @kindex / c (Summary)
6716 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6717 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6718 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6719
6720 @item / C
6721 @kindex / C (Summary)
6722 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6723 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6724 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6725 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6726
6727 @item / b
6728 @kindex / b (Summary)
6729 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6730 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6731 certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6732 prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6733 requires selecting each article to find the matches.
6734
6735 @item / h
6736 @kindex / h (Summary)
6737 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6738 Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6739 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
6740
6741 @end table
6742
6743
6744 The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
6745 prefix as well.
6746
6747 @table @kbd
6748 @item / N
6749 @kindex / N (Summary)
6750 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6751 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6752 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6753
6754 @item / o
6755 @kindex / o (Summary)
6756 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6757 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6758 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6759
6760 @end table
6761
6762
6763 @node Threading
6764 @section Threading
6765 @cindex threading
6766 @cindex article threading
6767
6768 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6769 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6770 hierarchical fashion.
6771
6772 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6773 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6774 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6775 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6776 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6777 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6778 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6779
6780 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6781
6782 @table @dfn
6783 @item root
6784 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6785
6786 @item thread
6787 A tree-like article structure.
6788
6789 @item sub-thread
6790 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6791
6792 @item loose threads
6793 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6794 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6795 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6796 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6797 called loose threads.
6798
6799 @item thread gathering
6800 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6801
6802 @item sparse threads
6803 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6804 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6805
6806 @end table
6807
6808
6809 @menu
6810 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6811 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6812 @end menu
6813
6814
6815 @node Customizing Threading
6816 @subsection Customizing Threading
6817 @cindex customizing threading
6818
6819 @menu
6820 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6821 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6822 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6823 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6824 @end menu
6825
6826
6827 @node Loose Threads
6828 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6829 @cindex <
6830 @cindex >
6831 @cindex loose threads
6832
6833 @table @code
6834 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6835 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6836 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6837 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6838 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6839 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6840
6841 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6842 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6843 There are four possible values:
6844
6845 @iftex
6846 @iflatex
6847 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6848 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6849 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6850 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6851 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6852 }
6853 @end iflatex
6854 @end iftex
6855
6856 @cindex adopting articles
6857
6858 @table @code
6859
6860 @item adopt
6861 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6862 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6863 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6864 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6865
6866 @item dummy
6867 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6868 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6869 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6870 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6871 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6872 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6873 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6874 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6875 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6876 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6877
6878 @item empty
6879 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6880 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6881 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6882 Buffer Format}).)
6883
6884 @item none
6885 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6886 display them after one another.
6887
6888 @item nil
6889 Don't gather loose threads.
6890 @end table
6891
6892 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6893 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6894 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6895 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6896 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6897 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6898 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6899 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6900 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6901 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6902 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6903
6904 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6905 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6906 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6907 Matching}).
6908
6909 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6910 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6911 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6912 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6913 simplification is used.
6914
6915 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6916 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6917 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6918 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6919
6920 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6921 @lisp
6922 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6923 (concat
6924 "\\`\\[?\\("
6925 (mapconcat
6926 'identity
6927 '("looking"
6928 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6929 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6930 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6931 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6932 ;; ...
6933 )
6934 "\\|")
6935 "\\)\\s *\\("
6936 (mapconcat 'identity
6937 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6938 "\\|")
6939 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6940 @end lisp
6941
6942 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6943 subjects.
6944
6945 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6946 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6947 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6948 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6949 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6950 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6951
6952 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6953
6954 @table @code
6955 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6956 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6957 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6958
6959 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6960 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6961 Simplify fuzzily.
6962
6963 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6964 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6965 Remove excessive whitespace.
6966
6967 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6968 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6969 Remove all whitespace.
6970 @end table
6971
6972 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6973
6974
6975 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6976 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6977 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6978 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6979 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6980 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6981 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6982 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6983
6984 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6985 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6986 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6987 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6988 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6989 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6990 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6991 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6992 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6993 cholera:
6994
6995 @table @code
6996 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6997 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6998 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6999 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
7000
7001 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7002 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7003 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
7004 @end table
7005
7006 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
7007 something like:
7008
7009 @lisp
7010 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7011 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
7012 @end lisp
7013
7014 @end table
7015
7016
7017 @node Filling In Threads
7018 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
7019
7020 @table @code
7021 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
7022 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7023 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7024 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7025 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7026 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7027 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7028 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7029 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7030 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7031 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7032 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7033 do about that.
7034
7035 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7036 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7037 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7038
7039 The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7040
7041 @cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7042 This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7043 cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7044 that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7045 slow summary generation.
7046
7047 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7048 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7049 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7050 newsgroups.
7051
7052 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7053 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7054 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7055 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7056 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7057 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7058 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7059 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7060 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7061 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7062 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7063 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7064 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7065 @code{nil} by default.
7066
7067 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7068 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7069 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7070 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7071 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7072 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7073 web-based groups.
7074
7075 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7076 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7077 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7078
7079 @end table
7080
7081
7082 @node More Threading
7083 @subsubsection More Threading
7084
7085 @table @code
7086 @item gnus-show-threads
7087 @vindex gnus-show-threads
7088 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7089 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7090 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7091 slower and more awkward.
7092
7093 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7094 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7095 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7096 generated.
7097
7098 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7099 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7100 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7101
7102 Here's an example:
7103
7104 @lisp
7105 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7106 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7107 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7108 @end lisp
7109
7110 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7111 unread, but you get my drift.)
7112
7113
7114 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7115 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7116 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7117 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7118 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7119 threads are expunged.
7120
7121 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7122 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7123 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7124 will be hidden.
7125
7126 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7127 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7128 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7129 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7130 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7131 result in a new thread.
7132
7133 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
7134 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7135 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7136 The default is 4.
7137
7138 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7139 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7140 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7141 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7142 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7143 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7144 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7145 Setting this variable to an alternate value
7146 (e.g., @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7147 appropriate hook (e.g., @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7148 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7149
7150 @end table
7151
7152
7153 @node Low-Level Threading
7154 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7155
7156 @table @code
7157
7158 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7159 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7160 Hook run before parsing any headers.
7161
7162 @item gnus-alter-header-function
7163 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7164 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7165 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7166 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7167 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7168 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7169 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7170 meaningful. Here's one example:
7171
7172 @lisp
7173 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7174
7175 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7176 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7177 (when (string-match
7178 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7179 (mail-header-set-id
7180 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7181 header))))
7182 @end lisp
7183
7184 @end table
7185
7186
7187 @node Thread Commands
7188 @subsection Thread Commands
7189 @cindex thread commands
7190
7191 @table @kbd
7192
7193 @item T k
7194 @itemx C-M-k
7195 @kindex T k (Summary)
7196 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7197 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7198 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7199 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7200 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7201 articles instead.
7202
7203 @item T l
7204 @itemx C-M-l
7205 @kindex T l (Summary)
7206 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7207 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7208 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7209 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7210
7211 @item T i
7212 @kindex T i (Summary)
7213 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7214 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7215 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7216
7217 @item T #
7218 @kindex T # (Summary)
7219 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7220 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7221 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7222
7223 @item T M-#
7224 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
7225 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7226 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7227 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7228
7229 @item T T
7230 @kindex T T (Summary)
7231 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7232 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7233
7234 @item T s
7235 @kindex T s (Summary)
7236 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7237 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7238 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7239
7240 @item T h
7241 @kindex T h (Summary)
7242 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7243 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
7244
7245 @item T S
7246 @kindex T S (Summary)
7247 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7248 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
7249
7250 @item T H
7251 @kindex T H (Summary)
7252 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7253 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
7254
7255 @item T t
7256 @kindex T t (Summary)
7257 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7258 Re-thread the current article's thread
7259 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7260 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
7261
7262 @item T ^
7263 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
7264 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7265 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7266 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7267
7268 @item T M-^
7269 @kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7270 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7271 Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7272 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
7273
7274 @end table
7275
7276 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7277 understand the numeric prefix.
7278
7279 @table @kbd
7280
7281 @item T n
7282 @kindex T n (Summary)
7283 @itemx C-M-f
7284 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7285 @itemx M-down
7286 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7287 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7288 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7289
7290 @item T p
7291 @kindex T p (Summary)
7292 @itemx C-M-b
7293 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7294 @itemx M-up
7295 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7296 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7297 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7298
7299 @item T d
7300 @kindex T d (Summary)
7301 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7302 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7303
7304 @item T u
7305 @kindex T u (Summary)
7306 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7307 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7308
7309 @item T o
7310 @kindex T o (Summary)
7311 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7312 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7313 @end table
7314
7315 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7316 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7317 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7318 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7319 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7320 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7321 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7322 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7323 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7324 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7325 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7326 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7327 Matching}).
7328
7329
7330 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7331 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7332
7333 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7334 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7335 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7336 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7337 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7338 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
7339 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7340 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7341 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7342 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7343 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7344 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7345 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7346 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7347 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7348
7349 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7350 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7351 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7352 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7353 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7354 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7355 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7356 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7357 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7358 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7359
7360 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7361 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7362 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. Exceptions
7363 to this rule are @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number} and
7364 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date}.
7365
7366 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7367 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7368 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7369 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7370 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7371 ascending article order.
7372
7373 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7374 by number, you could do something like:
7375
7376 @lisp
7377 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7378 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7379 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7380 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7381 @end lisp
7382
7383 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7384 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7385 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7386 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7387 which the articles arrived.
7388
7389 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7390 say something like:
7391
7392 @lisp
7393 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7394 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
7395 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7396 @end lisp
7397
7398 By default, threads including their subthreads are sorted according to
7399 the value of @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}. By customizing
7400 @code{gnus-subthread-sort-functions} you can define a custom sorting
7401 order for subthreads. This allows for example to sort threads from
7402 high score to low score in the summary buffer, but to have subthreads
7403 still sorted chronologically from old to new without taking their
7404 score into account.
7405
7406 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7407 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7408 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7409 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7410 tickles your fancy.
7411
7412 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7413 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7414 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
7415 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7416 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7417 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7418 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7419 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7420 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
7421 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7422 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7423 variable. It is very similar to the
7424 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7425 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7426 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7427 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7428 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7429 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7430 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7431
7432 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7433 say something like:
7434
7435 @lisp
7436 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7437 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7438 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7439 @end lisp
7440
7441 You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7442 @xref{Group Parameters}.
7443
7444
7445 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7446 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7447 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7448 @cindex article pre-fetch
7449 @cindex pre-fetch
7450
7451 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7452 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7453 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7454 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7455 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7456
7457 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7458 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7459
7460 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7461 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7462 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7463 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7464 connection is blocked.
7465
7466 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7467 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7468 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7469 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7470
7471 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7472 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7473 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7474 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7475 extra connection.
7476
7477 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7478 you really want to.
7479
7480 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7481 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7482 happen automatically.
7483
7484 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7485 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7486 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7487 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7488 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7489 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7490 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7491
7492 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7493 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7494 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7495 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7496 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7497 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7498 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7499 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7500 article data structure as the only parameter.
7501
7502 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7503 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7504
7505 @lisp
7506 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7507 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7508 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7509 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7510 100)))
7511
7512 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7513 @end lisp
7514
7515 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7516 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7517 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7518
7519 @vindex gnus-async-post-fetch-function
7520 @findex gnus-html-prefetch-images
7521 After an article has been prefetched, this
7522 @code{gnus-async-post-fetch-function} will be called. The buffer will
7523 be narrowed to the region of the article that was fetched. A useful
7524 value would be @code{gnus-html-prefetch-images}, which will prefetch
7525 and store images referenced in the article, so that you don't have to
7526 wait for them to be fetched when you read the article. This is useful
7527 for @acronym{HTML} messages that have external images.
7528
7529 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7530 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7531 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7532 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7533
7534 @table @code
7535 @item read
7536 Remove articles when they are read.
7537
7538 @item exit
7539 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7540 @end table
7541
7542 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7543
7544 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7545 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7546 @c from the next group.
7547
7548
7549 @node Article Caching
7550 @section Article Caching
7551 @cindex article caching
7552 @cindex caching
7553
7554 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7555 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7556 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7557 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7558 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7559
7560 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7561
7562 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7563 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7564 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7565 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7566 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7567 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7568 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7569 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7570
7571 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7572 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7573 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7574 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7575 as dormant, and don't worry.
7576
7577 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7578
7579 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7580 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7581 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7582 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7583 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7584 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7585 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7586 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7587 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7588 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7589
7590 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7591 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7592 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7593 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7594 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7595 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7596 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7597 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7598 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7599 not then be downloaded by this command.
7600
7601 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7602 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7603 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7604 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7605 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7606 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7607
7608 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7609 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7610 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7611 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7612 variables, the group is not cached.
7613
7614 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7615 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7616 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7617 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7618 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7619 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7620 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7621 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7622 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7623 file.
7624
7625 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7626 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7627 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7628 where, isn't that cool?
7629
7630 @node Persistent Articles
7631 @section Persistent Articles
7632 @cindex persistent articles
7633
7634 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7635 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7636 useful in my opinion.
7637
7638 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7639 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7640 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7641 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7642 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7643 the expiry going on at the news server.
7644
7645 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7646 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7647 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7648
7649 @table @kbd
7650
7651 @item *
7652 @kindex * (Summary)
7653 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7654 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7655
7656 @item M-*
7657 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7658 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7659 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7660 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7661 article.
7662 @end table
7663
7664 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7665
7666 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7667 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7668 interested in persistent articles:
7669
7670 @lisp
7671 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7672 @end lisp
7673
7674 @node Sticky Articles
7675 @section Sticky Articles
7676 @cindex sticky articles
7677
7678 When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7679 according to the value of the variable
7680 @code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7681 default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7682 has its own article buffer.
7683
7684 This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7685 in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7686 latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
7687 your 17 cousins to coordinate the next Christmas party.
7688
7689 That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7690 basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7691 select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
7692
7693 @table @kbd
7694 @item A S
7695 @kindex A S (Summary)
7696 @findex gnus-sticky-article
7697 Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7698 name for this sticky article buffer.
7699 @end table
7700
7701 To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
7702
7703 @table @kbd
7704 @item q
7705 @kindex q (Article)
7706 @findex bury-buffer
7707 Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7708
7709 @item k
7710 @kindex k (Article)
7711 @findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7712 Kills this sticky article buffer.
7713 @end table
7714
7715 To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
7716
7717 @defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7718 Kill all sticky article buffers.
7719 If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7720 @end defun
7721
7722 @node Article Backlog
7723 @section Article Backlog
7724 @cindex backlog
7725 @cindex article backlog
7726
7727 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7728 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7729 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7730 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7731 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7732 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7733 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7734 increase memory usage some.
7735
7736 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7737 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7738 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7739 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7740 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7741 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7742 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7743
7744 The default value is 20.
7745
7746
7747 @node Saving Articles
7748 @section Saving Articles
7749 @cindex saving articles
7750
7751 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7752 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7753 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7754 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7755 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7756
7757 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7758 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7759 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7760
7761 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7762 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7763 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7764
7765 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7766 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7767 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7768 deleted before saving.
7769
7770 @table @kbd
7771
7772 @item O o
7773 @itemx o
7774 @kindex O o (Summary)
7775 @kindex o (Summary)
7776 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7777 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7778 Save the current article using the default article saver
7779 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7780
7781 @item O m
7782 @kindex O m (Summary)
7783 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7784 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7785 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7786
7787 @item O r
7788 @kindex O r (Summary)
7789 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7790 Save the current article in Rmail format
7791 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
7792 Babyl in older versions.
7793
7794 @item O f
7795 @kindex O f (Summary)
7796 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7797 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7798 Save the current article in plain file format
7799 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7800
7801 @item O F
7802 @kindex O F (Summary)
7803 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7804 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7805 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7806
7807 @item O b
7808 @kindex O b (Summary)
7809 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7810 Save the current article body in plain file format
7811 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7812
7813 @item O h
7814 @kindex O h (Summary)
7815 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7816 Save the current article in mh folder format
7817 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7818
7819 @item O v
7820 @kindex O v (Summary)
7821 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7822 Save the current article in a VM folder
7823 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7824
7825 @item O p
7826 @itemx |
7827 @kindex O p (Summary)
7828 @kindex | (Summary)
7829 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7830 @vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
7831 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7832 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7833 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7834 complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
7835 special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
7836 The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
7837 to a string containing the default command and options (default
7838 @code{nil}).
7839
7840 @item O P
7841 @kindex O P (Summary)
7842 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7843 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7844 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7845 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7846 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7847 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7848 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7849
7850 @end table
7851
7852 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7853 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7854 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7855 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7856 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7857 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7858 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7859 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7860 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7861 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7862 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7863 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7864 files.
7865
7866
7867 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7868 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7869 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7870 functions below, or you can create your own.
7871
7872 @table @code
7873
7874 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7875 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7876 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7877 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7878 This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
7879 23, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
7880 @dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
7881 Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
7882 of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
7883 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7884 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7885
7886 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7887 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7888 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7889 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7890 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7891 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7892
7893 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7894 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7895 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7896 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7897 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7898 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7899 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7900
7901 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7902 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7903 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7904 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7905 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7906 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7907
7908 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7909 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7910 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7911 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7912 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7913
7914 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7915 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7916 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7917 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7918 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7919 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7920
7921 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7922 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7923 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7924 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7925 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7926 @cindex rcvstore
7927 @cindex MH folders
7928 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7929 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7930 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7931 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7932 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7933
7934 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7935 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7936 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7937 reader to use this setting.
7938
7939 @item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7940 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7941 Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
7942 arguments COMMAND and RAW@. Valid values for COMMAND include:
7943
7944 @itemize @bullet
7945 @item a string@*
7946 The executable command name and possibly arguments.
7947 @item @code{nil}@*
7948 You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
7949 @item the symbol @code{default}@*
7950 It will be replaced with the command which the variable
7951 @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
7952 last used for saving.
7953 @end itemize
7954
7955 Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
7956 @code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
7957 headers will be piped.
7958 @end table
7959
7960 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7961
7962 @table @code
7963 @item :decode
7964 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7965 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7966 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7967 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
7968 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
7969 @code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
7970
7971 @item :function
7972 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7973 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7974 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7975 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7976 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7977 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7978
7979 @item :headers
7980 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7981 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7982 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7983 headers should be saved.
7984 @end table
7985
7986 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7987 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7988 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7989 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7990 default.
7991
7992 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7993 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7994 available functions that generate names:
7995
7996 @table @code
7997
7998 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7999 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
8000 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
8001
8002 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
8003 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
8004 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
8005
8006 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
8007 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
8008 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
8009
8010 @item gnus-plain-save-name
8011 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
8012 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
8013
8014 @item gnus-sender-save-name
8015 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
8016 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
8017 @end table
8018
8019 @vindex gnus-split-methods
8020 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
8021 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
8022 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
8023 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
8024 like:
8025
8026 @lisp
8027 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
8028 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
8029 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
8030 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8031 @end lisp
8032
8033 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8034 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8035 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8036 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8037 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8038 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8039 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8040 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8041 called returns a string or a list of strings.
8042
8043 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8044 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8045 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8046 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8047
8048 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8049 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8050 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8051 name.
8052
8053 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8054 lots of mail groups called things like
8055 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8056 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8057 following will do just that:
8058
8059 @lisp
8060 (defun my-save-name (group)
8061 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8062 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8063
8064 (setq gnus-split-methods
8065 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8066 (my-save-name)))
8067 @end lisp
8068
8069
8070 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8071 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8072 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8073 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8074 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8075 all the files in the top level directory
8076 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8077 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8078 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8079 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8080
8081 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8082 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8083 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8084 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8085 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8086 for kill files.
8087
8088 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8089 a spool, you could
8090
8091 @lisp
8092 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8093 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
8094 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8095 @end lisp
8096
8097 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8098 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8099 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8100 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8101
8102
8103 @node Decoding Articles
8104 @section Decoding Articles
8105 @cindex decoding articles
8106
8107 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8108 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8109
8110 @menu
8111 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8112 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8113 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8114 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8115 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8116 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8117 @end menu
8118
8119 @cindex series
8120 @cindex article series
8121 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8122 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8123 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8124 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8125 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8126
8127 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8128 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8129 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8130
8131 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8132 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8133 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8134
8135 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8136 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8137 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8138
8139
8140 @node Uuencoded Articles
8141 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
8142 @cindex uudecode
8143 @cindex uuencoded articles
8144
8145 @table @kbd
8146
8147 @item X u
8148 @kindex X u (Summary)
8149 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8150 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8151 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8152
8153 @item X U
8154 @kindex X U (Summary)
8155 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8156 Uudecodes and saves the current series
8157 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8158
8159 @item X v u
8160 @kindex X v u (Summary)
8161 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8162 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8163
8164 @item X v U
8165 @kindex X v U (Summary)
8166 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8167 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8168 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8169
8170 @end table
8171
8172 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8173 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8174 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8175 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8176 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8177
8178 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8179 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8180 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8181 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8182 @kbd{X u}.
8183
8184 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8185 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8186 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8187 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8188 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8189 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8190 off.
8191
8192
8193 @node Shell Archives
8194 @subsection Shell Archives
8195 @cindex unshar
8196 @cindex shell archives
8197 @cindex shared articles
8198
8199 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8200 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8201 some commands to deal with these:
8202
8203 @table @kbd
8204
8205 @item X s
8206 @kindex X s (Summary)
8207 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8208 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8209
8210 @item X S
8211 @kindex X S (Summary)
8212 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8213 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8214
8215 @item X v s
8216 @kindex X v s (Summary)
8217 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8218 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8219
8220 @item X v S
8221 @kindex X v S (Summary)
8222 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8223 Unshars, views and saves the current series
8224 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8225 @end table
8226
8227
8228 @node PostScript Files
8229 @subsection PostScript Files
8230 @cindex PostScript
8231
8232 @table @kbd
8233
8234 @item X p
8235 @kindex X p (Summary)
8236 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8237 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8238
8239 @item X P
8240 @kindex X P (Summary)
8241 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8242 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8243 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8244
8245 @item X v p
8246 @kindex X v p (Summary)
8247 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8248 View the current PostScript series
8249 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8250
8251 @item X v P
8252 @kindex X v P (Summary)
8253 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8254 View and save the current PostScript series
8255 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8256 @end table
8257
8258
8259 @node Other Files
8260 @subsection Other Files
8261
8262 @table @kbd
8263 @item X o
8264 @kindex X o (Summary)
8265 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8266 Save the current series
8267 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8268
8269 @item X b
8270 @kindex X b (Summary)
8271 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8272 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8273 doesn't really work yet.
8274
8275 @item X Y
8276 @kindex X Y (Summary)
8277 @findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8278 yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8279 @end table
8280
8281
8282 @node Decoding Variables
8283 @subsection Decoding Variables
8284
8285 Adjective, not verb.
8286
8287 @menu
8288 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8289 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8290 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8291 @end menu
8292
8293
8294 @node Rule Variables
8295 @subsubsection Rule Variables
8296 @cindex rule variables
8297
8298 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8299 variables are of the form
8300
8301 @lisp
8302 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8303 '(regexp2 command2)
8304 ...)
8305 @end lisp
8306
8307 @table @code
8308
8309 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8310 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8311 @cindex sox
8312 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8313 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8314 say something like:
8315 @lisp
8316 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8317 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8318 @end lisp
8319
8320 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8321 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8322 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8323 user and default view rules.
8324
8325 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8326 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8327 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8328 archives.
8329 @end table
8330
8331
8332 @node Other Decode Variables
8333 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
8334
8335 @table @code
8336 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8337
8338 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8339 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8340 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8341 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8342 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
8343
8344 @table @code
8345
8346 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
8347 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8348 View the file.
8349
8350 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
8351 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8352 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8353 @end table
8354
8355 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8356 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8357 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8358 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8359 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8360 time.
8361
8362 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8363 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8364 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
8365
8366 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8367 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8368 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8369 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8370 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
8371 kludgy.
8372
8373 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8374 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8375 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
8376
8377 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8378 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8379 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8380 looking for files to display.
8381
8382 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8383 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8384 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8385 after viewing it.
8386
8387 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8388 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8389 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8390 rules.
8391
8392 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8393 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8394 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8395 unpacking commands.
8396
8397 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8398 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8399 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8400 from articles.
8401
8402 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8403 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8404 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8405 decoded articles as unread.
8406
8407 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8408 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8409 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8410 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8411
8412 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8413 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8414 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8415
8416 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8417 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8418 @cindex metamail
8419 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8420 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8421 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8422 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8423
8424 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8425 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8426 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8427 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8428 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8429 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8430 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8431 simply dropped them.
8432
8433 @end table
8434
8435
8436 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8437 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8438
8439 @table @code
8440
8441 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8442 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8443 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8444 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8445 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8446 for you when you post the article.
8447
8448 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8449 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8450 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8451 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8452
8453 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8454 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8455 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8456 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8457 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8458 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8459 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8460
8461 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8462 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8463 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8464 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8465 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8466 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8467 Default is @code{t}.
8468
8469 @end table
8470
8471
8472 @node Viewing Files
8473 @subsection Viewing Files
8474 @cindex viewing files
8475 @cindex pseudo-articles
8476
8477 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8478 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8479 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8480 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8481 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8482 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8483 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8484
8485 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8486 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8487 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8488 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8489
8490 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8491 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8492 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8493
8494 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8495 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8496 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8497 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8498 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8499
8500 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8501 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8502 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8503 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8504 a list of parameters to that command.
8505
8506 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8507 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8508 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8509
8510 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8511 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8512 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8513
8514
8515 @node Article Treatment
8516 @section Article Treatment
8517
8518 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8519 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8520 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8521 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8522 these articles easier.
8523
8524 @menu
8525 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8526 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8527 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8528 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8529 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8530 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8531 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8532 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8533 * Article Display:: Display various stuff:
8534 X-Face, Picons, Gravatars, Smileys.
8535 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8536 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8537 @end menu
8538
8539
8540 @node Article Highlighting
8541 @subsection Article Highlighting
8542 @cindex highlighting
8543
8544 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8545 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8546
8547 @table @kbd
8548
8549 @item W H a
8550 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8551 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8552 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8553 Do much highlighting of the current article
8554 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8555 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8556
8557 @item W H h
8558 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8559 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8560 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8561 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8562 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8563 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8564 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8565 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8566 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8567 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8568 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8569 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8570
8571 @item W H c
8572 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8573 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8574 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8575
8576 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8577
8578 @table @code
8579 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8580
8581 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8582 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8583 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8584
8585 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8586 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8587 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8588
8589 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8590 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8591 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8592 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8593 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8594 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8595
8596 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8597 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8598 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8599
8600 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8601 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8602 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8603
8604 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8605 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8606 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8607 that it's a citation.
8608
8609 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8610 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8611 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8612
8613 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8614 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8615 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8616
8617 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8618 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8619 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8620 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8621
8622 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8623 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8624 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8625 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8626 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8627 is @code{t}.
8628
8629 @end table
8630
8631
8632 @item W H s
8633 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8634 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8635 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8636 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8637 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8638 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8639 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8640 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8641 default.
8642
8643 @end table
8644
8645 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8646
8647
8648 @node Article Fontisizing
8649 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8650 @cindex emphasis
8651 @cindex article emphasis
8652
8653 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8654 @kindex W e (Summary)
8655 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8656 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8657 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8658 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8659
8660 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8661 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8662 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8663 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8664 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8665 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8666 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8667 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8668 highlighting.
8669
8670 @lisp
8671 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8672 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8673 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8674 @end lisp
8675
8676 @cindex slash
8677 @cindex asterisk
8678 @cindex underline
8679 @cindex /
8680 @cindex *
8681
8682 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8683 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8684 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8685 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8686 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8687 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8688 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8689 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8690 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8691 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8692 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8693 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8694 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8695
8696 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8697 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8698 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8699 say something like:
8700
8701 @lisp
8702 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8703 @end lisp
8704
8705 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8706
8707 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8708 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8709 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8710 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8711
8712 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8713
8714
8715 @node Article Hiding
8716 @subsection Article Hiding
8717 @cindex article hiding
8718
8719 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8720 too much cruft in most articles.
8721
8722 @table @kbd
8723
8724 @item W W a
8725 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8726 @findex gnus-article-hide
8727 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8728 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8729 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8730
8731 @item W W h
8732 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8733 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8734 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8735 Headers}.
8736
8737 @item W W b
8738 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8739 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8740 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8741 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8742
8743 @item W W s
8744 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8745 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8746 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8747 Signature}.
8748
8749 @item W W l
8750 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8751 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8752 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8753 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8754 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8755 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8756 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8757 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8758
8759 @table @code
8760
8761 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8762 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8763 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8764 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8765
8766 @end table
8767
8768 @item W W P
8769 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8770 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8771 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8772 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8773
8774 @item W W B
8775 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8776 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8777 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8778 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8779 @cindex banner
8780 @cindex OneList
8781 @cindex stripping advertisements
8782 @cindex advertisements
8783 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8784 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8785 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8786 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8787 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8788 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8789 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8790 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8791 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8792 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8793 used.
8794
8795 For instance:
8796
8797 @lisp
8798 (setq gnus-article-banner-alist
8799 ((googleGroups .
8800 "^\n*--~--~---------\\(.+\n\\)+")))
8801 @end lisp
8802
8803 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8804 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8805 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8806
8807 @table @code
8808
8809 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8810 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8811 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8812 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8813 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8814 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8815 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8816 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8817 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8818 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8819 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8820
8821 @lisp
8822 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8823 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8824 @end lisp
8825
8826 @end table
8827
8828 @item W W c
8829 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8830 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8831 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8832 customizing the hiding:
8833
8834 @table @code
8835
8836 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8837 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8838 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8839 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8840 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8841 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8842 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8843 specs are valid:
8844
8845 @table @samp
8846 @item b
8847 Starting point of the hidden text.
8848 @item e
8849 Ending point of the hidden text.
8850 @item l
8851 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8852 @item n
8853 Number of lines of hidden text.
8854 @end table
8855
8856 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8857 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8858 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8859 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8860 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8861
8862 @end table
8863
8864 @item W W C-c
8865 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8866 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8867
8868 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8869 following two variables:
8870
8871 @table @code
8872 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8873 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8874 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8875 50), hide the cited text.
8876
8877 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8878 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8879 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8880 is hidden.
8881 @end table
8882
8883 @item W W C
8884 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8885 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8886 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8887 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8888 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8889 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8890
8891 @end table
8892
8893 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8894 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8895 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8896
8897 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8898 citation customization.
8899
8900 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8901 automatically.
8902
8903
8904 @node Article Washing
8905 @subsection Article Washing
8906 @cindex washing
8907 @cindex article washing
8908
8909 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8910 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8911
8912 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8913 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8914 Cleaner, perhaps.
8915
8916 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8917 articles by default.
8918
8919 @table @kbd
8920
8921 @item C-u g
8922 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8923 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8924 the server.
8925
8926 @item g
8927 Force redisplaying of the current article
8928 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8929 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8930 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8931 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8932
8933 @item W l
8934 @kindex W l (Summary)
8935 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8936 Remove page breaks from the current article
8937 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8938 delimiters.
8939
8940 @item W r
8941 @kindex W r (Summary)
8942 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8943 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8944 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8945 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8946 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8947 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8948
8949 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8950 positions in the alphabet, e.g., @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8951 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8952 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8953
8954 @item W m
8955 @kindex W m (Summary)
8956 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8957 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8958
8959 @item W i
8960 @kindex W i (Summary)
8961 @findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8962 Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8963 encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8964 unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8965 string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8966 (@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8967 to work.
8968
8969 @item W t
8970 @item t
8971 @kindex W t (Summary)
8972 @kindex t (Summary)
8973 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8974 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8975 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8976
8977 @item W v
8978 @kindex W v (Summary)
8979 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8980 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8981 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8982
8983 @item W o
8984 @kindex W o (Summary)
8985 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8986 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8987
8988 @item W d
8989 @kindex W d (Summary)
8990 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8991 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8992 @cindex Smartquotes
8993 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8994 @cindex Latin 1
8995 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8996 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8997 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8998 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8999 interactively.
9000
9001 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
9002 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
9003 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
9004 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
9005
9006 @item W U
9007 @kindex W U (Summary)
9008 @findex gnus-article-treat-non-ascii
9009 @cindex Unicode
9010 @cindex Non-@acronym{ASCII}
9011 Translate many non-@acronym{ASCII} characters into their
9012 @acronym{ASCII} equivalents (@code{gnus-article-treat-non-ascii}).
9013 This is mostly useful if you're on a terminal that has a limited font
9014 and doesn't show accented characters, ``advanced'' punctuation, and the
9015 like. For instance, @samp{»} is translated into @samp{>>}, and so on.
9016
9017 @item W Y f
9018 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
9019 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
9020 @cindex Outlook Express
9021 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
9022 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
9023 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
9024
9025 @item W Y u
9026 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
9027 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
9028 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
9029 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
9030 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9031 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9032 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9033 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9034 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9035 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9036
9037 @item W Y a
9038 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
9039 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9040 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9041 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9042
9043 @item W Y c
9044 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
9045 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9046 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9047 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9048
9049 @item W w
9050 @kindex W w (Summary)
9051 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9052 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9053
9054 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9055 when filling.
9056
9057 @item W Q
9058 @kindex W Q (Summary)
9059 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9060 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9061
9062 @item W C
9063 @kindex W C (Summary)
9064 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9065 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9066 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9067
9068 @item W c
9069 @kindex W c (Summary)
9070 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9071 Translate CRLF pairs (i.e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9072 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9073 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9074 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9075
9076 @item W q
9077 @kindex W q (Summary)
9078 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9079 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9080 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9081 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9082 makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9083 which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9084 done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9085 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9086 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9087
9088 @item W 6
9089 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
9090 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9091 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9092 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9093 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9094 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9095 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9096 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9097
9098 @item W Z
9099 @kindex W Z (Summary)
9100 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9101 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9102 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9103 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9104
9105 @item W A
9106 @kindex W A (Summary)
9107 @findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9108 @cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9109 Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9110 extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9111 sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9112
9113 @item W u
9114 @kindex W u (Summary)
9115 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9116 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9117 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9118 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9119 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9120
9121 @item W h
9122 @kindex W h (Summary)
9123 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
9124 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9125 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9126 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9127
9128 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9129 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9130 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9131
9132 The default is to use the function specified by
9133 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9134 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9135 @acronym{HTML}. Pre-defined functions you can use include:
9136
9137 @table @code
9138 @item shr
9139 Use Gnus simple html renderer.
9140
9141 @item gnus-w3m
9142 Use Gnus rendered based on w3m.
9143
9144 @item w3
9145 Use Emacs/W3.
9146
9147 @item w3m
9148 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9149
9150 @item w3m-standalone
9151 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9152
9153 @item links
9154 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9155
9156 @item lynx
9157 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9158
9159 @item html2text
9160 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9161
9162 @end table
9163
9164 @item W b
9165 @kindex W b (Summary)
9166 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9167 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9168 @xref{Article Buttons}.
9169
9170 @item W B
9171 @kindex W B (Summary)
9172 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9173 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9174 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9175
9176 @item W p
9177 @kindex W p (Summary)
9178 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9179 Verify a signed control message
9180 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9181 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9182 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9183 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9184 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9185 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9186
9187 @item W s
9188 @kindex W s (Summary)
9189 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9190 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9191 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
9192 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9193
9194 @item W a
9195 @kindex W a (Summary)
9196 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9197 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9198 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9199
9200 @item W E l
9201 @kindex W E l (Summary)
9202 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9203 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9204 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9205
9206 @item W E m
9207 @kindex W E m (Summary)
9208 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9209 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9210 lines with a single empty line.
9211 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9212
9213 @item W E t
9214 @kindex W E t (Summary)
9215 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9216 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9217 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9218
9219 @item W E a
9220 @kindex W E a (Summary)
9221 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9222 Do all the three commands above
9223 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9224
9225 @item W E A
9226 @kindex W E A (Summary)
9227 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9228 Remove all blank lines
9229 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9230
9231 @item W E s
9232 @kindex W E s (Summary)
9233 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9234 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9235 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9236
9237 @item W E e
9238 @kindex W E e (Summary)
9239 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9240 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9241 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9242
9243 @end table
9244
9245 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9246
9247
9248 @node Article Header
9249 @subsection Article Header
9250
9251 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9252
9253 @table @kbd
9254
9255 @item W G u
9256 @kindex W G u (Summary)
9257 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9258 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9259
9260 @item W G n
9261 @kindex W G n (Summary)
9262 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9263 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9264 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9265
9266 @item W G f
9267 @kindex W G f (Summary)
9268 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9269 Fold all the message headers
9270 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9271
9272 @item W E w
9273 @kindex W E w (Summary)
9274 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9275 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9276 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9277
9278 @end table
9279
9280
9281 @node Article Buttons
9282 @subsection Article Buttons
9283 @cindex buttons
9284
9285 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9286 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9287 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9288 button on these references.
9289
9290 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9291 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9292 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9293 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9294 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
9295
9296 @table @code
9297
9298 @item gnus-button-alist
9299 @vindex gnus-button-alist
9300 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
9301
9302 @lisp
9303 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9304 @end lisp
9305
9306 @table @var
9307
9308 @item regexp
9309 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9310 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9311 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9312 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9313 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
9314
9315 @item button-par
9316 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9317 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9318 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
9319
9320 @item use-p
9321 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9322 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9323 avoid false matches. Often variables named
9324 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9325 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
9326
9327 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
9328
9329 @item function
9330 This function will be called when you click on this button.
9331
9332 @item data-par
9333 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9334 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
9335
9336 @end table
9337
9338 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
9339
9340 @lisp
9341 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
9342 @end lisp
9343
9344 @item gnus-header-button-alist
9345 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9346 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9347 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9348 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
9349
9350 @lisp
9351 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9352 @end lisp
9353
9354 @var{header} is a regular expression.
9355 @end table
9356
9357 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
9358
9359 @table @code
9360 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9361 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
9362
9363 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
9364
9365 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
9366 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9367 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9368 default values of the variables above.
9369
9370 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
9371
9372 @item gnus-button-man-handler
9373 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9374 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9375 argument with a string naming the man page.
9376
9377 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9378
9379 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9380 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9381 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
9382
9383 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9384 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9385 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9386 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9387 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9388 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9389 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9390 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9391 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9392 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9393 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
9394 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9395
9396 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9397 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9398 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9399 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9400 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9401 string is invalid.
9402
9403 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9404 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9405 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9406 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9407
9408 @c Misc stuff
9409
9410 @item gnus-article-button-face
9411 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
9412 Face used on buttons.
9413
9414 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
9415 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9416 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
9417
9418 @end table
9419
9420 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9421
9422
9423 @node Article Button Levels
9424 @subsection Article button levels
9425 @cindex button levels
9426 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9427 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9428 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9429 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9430 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9431 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9432 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9433 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9434
9435 @lisp
9436 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9437 (setq gnus-parameters
9438 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9439 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9440 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9441 @end lisp
9442
9443 @table @code
9444
9445 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9446 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9447 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9448 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9449 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9450 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9451
9452 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9453 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9454 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9455 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9456 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9457 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9458 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9459 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9460 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9461 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9462 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9463 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9464 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9465
9466 @item gnus-button-man-level
9467 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9468 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9469 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9470
9471 @item gnus-button-message-level
9472 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9473 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9474 Related variables and functions include
9475 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9476 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9477 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9478 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9479
9480 @end table
9481
9482
9483 @node Article Date
9484 @subsection Article Date
9485
9486 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9487 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9488 when the article was sent.
9489
9490 @table @kbd
9491
9492 @item W T u
9493 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9494 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9495 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9496 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9497
9498 @item W T i
9499 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9500 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9501 @cindex ISO 8601
9502 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9503 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9504
9505 @item W T l
9506 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9507 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9508 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9509
9510 @item W T p
9511 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9512 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9513 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9514 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9515
9516 @item W T s
9517 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9518 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9519 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9520 @findex format-time-string
9521 Display the date using a user-defined format
9522 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9523 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9524 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9525 for a list of possible format specs.
9526
9527 @item W T e
9528 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9529 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9530 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9531 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9532 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9533 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9534
9535 @example
9536 Date: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9537 @end example
9538
9539 To make this line updated continually, set the
9540 @code{gnus-article-update-date-headers} variable to the frequency in
9541 seconds (the default is @code{nil}).
9542
9543 @item W T o
9544 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9545 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9546 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9547 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9548 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9549 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9550 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9551
9552 @end table
9553
9554 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9555 preferred format automatically.
9556
9557
9558 @node Article Display
9559 @subsection Article Display
9560 @cindex picons
9561 @cindex x-face
9562 @cindex smileys
9563 @cindex gravatars
9564
9565 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9566 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9567
9568 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9569 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9570
9571 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9572 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9573
9574 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9575 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9576
9577 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9578 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9579
9580 Gravatars reside on-line and are fetched from
9581 @uref{http://www.gravatar.com/} (@pxref{Gravatars}).
9582
9583 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9584 they'll be removed.
9585
9586 @table @kbd
9587 @item W D x
9588 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9589 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9590 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9591 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9592
9593 @item W D d
9594 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9595 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9596 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9597 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9598
9599 @item W D s
9600 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9601 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9602 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9603
9604 @item W D f
9605 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9606 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9607 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9608
9609 @item W D m
9610 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9611 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9612 Piconify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9613 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9614
9615 @item W D n
9616 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9617 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9618 Piconify all news headers (i.e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9619 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9620
9621 @item W D g
9622 @kindex W D g (Summary)
9623 @findex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
9624 Gravatarify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9625
9626 @item W D h
9627 @kindex W D h (Summary)
9628 @findex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
9629 Gravatarify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9630 (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9631
9632 @item W D D
9633 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9634 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9635 Remove all images from the article buffer
9636 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9637
9638 @item W D W
9639 @kindex W D W (Summary)
9640 @findex gnus-html-show-images
9641 If you're reading an @acronym{HTML} article rendered with
9642 @code{gnus-article-html}, then you can insert any blocked images in
9643 the buffer with this command.
9644 (@code{gnus-html-show-images}).
9645
9646 @end table
9647
9648
9649
9650 @node Article Signature
9651 @subsection Article Signature
9652 @cindex signatures
9653 @cindex article signature
9654
9655 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9656 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9657 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9658 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9659 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9660 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9661 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9662 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9663 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9664
9665 @lisp
9666 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9667 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9668 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9669 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9670 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9671 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9672 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9673 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9674 @end lisp
9675
9676 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9677 positives.
9678
9679 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9680 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9681 signature when displaying articles.
9682
9683 @enumerate
9684 @item
9685 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9686 that integer.
9687 @item
9688 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9689 than that number.
9690 @item
9691 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9692 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9693 @item
9694 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9695 in question is not a signature.
9696 @end enumerate
9697
9698 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9699 listed above. Here's an example:
9700
9701 @lisp
9702 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9703 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9704 @end lisp
9705
9706 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9707 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9708 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9709 signature after all.
9710
9711
9712 @node Article Miscellanea
9713 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9714
9715 @table @kbd
9716 @item A t
9717 @kindex A t (Summary)
9718 @findex gnus-article-babel
9719 Translate the article from one language to another
9720 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9721
9722 @end table
9723
9724
9725 @node MIME Commands
9726 @section MIME Commands
9727 @cindex MIME decoding
9728 @cindex attachments
9729 @cindex viewing attachments
9730
9731 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9732 instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9733
9734 @table @kbd
9735 @item b
9736 @itemx K v
9737 @kindex b (Summary)
9738 @kindex K v (Summary)
9739 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9740
9741 @item K o
9742 @kindex K o (Summary)
9743 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9744
9745 @item K O
9746 @kindex K O (Summary)
9747 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9748 from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9749 via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
9750
9751 @item K r
9752 @kindex K r (Summary)
9753 Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
9754
9755 @item K d
9756 @kindex K d (Summary)
9757 Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9758 removed part.
9759
9760 @item K c
9761 @kindex K c (Summary)
9762 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9763
9764 @item K e
9765 @kindex K e (Summary)
9766 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9767
9768 @item K i
9769 @kindex K i (Summary)
9770 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9771
9772 @item K |
9773 @kindex K | (Summary)
9774 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9775 @end table
9776
9777 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9778 the same manner:
9779
9780 @table @kbd
9781 @item K H
9782 @kindex K H (Summary)
9783 @findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
9784 View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
9785 Inline images embedded in a message using the @code{cid} scheme, as they
9786 are generally considered to be safe, will be processed properly. The
9787 message header is added to the beginning of every @acronym{HTML} part
9788 unless the prefix argument is given.
9789
9790 Warning: Spammers use links to images (using the @code{http} scheme) in
9791 @acronym{HTML} articles to verify whether you have read the message. As
9792 this command passes the @acronym{HTML} content to the browser without
9793 eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should only use it for mails from
9794 trusted senders.
9795
9796 If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
9797 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
9798
9799 This command creates temporary files to pass @acronym{HTML} contents
9800 including images if any to the browser, and deletes them when exiting
9801 the group (if you want).
9802
9803 @item K b
9804 @kindex K b (Summary)
9805 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9806 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9807 parts.
9808
9809 @item K m
9810 @kindex K m (Summary)
9811 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9812 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9813 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9814 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9815 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9816
9817 @item X m
9818 @kindex X m (Summary)
9819 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9820 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9821 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9822 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9823
9824 @item M-t
9825 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9826 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9827 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9828 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9829
9830 @item W M w
9831 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9832 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9833 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9834 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9835
9836 @item W M c
9837 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9838 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9839 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9840 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9841
9842 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9843 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9844 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9845 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9846 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9847 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9848
9849 @item W M v
9850 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9851 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9852 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9853 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9854
9855 @end table
9856
9857 Relevant variables:
9858
9859 @table @code
9860 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9861 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9862 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9863 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9864 @code{nil}.
9865
9866 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9867
9868 @lisp
9869 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9870 '("text/x-vcard"))
9871 @end lisp
9872
9873 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9874 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9875 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9876 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9877 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9878 default is @code{t}.
9879
9880 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9881 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9882 @cindex uuencode
9883 @cindex yEnc
9884 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9885 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9886 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9887 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9888 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9889 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9890 for encoding in Gnus.
9891
9892 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9893 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9894 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9895 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9896 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9897 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9898 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9899 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9900
9901 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9902 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9903 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9904 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9905 displayed. This variable overrides
9906 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9907 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9908 is @code{nil}.
9909
9910 E.g., to see security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9911 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9912 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9913
9914 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9915 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9916 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9917 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9918 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9919
9920 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9921 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9922 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9923 default value is @code{nil}.
9924
9925 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9926 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9927 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9928 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9929 users to gather information from the article (e.g., add Vcard info to
9930 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e.g., automatically
9931 save all jpegs into some directory).
9932
9933 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9934
9935 @lisp
9936 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9937 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9938 (with-temp-buffer
9939 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9940 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9941 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9942 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9943 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9944 @end lisp
9945
9946 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9947 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9948 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9949
9950 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9951 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9952 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9953
9954 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9955 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9956 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9957
9958 If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9959 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9960 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9961 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9962 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9963
9964 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9965 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9966 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9967 overrides @code{nil} values of
9968 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9969 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9970
9971 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9972 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9973 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9974 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9975
9976 Ready-made functions include@*
9977 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9978 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9979 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9980 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9981 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9982 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9983 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9984 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9985 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9986 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9987 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9988 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9989
9990 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9991 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9992
9993 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9994 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9995 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9996
9997 @lisp
9998 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9999 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
10000 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
10001 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
10002 @end lisp
10003
10004 @noindent
10005 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
10006
10007 @end table
10008
10009
10010 @node Charsets
10011 @section Charsets
10012 @cindex charsets
10013
10014 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
10015 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
10016 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
10017 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
10018 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
10019 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
10020 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
10021
10022 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10023 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10024 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10025 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10026
10027 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10028 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10029 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10030 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10031 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10032 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10033 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10034 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10035 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10036
10037 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10038 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10039 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10040 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10041 quoted-printable header encoding.
10042
10043 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10044 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10045 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10046
10047 @table @var
10048 @item test
10049 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10050 variable to query,
10051 @item header
10052 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10053 means encode all charsets),
10054 @item body-list
10055 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10056 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10057 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10058 @end table
10059
10060 @cindex Russian
10061 @cindex koi8-r
10062 @cindex koi8-u
10063 @cindex iso-8859-5
10064 @cindex coding system aliases
10065 @cindex preferred charset
10066
10067 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10068 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10069 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10070
10071 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10072
10073 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10074 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10075
10076 @lisp
10077 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10078 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10079 @end lisp
10080
10081 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10082 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10083
10084 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10085
10086 @lisp
10087 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10088 @end lisp
10089
10090 This will almost do the right thing.
10091
10092 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10093 something like
10094
10095 @lisp
10096 (codepage-setup 1251)
10097 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10098 @end lisp
10099
10100
10101 @node Article Commands
10102 @section Article Commands
10103
10104 @table @kbd
10105
10106 @item A P
10107 @cindex PostScript
10108 @cindex printing
10109 @kindex A P (Summary)
10110 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10111 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
10112 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10113 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10114 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10115 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10116
10117 @item A C
10118 @vindex gnus-fetch-partial-articles
10119 @findex gnus-summary-show-complete-article
10120 If @code{<backend>-fetch-partial-articles} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
10121 fetch partial articles, if the backend it fetches them from supports
10122 it. Currently only @code{nnimap} does. If you're looking at a
10123 partial article, and want to see the complete article instead, then
10124 the @kbd{A C} command (@code{gnus-summary-show-complete-article}) will
10125 do so.
10126
10127 @end table
10128
10129
10130 @node Summary Sorting
10131 @section Summary Sorting
10132 @cindex summary sorting
10133
10134 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10135 can't really see why you'd want that.
10136
10137 @table @kbd
10138
10139 @item C-c C-s C-n
10140 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10141 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10142 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10143
10144 @item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10145 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10146 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10147 Sort by most recent article number
10148 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
10149
10150 @item C-c C-s C-a
10151 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10152 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10153 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10154
10155 @item C-c C-s C-t
10156 @kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10157 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10158 Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10159
10160 @item C-c C-s C-s
10161 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10162 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10163 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10164
10165 @item C-c C-s C-d
10166 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10167 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10168 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10169
10170 @item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10171 @kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10172 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10173 Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
10174
10175 @item C-c C-s C-l
10176 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10177 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10178 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10179
10180 @item C-c C-s C-c
10181 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10182 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10183 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10184
10185 @item C-c C-s C-i
10186 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10187 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10188 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10189
10190 @item C-c C-s C-r
10191 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10192 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10193 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10194
10195 @item C-c C-s C-o
10196 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10197 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10198 Sort using the default sorting method
10199 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10200 @end table
10201
10202 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10203 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10204 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10205 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10206 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10207 Commands}).
10208
10209 If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
10210
10211
10212 @node Finding the Parent
10213 @section Finding the Parent
10214 @cindex parent articles
10215 @cindex referring articles
10216
10217 @table @kbd
10218 @item ^
10219 @kindex ^ (Summary)
10220 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10221 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10222 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10223 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10224 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10225 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10226 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10227 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10228 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10229
10230 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10231 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10232 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10233 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10234 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10235 article.
10236
10237 @item A R (Summary)
10238 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10239 @kindex A R (Summary)
10240 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10241 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10242
10243 @item A T (Summary)
10244 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10245 @kindex A T (Summary)
10246 Display the full thread where the current article appears
10247 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10248 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10249 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10250 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10251 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10252 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10253
10254 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10255 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i.e.,
10256 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10257 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10258 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10259 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10260
10261 @item M-^ (Summary)
10262 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10263 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
10264 @cindex Message-ID
10265 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
10266 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10267 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10268 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10269 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10270 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10271
10272 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10273 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10274 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10275 @end table
10276
10277 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10278 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10279 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10280 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10281 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10282 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10283 necessary.
10284
10285 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10286 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10287 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10288 match.
10289
10290 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10291 then ask Google if that fails:
10292
10293 @lisp
10294 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
10295 '(current
10296 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10297 @end lisp
10298
10299 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10300 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10301 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10302 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10303 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10304 group. @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
10305
10306 Fortunately, the special @code{nnregistry} back end is able to locate
10307 articles in any groups, regardless of their back end (@pxref{Registry
10308 Article Refer Method, fetching by @code{Message-ID} using the
10309 registry}).
10310
10311 @node Alternative Approaches
10312 @section Alternative Approaches
10313
10314 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10315 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
10316
10317 @menu
10318 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10319 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10320 @end menu
10321
10322
10323 @node Pick and Read
10324 @subsection Pick and Read
10325 @cindex pick and read
10326
10327 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10328 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10329 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10330 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
10331
10332 @findex gnus-pick-mode
10333 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10334 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10335 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10336 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10337 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
10338
10339 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
10340
10341 @table @kbd
10342 @item .
10343 @kindex . (Pick)
10344 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10345 Pick the article or thread on the current line
10346 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10347 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10348 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10349 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10350 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10351 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
10352
10353 @item SPACE
10354 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
10355 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
10356 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10357 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
10358
10359 @item u
10360 @kindex u (Pick)
10361 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10362 Unpick the thread or article
10363 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10364 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10365 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10366 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10367 the thread or article at that line.
10368
10369 @item RET
10370 @kindex RET (Pick)
10371 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10372 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10373 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10374 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10375 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10376 will still be visible when you are reading.
10377
10378 @end table
10379
10380 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10381 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10382 which is mapped to the same function
10383 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10384
10385 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
10386
10387 @lisp
10388 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
10389 @end lisp
10390
10391 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10392 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
10393
10394 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10395 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10396 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
10397
10398 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10399 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10400 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10401 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10402 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10403 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10404 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
10405
10406
10407 @node Binary Groups
10408 @subsection Binary Groups
10409 @cindex binary groups
10410
10411 @findex gnus-binary-mode
10412 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10413 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10414 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10415 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10416 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10417 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
10418
10419 @kindex g (Binary)
10420 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
10421 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10422 command, when you have turned on this mode
10423 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
10424
10425 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10426 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
10427
10428
10429 @node Tree Display
10430 @section Tree Display
10431 @cindex trees
10432
10433 @vindex gnus-use-trees
10434 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10435 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10436 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10437 in the tree buffer.
10438
10439 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
10440
10441 @table @code
10442 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10443 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10444 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
10445
10446 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10447 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10448 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10449 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10450 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
10451
10452 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
10453 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10454 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10455 default is @code{modeline}.
10456
10457 @item gnus-tree-line-format
10458 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10459 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10460 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10461 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10462 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10463 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
10464
10465 Valid specs are:
10466
10467 @table @samp
10468 @item n
10469 The name of the poster.
10470 @item f
10471 The @code{From} header.
10472 @item N
10473 The number of the article.
10474 @item [
10475 The opening bracket.
10476 @item ]
10477 The closing bracket.
10478 @item s
10479 The subject.
10480 @end table
10481
10482 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
10483
10484 Variables related to the display are:
10485
10486 @table @code
10487 @item gnus-tree-brackets
10488 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10489 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10490 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
10491 @example
10492 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10493 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10494 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10495 @end example
10496 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10497
10498 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10499 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10500 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10501 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10502
10503 @end table
10504
10505 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10506 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10507 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10508 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10509 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10510 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10511 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10512 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10513 other windows displayed next to it.
10514
10515 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10516 at all times:
10517
10518 @lisp
10519 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10520 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10521 @end lisp
10522
10523 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10524 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10525 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10526 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10527 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10528 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10529 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10530
10531 @end table
10532
10533 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10534
10535 @example
10536 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10537 | \[Jan]
10538 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10539 | \(***)-[Eri]
10540 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10541 \[Bjo]
10542 \[Gun]
10543 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10544 @end example
10545
10546 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10547
10548 @example
10549 @group
10550 @{***@}
10551 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10552 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10553 |--\-----\-----\ |
10554 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10555 | | |--\
10556 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10557 |
10558 [Paa]
10559 @end group
10560 @end example
10561
10562 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10563 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10564 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10565
10566 @lisp
10567 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10568 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10569 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10570 (gnus-add-configuration
10571 '(article
10572 (vertical 1.0
10573 (horizontal 0.25
10574 (summary 0.75 point)
10575 (tree 1.0))
10576 (article 1.0))))
10577 @end lisp
10578
10579 @xref{Window Layout}.
10580
10581
10582 @node Mail Group Commands
10583 @section Mail Group Commands
10584 @cindex mail group commands
10585
10586 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10587 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10588
10589 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10590 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10591
10592 @table @kbd
10593
10594 @item B e
10595 @kindex B e (Summary)
10596 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10597 @cindex expiring mail
10598 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10599 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10600 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10601 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10602
10603 @item B C-M-e
10604 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10605 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10606 @cindex expiring mail
10607 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10608 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10609 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10610 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10611
10612 @item B DEL
10613 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10614 @cindex deleting mail
10615 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10616 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10617 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10618 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10619 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10620
10621 @item B m
10622 @kindex B m (Summary)
10623 @cindex move mail
10624 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10625 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10626 Move the article from one mail group to another
10627 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10628 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10629
10630 @item B c
10631 @kindex B c (Summary)
10632 @cindex copy mail
10633 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10634 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10635 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10636 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10637 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10638
10639 @item B B
10640 @kindex B B (Summary)
10641 @cindex crosspost mail
10642 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10643 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10644 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10645 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10646 be properly updated.
10647
10648 @item B i
10649 @kindex B i (Summary)
10650 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10651 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10652 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10653 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10654
10655 @item B I
10656 @kindex B I (Summary)
10657 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10658 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10659 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10660 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10661
10662 @item B r
10663 @kindex B r (Summary)
10664 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10665 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10666 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10667 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10668 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10669 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10670 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10671 (which is the default).
10672
10673 @item B w
10674 @itemx e
10675 @kindex B w (Summary)
10676 @kindex e (Summary)
10677 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10678 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10679 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10680 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10681 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10682 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10683 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10684
10685 @item B q
10686 @kindex B q (Summary)
10687 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10688 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10689 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10690 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10691
10692 @item B t
10693 @kindex B t (Summary)
10694 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10695 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10696 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10697
10698 @item B p
10699 @kindex B p (Summary)
10700 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10701 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10702 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10703 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10704 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10705 article from your news server (or rather, from
10706 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10707 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10708 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10709 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10710 just not have arrived yet.
10711
10712 @item K E
10713 @kindex K E (Summary)
10714 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10715 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10716 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10717 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10718 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10719
10720 @end table
10721
10722 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10723 @cindex moving articles
10724 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10725 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10726 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10727 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10728 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10729 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10730 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10731
10732 @lisp
10733 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10734 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10735 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10736 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10737 @end lisp
10738
10739
10740 @node Various Summary Stuff
10741 @section Various Summary Stuff
10742
10743 @menu
10744 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10745 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10746 * Summary Generation Commands::
10747 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10748 @end menu
10749
10750 @table @code
10751 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10752 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10753 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10754 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10755 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10756 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10757
10758 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10759 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10760 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10761 current article.
10762
10763 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10764 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10765 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10766
10767 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10768 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10769 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10770 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10771 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10772 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10773 have been set.
10774
10775 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10776 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10777 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10778 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10779 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10780
10781 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10782 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10783 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10784 generated.
10785
10786 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10787 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10788 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10789 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10790 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10791 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10792 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10793 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10794 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10795 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10796
10797 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10798 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10799 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10800 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10801 list of articles to be selected.
10802
10803 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10804 the list in one particular group:
10805
10806 @lisp
10807 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10808 (if (string= group "some.group")
10809 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10810 articles))
10811 @end lisp
10812
10813 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10814 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10815 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10816 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10817 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10818 buffer is active.
10819
10820 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10821 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10822 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10823 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10824 variable will be used instead.
10825
10826 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10827 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10828 buffers. For example:
10829
10830 @lisp
10831 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10832 '(message-use-followup-to
10833 (gnus-visible-headers .
10834 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10835 @end lisp
10836
10837 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10838
10839 @end table
10840
10841
10842 @node Summary Group Information
10843 @subsection Summary Group Information
10844
10845 @table @kbd
10846
10847 @item H d
10848 @kindex H d (Summary)
10849 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10850 Give a brief description of the current group
10851 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10852 rereading the description from the server.
10853
10854 @item H h
10855 @kindex H h (Summary)
10856 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10857 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10858 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10859
10860 @item H i
10861 @kindex H i (Summary)
10862 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10863 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10864 @end table
10865
10866
10867 @node Searching for Articles
10868 @subsection Searching for Articles
10869
10870 @table @kbd
10871
10872 @item M-s
10873 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10874 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10875 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10876 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10877
10878 @item M-r
10879 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10880 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10881 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10882 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10883
10884 @item M-S
10885 @kindex M-S (Summary)
10886 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10887 Repeat the previous search forwards
10888 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
10889
10890 @item M-R
10891 @kindex M-R (Summary)
10892 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10893 Repeat the previous search backwards
10894 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
10895
10896 @item &
10897 @kindex & (Summary)
10898 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10899 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10900 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10901 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10902 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10903 search backward instead.
10904
10905 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10906 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10907
10908 @item M-&
10909 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10910 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10911 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10912 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10913 @end table
10914
10915 @node Summary Generation Commands
10916 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10917
10918 @table @kbd
10919
10920 @item Y g
10921 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10922 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10923 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10924
10925 @item Y c
10926 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10927 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10928 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10929 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10930
10931 @item Y d
10932 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10933 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10934 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10935 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10936
10937 @item Y t
10938 @kindex Y t (Summary)
10939 @findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10940 Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10941 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
10942
10943 @end table
10944
10945
10946 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10947 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10948
10949 @table @kbd
10950
10951 @item A D
10952 @itemx C-d
10953 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10954 @kindex A D (Summary)
10955 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10956 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10957 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10958 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10959 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10960 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10961 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10962 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10963 fashion.
10964
10965 @vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10966 The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10967 article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10968 include:
10969
10970 @table @code
10971 @item next
10972 Select the next article.
10973
10974 @item next-unread
10975 Select the next unread article.
10976
10977 @item next-noselect
10978 Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
10979
10980 @item next-unread-noselect
10981 Move the cursor to the next unread article.
10982 @end table
10983
10984 If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10985 article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
10986
10987 @item C-M-d
10988 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10989 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10990 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10991 several documents into one biiig group
10992 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10993 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10994 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10995 command understands the process/prefix convention
10996 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10997
10998 @item C-t
10999 @kindex C-t (Summary)
11000 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
11001 Toggle truncation of summary lines
11002 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
11003 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
11004 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
11005
11006 @item =
11007 @kindex = (Summary)
11008 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
11009 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
11010 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
11011
11012 @item C-M-e
11013 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
11014 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
11015 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11016 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
11017
11018 @item C-M-a
11019 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11020 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11021 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11022 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11023
11024 @end table
11025
11026
11027 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11028 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11029 @cindex summary exit
11030 @cindex exiting groups
11031
11032 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11033 group and return you to the group buffer.
11034
11035 @table @kbd
11036
11037 @item Z Z
11038 @itemx Z Q
11039 @itemx q
11040 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
11041 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
11042 @kindex q (Summary)
11043 @findex gnus-summary-exit
11044 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11045 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11046 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11047 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11048 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11049 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11050 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11051 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11052 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11053 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11054 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11055
11056 @item Z E
11057 @itemx Q
11058 @kindex Z E (Summary)
11059 @kindex Q (Summary)
11060 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11061 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11062 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11063
11064 @item Z c
11065 @itemx c
11066 @kindex Z c (Summary)
11067 @kindex c (Summary)
11068 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11069 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11070 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11071 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11072
11073 @item Z C
11074 @kindex Z C (Summary)
11075 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11076 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11077 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11078
11079 @item Z n
11080 @kindex Z n (Summary)
11081 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11082 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11083 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11084
11085 @item Z p
11086 @kindex Z p (Summary)
11087 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11088 Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11089 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11090
11091 @item Z R
11092 @itemx C-x C-s
11093 @kindex Z R (Summary)
11094 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11095 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11096 Exit this group, and then enter it again
11097 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11098 all articles, both read and unread.
11099
11100 @item Z G
11101 @itemx M-g
11102 @kindex Z G (Summary)
11103 @kindex M-g (Summary)
11104 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11105 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11106 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11107 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11108 articles, both read and unread.
11109
11110 @item Z N
11111 @kindex Z N (Summary)
11112 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
11113 Exit the group and go to the next group
11114 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11115
11116 @item Z P
11117 @kindex Z P (Summary)
11118 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11119 Exit the group and go to the previous group
11120 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11121
11122 @item Z s
11123 @kindex Z s (Summary)
11124 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11125 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11126 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11127 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11128 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11129 @end table
11130
11131 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11132 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11133 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11134 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11135
11136 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11137 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11138 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11139 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11140 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11141 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11142 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11143 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11144 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11145 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11146 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11147 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11148
11149 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11150
11151 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11152 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11153 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.)@: when you exit the
11154 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11155 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11156 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11157 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11158 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11159 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11160
11161
11162 @node Crosspost Handling
11163 @section Crosspost Handling
11164
11165 @cindex velveeta
11166 @cindex spamming
11167 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11168 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11169 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11170 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11171 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11172 heinous crime.
11173
11174 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11175 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11176 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11177 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11178 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11179
11180 @cindex cross-posting
11181 @cindex Xref
11182 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
11183 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11184 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11185 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11186 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11187 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11188 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11189 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11190 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11191 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11192 the cross reference mechanism.
11193
11194 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
11195 @cindex overview.fmt
11196 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11197 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11198 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11199 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11200 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11201 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11202 overview files.
11203
11204 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11205 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11206 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
11207
11208 C'est la vie.
11209
11210 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11211
11212
11213 @node Duplicate Suppression
11214 @section Duplicate Suppression
11215
11216 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11217 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11218 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11219 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11220 reasons.
11221
11222 @enumerate
11223 @item
11224 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11225 is evil and not very common.
11226
11227 @item
11228 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11229 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11230
11231 @item
11232 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11233 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11234
11235 @item
11236 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11237 @end enumerate
11238
11239 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11240 well, but these four are the most common situations.
11241
11242 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11243 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11244 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11245 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11246 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11247 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11248 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11249 once.
11250
11251 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11252 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11253 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11254 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11255 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11256 saw the article in.
11257
11258 @table @code
11259 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11260 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11261 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11262
11263 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11264 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11265 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11266 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11267 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11268 session are suppressed.
11269
11270 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11271 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11272 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11273 suppression list. The default is 10000.
11274
11275 @item gnus-duplicate-file
11276 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11277 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11278 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11279 @end table
11280
11281 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11282 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11283 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11284 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11285 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11286 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11287 to you to figure out, I think.
11288
11289 @node Security
11290 @section Security
11291
11292 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11293 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11294 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11295 things to work:
11296
11297 @enumerate
11298 @item
11299 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
11300 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG@. The Lisp interface
11301 to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
11302 epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
11303 PGG Manual}), and Mailcrypt are also supported.
11304
11305 @item
11306 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL@. OpenSSL 0.9.6
11307 or newer is recommended.
11308
11309 @end enumerate
11310
11311 The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
11312 messages include:
11313
11314 @table @code
11315 @item mm-verify-option
11316 @vindex mm-verify-option
11317 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11318 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11319 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11320
11321 @item mm-decrypt-option
11322 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
11323 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11324 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11325 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11326
11327 @item mm-sign-option
11328 @vindex mm-sign-option
11329 Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
11330 keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
11331
11332 @item mm-encrypt-option
11333 @vindex mm-encrypt-option
11334 Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
11335 public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
11336 @code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
11337
11338 @item mml1991-use
11339 @vindex mml1991-use
11340 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11341 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
11342 and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported although
11343 deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
11344 this order.
11345
11346 @item mml2015-use
11347 @vindex mml2015-use
11348 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11349 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
11350 @code{pgg}, and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported
11351 although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
11352 interface in this order.
11353
11354 @end table
11355
11356 By default the buttons that display security information are not
11357 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11358 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11359 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11360 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11361 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11362 how to customize these variables to always display security
11363 information.
11364
11365 @cindex snarfing keys
11366 @cindex importing PGP keys
11367 @cindex PGP key ring import
11368 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11369 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11370 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11371 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11372 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11373 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11374 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11375 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11376 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
11377
11378 @example
11379 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11380 @end example
11381 @noindent
11382 This happens to also be the default action defined in
11383 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
11384
11385 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11386 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11387 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
11388
11389 @node Mailing List
11390 @section Mailing List
11391 @cindex mailing list
11392 @cindex RFC 2396
11393
11394 @kindex A M (summary)
11395 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11396 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11397 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11398 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11399 summary buffer.
11400
11401 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
11402
11403 @table @kbd
11404
11405 @item C-c C-n h
11406 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11407 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11408 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
11409
11410 @item C-c C-n s
11411 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11412 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11413 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
11414
11415 @item C-c C-n u
11416 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11417 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11418 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11419 field exists.
11420
11421 @item C-c C-n p
11422 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11423 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11424 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
11425
11426 @item C-c C-n o
11427 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11428 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11429 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
11430
11431 @item C-c C-n a
11432 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
11433 @findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
11434 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
11435
11436 @end table
11437
11438
11439 @node Article Buffer
11440 @chapter Article Buffer
11441 @cindex article buffer
11442
11443 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11444 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11445 tell Gnus otherwise.
11446
11447 @menu
11448 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11449 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11450 * HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
11451 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11452 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11453 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
11454 @end menu
11455
11456
11457 @node Hiding Headers
11458 @section Hiding Headers
11459 @cindex hiding headers
11460 @cindex deleting headers
11461
11462 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11463 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
11464
11465 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11466 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11467 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11468 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11469 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11470 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11471 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11472 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11473 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
11474
11475 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
11476
11477 @table @code
11478
11479 @item gnus-visible-headers
11480 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
11481 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11482 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11483 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
11484
11485 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11486 the article and the subject, you'd say:
11487
11488 @lisp
11489 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
11490 @end lisp
11491
11492 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11493 remain visible.
11494
11495 @item gnus-ignored-headers
11496 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11497 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11498 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11499 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11500 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
11501
11502 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11503 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
11504
11505 @lisp
11506 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
11507 @end lisp
11508
11509 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11510 be removed.
11511
11512 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11513 variable will have no effect.
11514
11515 @end table
11516
11517 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11518 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11519 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11520 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11521 the headers are to be displayed.
11522
11523 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11524 and then the subject, you might say something like:
11525
11526 @lisp
11527 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11528 @end lisp
11529
11530 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11531 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
11532
11533 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11534 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11535 You can hide further boring headers by setting
11536 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11537 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11538 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11539 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11540 from sight.
11541
11542 These conditions are:
11543 @table @code
11544 @item empty
11545 Remove all empty headers.
11546 @item followup-to
11547 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11548 @code{Newsgroups} header.
11549 @item reply-to
11550 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11551 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11552 parameter is set.
11553 @item newsgroups
11554 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11555 name.
11556 @item to-address
11557 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11558 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11559 @item to-list
11560 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11561 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11562 @item cc-list
11563 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11564 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11565 @item date
11566 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11567 old.
11568 @item long-to
11569 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11570 @item many-to
11571 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11572 @end table
11573
11574 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11575
11576 @lisp
11577 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11578 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11579 @end lisp
11580
11581 This is also the default value for this variable.
11582
11583
11584 @node Using MIME
11585 @section Using MIME
11586 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11587
11588 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11589 while people stand around yawning.
11590
11591 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11592 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11593
11594 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11595 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11596 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11597
11598 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11599 @findex gnus-display-mime
11600 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11601 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11602 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11603 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11604
11605 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11606 @acronym{MIME} button:
11607
11608 @table @kbd
11609 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11610 @item RET (Article)
11611 @kindex RET (Article)
11612 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11613 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11614 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11615 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11616 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11617 object is displayed inline.
11618
11619 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11620 @item M-RET (Article)
11621 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11622 @itemx v (Article)
11623 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11624 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11625
11626 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11627 @item t (Article)
11628 @kindex t (Article)
11629 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11630 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11631
11632 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11633 @item C (Article)
11634 @kindex C (Article)
11635 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11636 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11637
11638 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11639 @item o (Article)
11640 @kindex o (Article)
11641 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11642 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11643
11644 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11645 @item C-o (Article)
11646 @kindex C-o (Article)
11647 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11648 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11649 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11650 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11651 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11652 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11653
11654 @findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11655 @item r (Article)
11656 @kindex r (Article)
11657 Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
11658 external body referring to the file via the message/external-body
11659 @acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
11660
11661 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11662 @item d (Article)
11663 @kindex d (Article)
11664 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11665 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11666 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11667
11668 @c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
11669
11670 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11671 @item c (Article)
11672 @kindex c (Article)
11673 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11674 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11675 without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11676 charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11677 @ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11678 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11679 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11680 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11681
11682 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11683 @item p (Article)
11684 @kindex p (Article)
11685 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11686 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11687 @file{.mailcap} file.
11688
11689 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11690 @item i (Article)
11691 @kindex i (Article)
11692 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11693 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11694 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11695 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11696 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11697 Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11698 automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11699 @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11700 Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11701
11702 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11703 @item E (Article)
11704 @kindex E (Article)
11705 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11706 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11707 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11708
11709 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11710 @item e (Article)
11711 @kindex e (Article)
11712 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11713 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11714
11715 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11716 @item | (Article)
11717 @kindex | (Article)
11718 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11719
11720 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11721 @item . (Article)
11722 @kindex . (Article)
11723 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11724 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11725
11726 @end table
11727
11728 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11729 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11730 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11731
11732 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11733 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11734 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11735 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11736 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11737 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11738 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11739 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11740 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11741
11742 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11743
11744 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11745
11746
11747 @node HTML
11748 @section @acronym{HTML}
11749 @cindex @acronym{HTML}
11750
11751 If you have @code{w3m} installed on your system, Gnus can display
11752 @acronym{HTML} articles in the article buffer. There are many Gnus
11753 add-ons for doing this, using various approaches, but there's one
11754 (sort of) built-in method that's used by default.
11755
11756 For a complete overview, consult @xref{Display Customization,
11757 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. This
11758 section only describes the default method.
11759
11760 @table @code
11761 @item mm-text-html-renderer
11762 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
11763 If set to @code{gnus-article-html}, Gnus will use the built-in method,
11764 that's based on @code{w3m}.
11765
11766 @item gnus-blocked-images
11767 @vindex gnus-blocked-images
11768 External images that have @acronym{URL}s that match this regexp won't
11769 be fetched and displayed. For instance, do block all @acronym{URL}s
11770 that have the string ``ads'' in them, do the following:
11771
11772 @lisp
11773 (setq gnus-blocked-images "ads")
11774 @end lisp
11775
11776 This can also be a function to be evaluated. If so, it will be
11777 called with the group name as the parameter. The default value is
11778 @code{gnus-block-private-groups}, which will return @samp{"."} for
11779 anything that isn't a newsgroup. This means that no external images
11780 will be fetched as a result of reading mail, so that nobody can use
11781 web bugs (and the like) to track whether you've read email.
11782
11783 Also @pxref{Misc Article} for @code{gnus-inhibit-images}.
11784
11785 @item gnus-html-cache-directory
11786 @vindex gnus-html-cache-directory
11787 Gnus will download and cache images according to how
11788 @code{gnus-blocked-images} is set. These images will be stored in
11789 this directory.
11790
11791 @item gnus-html-cache-size
11792 @vindex gnus-html-cache-size
11793 When @code{gnus-html-cache-size} bytes have been used in that
11794 directory, the oldest files will be deleted. The default is 500MB.
11795
11796 @item gnus-html-frame-width
11797 @vindex gnus-html-frame-width
11798 The width to use when rendering HTML@. The default is 70.
11799
11800 @item gnus-max-image-proportion
11801 @vindex gnus-max-image-proportion
11802 How big pictures displayed are in relation to the window they're in.
11803 A value of 0.7 (the default) means that they are allowed to take up
11804 70% of the width and height of the window. If they are larger than
11805 this, and Emacs supports it, then the images will be rescaled down to
11806 fit these criteria.
11807
11808 @end table
11809
11810 To use this, make sure that you have @code{w3m} and @code{curl}
11811 installed. If you have, then Gnus should display @acronym{HTML}
11812 automatically.
11813
11814
11815
11816 @node Customizing Articles
11817 @section Customizing Articles
11818 @cindex article customization
11819
11820 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11821 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11822 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11823 called automatically when you select the articles.
11824
11825 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11826 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11827 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11828 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11829
11830 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11831 for sensible values.
11832
11833 @enumerate
11834 @item
11835 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11836
11837 @item
11838 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11839
11840 @item
11841 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11842
11843 @item
11844 @code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
11845
11846 @item
11847 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
11848
11849 @item
11850 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11851 than this number.
11852
11853 @item
11854 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11855 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11856 regexps in the list.
11857
11858 @item
11859 A list where the first element is not a string:
11860
11861 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11862 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11863 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11864
11865 @lisp
11866 (or last
11867 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11868 @end lisp
11869
11870 @item
11871 A function: the function is called with no arguments and should return
11872 @code{nil} or non-@code{nil}. The current article is available in the
11873 buffer named by @code{gnus-article-buffer}.
11874
11875 @end enumerate
11876
11877 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11878 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11879 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11880 considered to contain just a single part.
11881
11882 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11883 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11884 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11885 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11886 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11887 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11888 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11889
11890 @ifinfo
11891 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11892 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11893 @c `i foo-bar'.
11894 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11895 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11896 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11897 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11898 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11899 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11900 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11901 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11902 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11903 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11904 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11905 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11906 @vindex gnus-treat-date
11907 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11908 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11909 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11910 @vindex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
11911 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
11912 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11913 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11914 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11915 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11916 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11917 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11918 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11919 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11920 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11921 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11922 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11923 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11924 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11925 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11926 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11927 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11928 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11929 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11930 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11931 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11932 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11933 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11934 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11935 @end ifinfo
11936
11937 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11938 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11939 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11940 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11941
11942 @table @code
11943 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11944 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11945
11946 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11947
11948 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11949 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11950 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11951 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11952 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
11953 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11954 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11955 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11956 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11957 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11958
11959 @xref{Article Washing}.
11960
11961 @item gnus-treat-date (head)
11962
11963 This will transform/add date headers according to the
11964 @code{gnus-article-date-headers} variable. This is a list of Date
11965 headers to display. The formats available are:
11966
11967 @table @code
11968 @item ut
11969 Universal time, aka GMT, aka ZULU.
11970
11971 @item local
11972 The user's local time zone.
11973
11974 @item english
11975 A semi-readable English sentence.
11976
11977 @item lapsed
11978 The time elapsed since the message was posted.
11979
11980 @item combined-lapsed
11981 Both the original date header and a (shortened) elapsed time.
11982
11983 @item original
11984 The original date header.
11985
11986 @item iso8601
11987 ISO8601 format, i.e., ``2010-11-23T22:05:21''.
11988
11989 @item user-defined
11990 A format done according to the @code{gnus-article-time-format}
11991 variable.
11992
11993 @end table
11994
11995 @xref{Article Date}.
11996
11997 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11998 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11999 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
12000
12001 @xref{Picons}.
12002
12003 @item gnus-treat-from-gravatar (head)
12004 @item gnus-treat-mail-gravatar (head)
12005
12006 @xref{Gravatars}.
12007
12008 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
12009
12010 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
12011
12012 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
12013 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
12014 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
12015
12016 @xref{Smileys}.
12017
12018 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
12019 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
12020
12021 @xref{X-Face}.
12022
12023 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12024 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
12025
12026 @xref{Face}.
12027
12028 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12029 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12030 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12031 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12032 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12033 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12034 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12035 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12036 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12037 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12038 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12039 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12040 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12041 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12042 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12043 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12044 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12045 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12046 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12047 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12048
12049 @xref{Article Hiding}.
12050
12051 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12052 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12053 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12054 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12055 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12056 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12057
12058 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
12059
12060 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12061 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12062 @item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12063 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12064 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12065
12066 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12067 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12068 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12069 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12070 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12071 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12072 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12073 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12074
12075 @xref{Article Header}.
12076
12077
12078 @end table
12079
12080 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12081 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12082 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12083 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12084 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12085 everything.
12086
12087
12088 @node Article Keymap
12089 @section Article Keymap
12090
12091 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12092 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12093 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12094 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12095 buffer.
12096
12097 @kindex v (Article)
12098 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12099 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12100 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12101
12102 A few additional keystrokes are available:
12103
12104 @table @kbd
12105
12106 @item SPACE
12107 @kindex SPACE (Article)
12108 @findex gnus-article-next-page
12109 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12110 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12111
12112 @item DEL
12113 @kindex DEL (Article)
12114 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
12115 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12116 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12117
12118 @item C-c ^
12119 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12120 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
12121 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12122 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12123 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12124
12125 @item C-c C-m
12126 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12127 @findex gnus-article-mail
12128 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12129 given a prefix, include the mail.
12130
12131 @item s
12132 @kindex s (Article)
12133 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
12134 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12135 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12136
12137 @item ?
12138 @kindex ? (Article)
12139 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12140 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12141 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12142
12143 @item TAB
12144 @kindex TAB (Article)
12145 @findex gnus-article-next-button
12146 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12147 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12148
12149 @item M-TAB
12150 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
12151 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
12152 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12153
12154 @item R
12155 @kindex R (Article)
12156 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12157 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12158 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12159 only yank the text in the region.
12160
12161 @item S W
12162 @kindex S W (Article)
12163 @findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12164 Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12165 (@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12166 active, only yank the text in the region.
12167
12168 @item F
12169 @kindex F (Article)
12170 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12171 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12172 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12173 only yank the text in the region.
12174
12175
12176 @end table
12177
12178
12179 @node Misc Article
12180 @section Misc Article
12181
12182 @table @code
12183
12184 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
12185 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12186 @cindex article buffers, several
12187 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12188 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12189 article buffer.
12190
12191 @item gnus-widen-article-window
12192 @cindex gnus-widen-article-window
12193 If non-@code{nil}, selecting the article buffer with the @kbd{h}
12194 command will ``widen'' the article window to take the entire frame.
12195
12196 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12197 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
12198 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
12199 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12200 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12201
12202 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12203 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12204 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12205 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12206 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12207 the contents of the article buffer.
12208
12209 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
12210 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12211 Hook called in article mode buffers.
12212
12213 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12214 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12215 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12216 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12217
12218 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12219 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
12220 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12221 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12222
12223 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12224 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12225 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12226 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12227 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12228 with two extensions:
12229
12230 @table @samp
12231
12232 @item w
12233 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12234 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12235 performed. The characters and their meaning:
12236
12237 @table @samp
12238
12239 @item c
12240 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12241
12242 @item h
12243 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12244
12245 @item p
12246 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12247 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12248 security status, i.e., good or bad signature.)
12249
12250 @item s
12251 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12252
12253 @item o
12254 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12255
12256 @item e
12257 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
12258
12259 @end table
12260
12261 @item m
12262 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12263
12264 @end table
12265
12266 @vindex gnus-break-pages
12267
12268 @item gnus-break-pages
12269 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12270 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12271 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12272 paging will not be done.
12273
12274 @item gnus-page-delimiter
12275 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12276 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12277 (formfeed).
12278
12279 @cindex IDNA
12280 @cindex internationalized domain names
12281 @vindex gnus-use-idna
12282 @item gnus-use-idna
12283 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12284 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12285 @samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12286 for how to compose such messages. This requires
12287 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12288 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12289
12290 @vindex gnus-inhibit-images
12291 @item gnus-inhibit-images
12292 If this is non-@code{nil}, inhibit displaying of images inline in the
12293 article body. It is effective to images that are in articles as
12294 @acronym{MIME} parts, and images in @acronym{HTML} articles rendered
12295 when @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization,
12296 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) is
12297 @code{shr} or @code{gnus-w3m}.
12298
12299 @end table
12300
12301
12302 @node Composing Messages
12303 @chapter Composing Messages
12304 @cindex composing messages
12305 @cindex messages
12306 @cindex mail
12307 @cindex sending mail
12308 @cindex reply
12309 @cindex followup
12310 @cindex post
12311 @cindex using gpg
12312 @cindex using s/mime
12313 @cindex using smime
12314
12315 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12316 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12317 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12318 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12319 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12320 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12321
12322 @menu
12323 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12324 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12325 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12326 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12327 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12328 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12329 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12330 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12331 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12332 @end menu
12333
12334 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12335 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12336
12337
12338 @node Mail
12339 @section Mail
12340
12341 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12342
12343 @table @code
12344 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12345 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12346 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12347 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12348 @code{nil} include all headers.
12349
12350 @item gnus-add-to-list
12351 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
12352 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12353 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12354
12355 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12356 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12357 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12358 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12359 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12360 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12361 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12362 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12363
12364 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12365 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12366
12367 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12368 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12369 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12370 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12371 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12372
12373 @end table
12374
12375
12376 @node Posting Server
12377 @section Posting Server
12378
12379 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12380 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12381
12382 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12383
12384 It can be quite complicated.
12385
12386 @vindex gnus-post-method
12387 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12388 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12389 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12390 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12391 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12392 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12393 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12394 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12395 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12396
12397 @lisp
12398 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12399 @end lisp
12400
12401 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12402 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12403 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12404 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12405
12406 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12407 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12408
12409 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12410 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12411 for posting.
12412
12413 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12414 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
12415
12416 @vindex message-send-mail-function
12417 When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12418 variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12419 value suitable for your system.
12420 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12421 information.
12422
12423
12424 @node POP before SMTP
12425 @section POP before SMTP
12426 @cindex pop before smtp
12427 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
12428
12429 Does your @acronym{ISP} use @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12430 authentication? This authentication method simply requires you to
12431 contact the @acronym{POP} server before sending email. To do that,
12432 put the following lines in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
12433
12434 @lisp
12435 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12436 @end lisp
12437
12438 @noindent
12439 The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function does @acronym{POP}
12440 authentication according to the value of @code{mail-sources} without
12441 fetching mails, just before sending a mail. @xref{Mail Sources}.
12442
12443 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12444 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12445 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12446 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12447 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12448 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
12449
12450 @lisp
12451 (setq mail-source-primary-source
12452 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12453 :password "secret"))
12454 @end lisp
12455
12456 @noindent
12457 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12458 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
12459
12460 @lisp
12461 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12462 (lambda ()
12463 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12464 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12465 :password "secret")))
12466 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
12467 @end lisp
12468
12469
12470 @node Mail and Post
12471 @section Mail and Post
12472
12473 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12474 posting:
12475
12476 @table @code
12477 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12478 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12479 @cindex mailing lists
12480
12481 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12482 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12483 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12484 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12485 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12486 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12487 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12488 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12489 still a pain, though.
12490
12491 @item gnus-user-agent
12492 @vindex gnus-user-agent
12493 @cindex User-Agent
12494
12495 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12496 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12497 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12498 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12499 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12500 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12501 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
12502
12503 @end table
12504
12505 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12506 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12507 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
12508
12509 @cindex ispell
12510 @findex ispell-message
12511 @lisp
12512 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12513 @end lisp
12514
12515 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12516 you're in, you could say something like the following:
12517
12518 @lisp
12519 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12520 (lambda ()
12521 (cond
12522 ((string-match
12523 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12524 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12525 (t
12526 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12527 @end lisp
12528
12529 Modify to suit your needs.
12530
12531 @vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12532 If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
12533 citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12534 mode buffers.
12535
12536 @node Archived Messages
12537 @section Archived Messages
12538 @cindex archived messages
12539 @cindex sent messages
12540
12541 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12542 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12543 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
12544 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}. The
12545 default is "sent.%Y-%m", which gives you one archive group per month.
12546
12547 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12548 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12549 Group Commands}).
12550
12551 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12552 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
12553 use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12554 actually being used it is expanded into:
12555
12556 @lisp
12557 (nnfolder "archive"
12558 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12559 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12560 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12561 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12562 @end lisp
12563
12564 @quotation
12565 @vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12566 Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12567 so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12568 @code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12569 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12570 since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12571 even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12572 afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12573 mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12574 saved method to reflect always the value of
12575 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12576 @code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12577 value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12578 @end quotation
12579
12580 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12581 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12582 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12583 directory chosen, you could say something like:
12584
12585 @lisp
12586 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
12587 '(nnfolder "archive"
12588 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12589 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12590 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12591 @end lisp
12592
12593 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12594 @cindex Gcc
12595 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12596 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12597 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
12598
12599 This variable can be used to do the following:
12600
12601 @table @asis
12602 @item a string
12603 Messages will be saved in that group.
12604
12605 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12606 message will not be stored in the select method given by
12607 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12608 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12609 has the default value shown above. Then setting
12610 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12611 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12612 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12613 @samp{nnml:foo}.
12614
12615 @item a list of strings
12616 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
12617
12618 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12619 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
12620
12621 @item @code{nil}
12622 No message archiving will take place.
12623 @end table
12624
12625 Let's illustrate:
12626
12627 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12628 @lisp
12629 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12630 @end lisp
12631
12632 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12633 @lisp
12634 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12635 @end lisp
12636
12637 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12638 @lisp
12639 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12640 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12641 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12642 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12643 @end lisp
12644
12645 More complex stuff:
12646 @lisp
12647 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12648 '((if (message-news-p)
12649 "misc-news"
12650 "misc-mail")))
12651 @end lisp
12652
12653 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12654 messages in one file per month:
12655
12656 @lisp
12657 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12658 '((if (message-news-p)
12659 "misc-news"
12660 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12661 @end lisp
12662
12663 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12664 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12665 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12666 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12667 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12668 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12669 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12670 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12671 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12672 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12673
12674 @table @code
12675 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12676 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12677 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12678
12679 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12680 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12681 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12682 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12683 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12684 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12685 changed in the future.
12686
12687 @item gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12688 @vindex gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12689 Like the @code{gcc-self} group parameter, applied only for unmodified
12690 messages that @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} (@pxref{Summary Mail
12691 Commands}) resends. Non-@code{nil} value of this variable takes
12692 precedence over any existing @code{Gcc} header.
12693
12694 If this is @code{none}, no @code{Gcc} copy will be made. If this is
12695 @code{t}, messages resent will be @code{Gcc} copied to the current
12696 group. If this is a string, it specifies a group to which resent
12697 messages will be @code{Gcc} copied. If this is @code{nil}, @code{Gcc}
12698 will be done according to existing @code{Gcc} header(s), if any. If
12699 this is @code{no-gcc-self}, that is the default, resent messages will be
12700 @code{Gcc} copied to groups that existing @code{Gcc} header specifies,
12701 except for the current group.
12702
12703 @item gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12704 @vindex gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12705 @itemx gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12706 @vindex gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12707
12708 These hooks are run before/after encoding the message body of the Gcc
12709 copy of a sent message. The current buffer (when the hook is run)
12710 contains the message including the message header. Changes made to
12711 the message will only affect the Gcc copy, but not the original
12712 message. You can use these hooks to edit the copy (and influence
12713 subsequent transformations), e.g., remove MML secure tags
12714 (@pxref{Signing and encrypting}).
12715
12716 @end table
12717
12718
12719 @node Posting Styles
12720 @section Posting Styles
12721 @cindex posting styles
12722 @cindex styles
12723
12724 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12725
12726 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12727 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12728 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12729 on?
12730
12731 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12732 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12733 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12734 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12735 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12736 variable:
12737
12738 @lisp
12739 ((".*"
12740 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12741 (organization "What me?"))
12742 ("^comp"
12743 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12744 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12745 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12746 @end lisp
12747
12748 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12749 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12750 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12751 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12752 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12753 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12754 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12755 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12756
12757 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12758 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12759 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12760 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12761 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12762 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12763 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12764 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12765 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12766 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12767 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12768 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12769 said to @dfn{match}.
12770
12771 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12772 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12773 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12774 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12775 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12776 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12777 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12778 name can be one of:
12779
12780 @itemize @bullet
12781 @item @code{signature}
12782 @item @code{signature-file}
12783 @item @code{x-face-file}
12784 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12785 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12786 @item @code{body}
12787 @end itemize
12788
12789 Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12790 @code{message-signature-directory}.
12791
12792 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12793 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12794 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12795 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12796 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12797
12798 The attribute value can be a string, a function with zero arguments
12799 (the return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used)
12800 or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be
12801 used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12802 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current
12803 article are available through the @code{message-reply-headers}
12804 variable, which is a vector of the following headers: number subject
12805 from date id references chars lines xref extra.
12806
12807 In the case of a string value, if the @code{match} is a regular
12808 expression, a @samp{gnus-match-substitute-replacement} is proceed on
12809 the value to replace the positional parameters @samp{\@var{n}} by the
12810 corresponding parenthetical matches (see @xref{Replacing Match,,
12811 Replacing the Text that Matched, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
12812
12813 @vindex message-reply-headers
12814
12815 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12816 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12817 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12818
12819 @findex message-mail-p
12820 @findex message-news-p
12821
12822 So here's a new example:
12823
12824 @lisp
12825 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12826 '((".*"
12827 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12828 (name "User Name")
12829 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12830 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12831 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12832 ("^rec.humor"
12833 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12834 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12835 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12836 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12837 (signature my-news-signature))
12838 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12839 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12840 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12841 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12842 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12843 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12844 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12845 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12846 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12847 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
12848 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12849 ("nnml:.*"
12850 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
12851 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12852 ("^nn.+:"
12853 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12854 @end lisp
12855
12856 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12857 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12858 if you fill many roles.
12859 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12860 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12861
12862 Of particular interest in the ``work-mail'' style is the
12863 @samp{X-Message-SMTP-Method} header. It specifies how to send the
12864 outgoing email. You may want to sent certain emails through certain
12865 @acronym{SMTP} servers due to company policies, for instance.
12866 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Message Variables, message, Message Manual}.
12867
12868
12869 @node Drafts
12870 @section Drafts
12871 @cindex drafts
12872
12873 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12874 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12875 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12876 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12877 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12878
12879 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12880 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12881 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12882 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12883 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12884 group.)
12885
12886 @cindex nndraft
12887 @vindex nndraft-directory
12888 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12889 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12890 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12891 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12892 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12893 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12894
12895 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12896 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12897 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12898 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12899 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12900 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12901 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12902 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12903 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12904
12905 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12906 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12907 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12908 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12909 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12910 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12911 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12912 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12913 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12914 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12915 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12916 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12917 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12918 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12919 @c
12920 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12921 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12922 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12923
12924 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12925 @kindex D e (Draft)
12926 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12927 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12928 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12929
12930 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12931 Articles}).
12932
12933 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12934 @kindex D s (Draft)
12935 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12936 @kindex D S (Draft)
12937 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12938 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12939 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12940 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12941 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12942 in the buffer.
12943
12944 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12945 @kindex D t (Draft)
12946 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12947 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12948 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12949
12950 Finally, if you want to delete a draft, use the normal @kbd{B DEL}
12951 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
12952
12953
12954 @node Rejected Articles
12955 @section Rejected Articles
12956 @cindex rejected articles
12957
12958 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12959 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12960 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12961 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12962
12963 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12964 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12965 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12966 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12967 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12968
12969 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12970 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12971 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12972
12973 @node Signing and encrypting
12974 @section Signing and encrypting
12975 @cindex using gpg
12976 @cindex using s/mime
12977 @cindex using smime
12978
12979 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12980 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12981 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12982 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12983
12984 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12985 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12986 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12987 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12988 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12989 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12990 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12991 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12992 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12993 automatically encrypted messages.
12994
12995 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12996 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12997 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12998
12999 @table @kbd
13000
13001 @item C-c C-m s s
13002 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
13003 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
13004
13005 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13006
13007 @item C-c C-m s o
13008 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
13009 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13010
13011 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13012
13013 @item C-c C-m s p
13014 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
13015 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13016
13017 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13018
13019 @item C-c C-m c s
13020 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
13021 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
13022
13023 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13024
13025 @item C-c C-m c o
13026 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13027 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
13028
13029 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13030
13031 @item C-c C-m c p
13032 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13033 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
13034
13035 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13036
13037 @item C-c C-m C-n
13038 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13039 @findex mml-unsecure-message
13040 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
13041
13042 @end table
13043
13044 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
13045
13046 @node Select Methods
13047 @chapter Select Methods
13048 @cindex foreign groups
13049 @cindex select methods
13050
13051 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13052 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13053 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13054 personal mail group.
13055
13056 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13057 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13058 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g., @code{nntp},
13059 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13060 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13061 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13062
13063 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13064 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13065
13066 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13067 group as.
13068
13069 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13070 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13071 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13072 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13073 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13074
13075 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13076
13077 @menu
13078 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13079 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13080 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
13081 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13082 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13083 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
13084 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13085 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13086 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13087 @end menu
13088
13089
13090 @node Server Buffer
13091 @section Server Buffer
13092
13093 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13094 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13095 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13096 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13097 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13098 back end represents a virtual server.
13099
13100 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13101 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13102 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13103 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13104
13105 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13106 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13107 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13108 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13109 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13110 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13111 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13112
13113 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13114 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13115
13116 @menu
13117 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13118 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13119 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13120 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13121 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13122 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13123 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13124 @end menu
13125
13126 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13127 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13128
13129
13130 @node Server Buffer Format
13131 @subsection Server Buffer Format
13132 @cindex server buffer format
13133
13134 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
13135 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13136 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13137 variable, with some simple extensions:
13138
13139 @table @samp
13140
13141 @item h
13142 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13143
13144 @item n
13145 The name of this server.
13146
13147 @item w
13148 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13149
13150 @item s
13151 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13152
13153 @item a
13154 Whether this server is agentized.
13155 @end table
13156
13157 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13158 The mode line can also be customized by using the
13159 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13160 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13161
13162 @table @samp
13163 @item S
13164 Server name.
13165
13166 @item M
13167 Server method.
13168 @end table
13169
13170 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13171
13172
13173 @node Server Commands
13174 @subsection Server Commands
13175 @cindex server commands
13176
13177 @table @kbd
13178
13179 @item v
13180 @kindex v (Server)
13181 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13182 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13183 command or better use it as a prefix key.
13184
13185 @item a
13186 @kindex a (Server)
13187 @findex gnus-server-add-server
13188 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13189
13190 @item e
13191 @kindex e (Server)
13192 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
13193 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13194
13195 @item S
13196 @kindex S (Server)
13197 @findex gnus-server-show-server
13198 Show the definition of a server (@code{gnus-server-show-server}).
13199
13200 @item SPACE
13201 @kindex SPACE (Server)
13202 @findex gnus-server-read-server
13203 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13204
13205 @item q
13206 @kindex q (Server)
13207 @findex gnus-server-exit
13208 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13209
13210 @item k
13211 @kindex k (Server)
13212 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
13213 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13214
13215 @item y
13216 @kindex y (Server)
13217 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
13218 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13219
13220 @item c
13221 @kindex c (Server)
13222 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13223 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13224
13225 @item l
13226 @kindex l (Server)
13227 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
13228 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13229
13230 @item s
13231 @kindex s (Server)
13232 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
13233 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13234 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13235 servers.
13236
13237 @item g
13238 @kindex g (Server)
13239 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13240 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13241 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13242 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13243
13244 @item z
13245 @kindex z (Server)
13246 @findex gnus-server-compact-server
13247
13248 Compact all groups in the server under point
13249 (@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13250 nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13251 hence getting a correct total article count.
13252
13253 @end table
13254
13255 Some more commands for closing, disabling, and re-opening servers are
13256 listed in @ref{Unavailable Servers}.
13257
13258
13259 @node Example Methods
13260 @subsection Example Methods
13261
13262 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13263
13264 @lisp
13265 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
13266 @end lisp
13267
13268 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13269
13270 @lisp
13271 (nnspool "")
13272 @end lisp
13273
13274 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13275 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13276 will.
13277
13278 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13279 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13280
13281 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13282 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13283 look like then:
13284
13285 @lisp
13286 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13287 @end lisp
13288
13289 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13290 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13291
13292 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13293 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13294 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13295 your private mail:
13296
13297 @lisp
13298 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13299 @end lisp
13300
13301 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13302 that.)
13303
13304 Here's the method for a public spool:
13305
13306 @lisp
13307 (nnmh "public"
13308 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13309 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13310 @end lisp
13311
13312 @cindex proxy
13313 @cindex firewall
13314
13315 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13316 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13317 on the firewall machine and connect with
13318 @uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13319 @acronym{NNTP} server.
13320 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13321 should probably look something like this:
13322
13323 @lisp
13324 (nntp "firewall"
13325 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13326 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13327 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13328 @end lisp
13329
13330 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13331 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13332 configuration to the example above:
13333
13334 @lisp
13335 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13336 @end lisp
13337
13338 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13339 an indirect connection:
13340
13341 @lisp
13342 (setq gnus-select-method
13343 '(nntp "indirect"
13344 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13345 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13346 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13347 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13348 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13349 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
13350 @end lisp
13351
13352 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13353 provide automatic authorization, of course.
13354
13355 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13356 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13357 netcat connection to the news server as follows:
13358
13359 @lisp
13360 (nntp "outside"
13361 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13362 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13363 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13364 @end lisp
13365
13366
13367 @node Creating a Virtual Server
13368 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13369
13370 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13371 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13372
13373 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13374 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13375 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13376
13377 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13378
13379 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13380 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13381 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13382 will contain the following:
13383
13384 @lisp
13385 (nnml "cache")
13386 @end lisp
13387
13388 Change that to:
13389
13390 @lisp
13391 (nnml "cache"
13392 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13393 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13394 @end lisp
13395
13396 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13397 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13398 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13399
13400
13401 @node Server Variables
13402 @subsection Server Variables
13403 @cindex server variables
13404 @cindex server parameters
13405
13406 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13407 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13408 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13409 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13410 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13411
13412 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13413 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13414 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13415 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13416 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13417 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13418 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13419 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13420 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13421
13422 @lisp
13423 (nnml "public"
13424 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13425 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13426 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13427 @end lisp
13428
13429 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13430
13431 @node Servers and Methods
13432 @subsection Servers and Methods
13433
13434 Wherever you would normally use a select method
13435 (e.g., @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
13436 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13437 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13438 over.
13439
13440
13441 @node Unavailable Servers
13442 @subsection Unavailable Servers
13443
13444 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13445 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13446 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13447 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13448 actually the case or not.
13449
13450 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13451 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13452 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13453 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13454 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13455 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13456 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13457 it will regard that server as ``down''.
13458
13459 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13460 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13461
13462 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13463 with the following commands:
13464
13465 @table @kbd
13466
13467 @item O
13468 @kindex O (Server)
13469 @findex gnus-server-open-server
13470 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13471 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
13472
13473 @item C
13474 @kindex C (Server)
13475 @findex gnus-server-close-server
13476 Close the connection (if any) to the server
13477 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
13478
13479 @item D
13480 @kindex D (Server)
13481 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
13482 Mark the current server as unreachable
13483 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
13484
13485 @item M-o
13486 @kindex M-o (Server)
13487 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13488 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13489 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
13490
13491 @item M-c
13492 @kindex M-c (Server)
13493 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13494 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13495 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
13496
13497 @item R
13498 @kindex R (Server)
13499 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13500 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13501 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
13502
13503 @item c
13504 @kindex c (Server)
13505 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13506 Copy a server and give it a new name
13507 (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}). This can be useful if you have a
13508 complex method definition, and want to use the same definition towards
13509 a different (physical) server.
13510
13511 @item L
13512 @kindex L (Server)
13513 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
13514 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
13515
13516 @end table
13517
13518
13519 @node Getting News
13520 @section Getting News
13521 @cindex reading news
13522 @cindex news back ends
13523
13524 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13525 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13526 or it can read from a local spool.
13527
13528 @menu
13529 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13530 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13531 @end menu
13532
13533
13534 @node NNTP
13535 @subsection NNTP
13536 @cindex nntp
13537
13538 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13539 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13540 server as the, uhm, address.
13541
13542 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13543 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13544 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13545 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13546
13547 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13548 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13549 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
13550
13551 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13552 server:
13553
13554 @table @code
13555
13556 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
13557 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13558 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
13559 @cindex authinfo
13560 @cindex authentication
13561 @cindex nntp authentication
13562 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13563 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13564 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13565 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13566 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13567 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13568 present in this hook.
13569
13570 @item nntp-authinfo-function
13571 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13572 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13573 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13574 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13575 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13576 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13577 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13578 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13579 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13580 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13581 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
13582
13583 @enumerate
13584 @item
13585 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
13586
13587 @item
13588 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
13589
13590 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13591 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13592 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13593 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13594 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13595 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13596 @samp{force} is explained below.
13597
13598 @end enumerate
13599
13600 Here's an example file:
13601
13602 @example
13603 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13604 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13605 @end example
13606
13607 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13608 have to be first, for instance.
13609
13610 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13611 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13612 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13613 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13614 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13615 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13616 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
13617
13618 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13619 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
13620
13621 @example
13622 default force yes
13623 @end example
13624
13625 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13626 previously mentioned.
13627
13628 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
13629
13630 @item nntp-server-action-alist
13631 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13632 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13633 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13634 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
13635
13636 @lisp
13637 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
13638 '(("innd" (ding))))
13639 @end lisp
13640
13641 You probably don't want to do that, though.
13642
13643 The default value is
13644
13645 @lisp
13646 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13647 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13648 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13649 @end lisp
13650
13651 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13652 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
13653
13654 @item nntp-maximum-request
13655 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
13656 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13657 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13658 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13659 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13660 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13661 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
13662
13663 @item nntp-connection-timeout
13664 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13665 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13666 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13667 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13668 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13669 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13670 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13671 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13672 no timeouts are done.
13673
13674 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
13675 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13676 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13677 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13678 can be used.
13679
13680 @item nntp-xover-commands
13681 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
13682 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
13683 @cindex XOVER
13684 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13685 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13686 "XOVERVIEW")}.
13687
13688 @item nntp-nov-gap
13689 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
13690 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13691 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
13692 if you have read articles 2--5000 in the group, and only want to read
13693 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13694 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13695 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13696 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13697 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13698 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13699 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
13700
13701 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13702 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13703 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13704 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13705 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13706 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13707 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13708 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13709 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13710 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13711 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13712 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13713 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13714 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13715 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13716 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13717 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
13718
13719 @lisp
13720 (setq gnus-select-method
13721 '(nntp "newszilla"
13722 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13723 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13724 @dots{}))
13725 @end lisp
13726
13727 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
13728
13729 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13730 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13731 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13732
13733 @item nntp-record-commands
13734 @vindex nntp-record-commands
13735 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13736 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13737 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13738 that doesn't seem to work.
13739
13740 @item nntp-open-connection-function
13741 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13742 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13743 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13744 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13745 Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13746 in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13747 indirect ones (three pre-made).
13748
13749 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13750 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13751 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13752 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13753 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13754 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13755 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13756 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13757 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13758
13759 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13760 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13761 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13762 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13763 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13764 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13765 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13766
13767 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13768 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13769 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13770 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13771 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13772 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13773 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13774
13775 @lisp
13776 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13777 @end lisp
13778
13779 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID@. This works for
13780 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13781
13782 @item nntp-server-list-active-group
13783 If @code{nil}, then always use @samp{GROUP} instead of @samp{LIST
13784 ACTIVE}. This is usually slower, but on misconfigured servers that
13785 don't update their active files often, this can help.
13786
13787
13788 @end table
13789
13790 @menu
13791 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13792 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13793 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13794 @end menu
13795
13796
13797 @node Direct Functions
13798 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13799 @cindex direct connection functions
13800
13801 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13802 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13803 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13804 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13805
13806 @table @code
13807 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13808 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13809 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13810 remote system. If both Emacs and the server supports it, the
13811 connection will be upgraded to an encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS}
13812 connection automatically.
13813
13814 @item network-only
13815 The same as the above, but don't do automatic @acronym{STARTTLS} upgrades.
13816
13817 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13818 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13819 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13820 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GnuTLS}
13821 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13822
13823 @lisp
13824 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13825 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13826 ;;
13827 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13828 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13829 (nntp-port-number 563)
13830 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13831 @end lisp
13832
13833 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13834 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13835 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13836 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL}
13837 @ignore
13838 @c Defunct URL, ancient package, so don't mention it.
13839 or @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay}
13840 @end ignore
13841 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13842
13843 @lisp
13844 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13845 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13846 ;;
13847 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13848 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13849 (nntp-port-number 563)
13850 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13851 @end lisp
13852
13853 @findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
13854 @item nntp-open-netcat-stream
13855 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
13856 program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
13857 the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13858 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13859 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13860 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13861
13862 @lisp
13863 (nntp "socksified"
13864 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13865 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13866 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13867 @end lisp
13868
13869 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13870 session, which is not a good idea.
13871
13872 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13873 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13874 Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
13875 @code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
13876 like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
13877 not available. The previous example would turn into:
13878
13879 @lisp
13880 (nntp "socksified"
13881 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13882 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13883 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13884 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13885 @end lisp
13886 @end table
13887
13888
13889 @node Indirect Functions
13890 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13891 @cindex indirect connection functions
13892
13893 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13894 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13895 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13896 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13897 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13898 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13899
13900 @table @code
13901 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13902 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13903 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
13904 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13905 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13906
13907 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
13908
13909 @table @code
13910 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13911 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13912 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13913 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13914
13915 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13916 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13917 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13918 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13919 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13920 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
13921 @end table
13922
13923 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13924 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13925 Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
13926 to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13927 @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
13928 line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
13929
13930 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13931
13932 @table @code
13933 @item nntp-telnet-command
13934 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13935 Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13936 intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
13937
13938 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13939 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13940 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13941 @code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
13942
13943 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13944 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13945 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13946 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13947
13948 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13949 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13950 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13951 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
13952 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13953 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13954 host. The default is @code{nil}.
13955 @end table
13956
13957 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13958 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13959
13960 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13961 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13962 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13963 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13964
13965 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13966
13967 @table @code
13968 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13969 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13970 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13971 @samp{telnet}.
13972
13973 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13974 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13975 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13976 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13977
13978 @item nntp-via-user-password
13979 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13980 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13981
13982 @item nntp-via-envuser
13983 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13984 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13985 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13986 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13987
13988 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13989 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13990 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13991 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13992
13993 @end table
13994
13995 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13996 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13997 @end table
13998
13999
14000 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
14001 functions:
14002
14003 @table @code
14004
14005 @item nntp-via-user-name
14006 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
14007 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
14008
14009 @item nntp-via-address
14010 @vindex nntp-via-address
14011 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
14012
14013 @end table
14014
14015
14016 @node Common Variables
14017 @subsubsection Common Variables
14018
14019 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
14020 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
14021 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
14022 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
14023 variables individually).
14024
14025 @table @code
14026
14027 @item nntp-pre-command
14028 @vindex nntp-pre-command
14029 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14030 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14031 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14032 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
14033
14034 @item nntp-address
14035 @vindex nntp-address
14036 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14037
14038 @item nntp-port-number
14039 @vindex nntp-port-number
14040 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14041 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14042 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
14043 than named ports (i.e., use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
14044 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14045 not work with named ports.
14046
14047 @item nntp-end-of-line
14048 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
14049 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14050 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
14051 using a non native telnet connection function.
14052
14053 @item nntp-netcat-command
14054 @vindex nntp-netcat-command
14055 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
14056 @samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14057 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14058 @samp{nc}.
14059
14060 @item nntp-netcat-switches
14061 @vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14062 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14063 is @samp{()}.
14064
14065 @end table
14066
14067 @node News Spool
14068 @subsection News Spool
14069 @cindex nnspool
14070 @cindex news spool
14071
14072 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14073 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14074 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14075 instance.
14076
14077 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14078 anything else) as the address.
14079
14080 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14081 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14082 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14083 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14084
14085 @table @code
14086
14087 @item nnspool-inews-program
14088 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
14089 Program used to post an article.
14090
14091 @item nnspool-inews-switches
14092 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14093 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14094
14095 @item nnspool-spool-directory
14096 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14097 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14098 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14099
14100 @item nnspool-nov-directory
14101 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14102 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14103 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14104
14105 @item nnspool-lib-dir
14106 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14107 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14108
14109 @item nnspool-active-file
14110 @vindex nnspool-active-file
14111 The name of the active file.
14112
14113 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14114 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14115 The name of the group descriptions file.
14116
14117 @item nnspool-history-file
14118 @vindex nnspool-history-file
14119 The name of the news history file.
14120
14121 @item nnspool-active-times-file
14122 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14123 The name of the active date file.
14124
14125 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14126 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14127 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14128 that it finds.
14129
14130 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14131 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14132 @cindex sed
14133 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14134 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14135 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14136 there.
14137
14138 @end table
14139
14140
14141 @node Using IMAP
14142 @section Using IMAP
14143 @cindex imap
14144
14145 The most popular mail backend is probably @code{nnimap}, which
14146 provides access to @acronym{IMAP} servers. @acronym{IMAP} servers
14147 store mail remotely, so the client doesn't store anything locally.
14148 This means that it's a convenient choice when you're reading your mail
14149 from different locations, or with different user agents.
14150
14151 @menu
14152 * Connecting to an IMAP Server:: Getting started with @acronym{IMAP}.
14153 * Customizing the IMAP Connection:: Variables for @acronym{IMAP} connection.
14154 * Client-Side IMAP Splitting:: Put mail in the correct mail box.
14155 @end menu
14156
14157
14158 @node Connecting to an IMAP Server
14159 @subsection Connecting to an IMAP Server
14160
14161 Connecting to an @acronym{IMAP} can be very easy. Type @kbd{B} in the
14162 group buffer, or (if your primary interest is reading email), say
14163 something like:
14164
14165 @example
14166 (setq gnus-select-method
14167 '(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"))
14168 @end example
14169
14170 You'll be prompted for a user name and password. If you grow tired of
14171 that, then add the following to your @file{~/.authinfo} file:
14172
14173 @example
14174 machine imap.gmail.com login <username> password <password> port imap
14175 @end example
14176
14177 That should basically be it for most users.
14178
14179
14180 @node Customizing the IMAP Connection
14181 @subsection Customizing the IMAP Connection
14182
14183 Here's an example method that's more complex:
14184
14185 @example
14186 (nnimap "imap.gmail.com"
14187 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14188 (nnimap-split-methods default)
14189 (nnimap-expunge t)
14190 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14191 @end example
14192
14193 @table @code
14194 @item nnimap-address
14195 The address of the server, like @samp{imap.gmail.com}.
14196
14197 @item nnimap-server-port
14198 If the server uses a non-standard port, that can be specified here. A
14199 typical port would be @code{"imap"} or @code{"imaps"}.
14200
14201 @item nnimap-stream
14202 How @code{nnimap} should connect to the server. Possible values are:
14203
14204 @table @code
14205 @item undecided
14206 This is the default, and this first tries the @code{ssl} setting, and
14207 then tries the @code{network} setting.
14208
14209 @item ssl
14210 This uses standard @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14211
14212 @item network
14213 Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection, but will upgrade
14214 to encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} if both Emacs and the server
14215 supports it.
14216
14217 @item starttls
14218 Encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} over the normal @acronym{IMAP} port.
14219
14220 @item shell
14221 If you need to tunnel via other systems to connect to the server, you
14222 can use this option, and customize @code{nnimap-shell-program} to be
14223 what you need.
14224
14225 @end table
14226
14227 @item nnimap-authenticator
14228 Some @acronym{IMAP} servers allow anonymous logins. In that case,
14229 this should be set to @code{anonymous}. If this variable isn't set,
14230 the normal login methods will be used. If you wish to specify a
14231 specific login method to be used, you can set this variable to either
14232 @code{login} (the traditional @acronym{IMAP} login method),
14233 @code{plain} or @code{cram-md5}.
14234
14235 @item nnimap-expunge
14236 If non-@code{nil}, expunge articles after deleting them. This is always done
14237 if the server supports UID EXPUNGE, but it's not done by default on
14238 servers that doesn't support that command.
14239
14240 @item nnimap-streaming
14241 Virtually all @acronym{IMAP} server support fast streaming of data.
14242 If you have problems connecting to the server, try setting this to
14243 @code{nil}.
14244
14245 @item nnimap-fetch-partial-articles
14246 If non-@code{nil}, fetch partial articles from the server. If set to
14247 a string, then it's interpreted as a regexp, and parts that have
14248 matching types will be fetched. For instance, @samp{"text/"} will
14249 fetch all textual parts, while leaving the rest on the server.
14250
14251 @item nnimap-record-commands
14252 If non-@code{nil}, record all @acronym{IMAP} commands in the
14253 @samp{"*imap log*"} buffer.
14254
14255 @end table
14256
14257
14258 @node Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14259 @subsection Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14260
14261 Many people prefer to do the sorting/splitting of mail into their mail
14262 boxes on the @acronym{IMAP} server. That way they don't have to
14263 download the mail they're not all that interested in.
14264
14265 If you do want to do client-side mail splitting, then the following
14266 variables are relevant:
14267
14268 @table @code
14269 @item nnimap-inbox
14270 This is the @acronym{IMAP} mail box that will be scanned for new
14271 mail. This can also be a list of mail box names.
14272
14273 @item nnimap-split-methods
14274 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-methods} (@pxref{Splitting
14275 Mail}), except the symbol @code{default}, which means that it should
14276 use the value of the @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable.
14277
14278 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14279 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14280
14281 @item nnimap-unsplittable-articles
14282 List of flag symbols to ignore when doing splitting. That is,
14283 articles that have these flags won't be considered when splitting.
14284 The default is @samp{(%Deleted %Seen)}.
14285
14286 @end table
14287
14288 Here's a complete example @code{nnimap} backend with a client-side
14289 ``fancy'' splitting method:
14290
14291 @example
14292 (nnimap "imap.example.com"
14293 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14294 (nnimap-split-methods
14295 (| ("MailScanner-SpamCheck" "spam" "spam.detected")
14296 (to "foo@@bar.com" "foo")
14297 "undecided")))
14298 @end example
14299
14300
14301 @node Getting Mail
14302 @section Getting Mail
14303 @cindex reading mail
14304 @cindex mail
14305
14306 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD@? But of
14307 course.
14308
14309 @menu
14310 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14311 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14312 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14313 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14314 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14315 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14316 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14317 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14318 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14319 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14320 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14321 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14322 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14323 @end menu
14324
14325
14326 @node Mail in a Newsreader
14327 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14328
14329 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14330 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14331 of a culture shock.
14332
14333 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14334 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14335
14336 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14337 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14338 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14339 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14340
14341 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14342
14343 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14344 deleted? How awful!
14345
14346 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14347 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14348 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14349 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14350 Mail}.
14351
14352 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14353 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14354 they want to treat a message.
14355
14356 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14357 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14358 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14359 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14360 archived somewhere else.
14361
14362 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14363 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14364 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14365 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14366 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14367
14368 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14369 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14370 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14371
14372 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14373 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14374 differently.
14375
14376 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14377 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14378 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14379 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14380 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14381
14382 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14383 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14384 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14385 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14386 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14387 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14388 You Do.)
14389
14390
14391 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
14392 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14393
14394 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14395 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14396 and things will happen automatically.
14397
14398 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14399 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14400
14401 @lisp
14402 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14403 @end lisp
14404
14405 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14406 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14407 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14408 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14409 like any other group.
14410
14411 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14412
14413 @lisp
14414 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14415 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14416 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14417 ("other" "")))
14418 @end lisp
14419
14420 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14421 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14422 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14423 last group.
14424
14425 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14426 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14427 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14428
14429
14430 @node Splitting Mail
14431 @subsection Splitting Mail
14432 @cindex splitting mail
14433 @cindex mail splitting
14434 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14435
14436 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
14437 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14438 to be split into groups.
14439
14440 @lisp
14441 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14442 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14443 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14444 ("mail.other" "")))
14445 @end lisp
14446
14447 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14448 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14449 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14450 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14451 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14452 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14453 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14454
14455 @lisp
14456 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14457 @end lisp
14458
14459 @noindent
14460 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14461 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14462
14463 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14464 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14465 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14466 mail belongs in that group.
14467
14468 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
14469 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14470 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14471 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14472 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14473 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14474 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14475 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14476 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14477 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14478
14479 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14480 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14481 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14482 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14483 thinks should carry this mail message.
14484
14485 This variable can also be a fancy split method. For the syntax,
14486 see @ref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14487
14488 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14489 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14490 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14491 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14492
14493 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
14494 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14495 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14496 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14497 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14498
14499 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14500 @cindex crosspost
14501 @cindex links
14502 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14503 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14504 links. If that's the case for you, set
14505 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14506 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14507
14508 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14509 @findex nnmail-split-history
14510 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14511 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14512 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14513 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14514 Group Commands}).
14515
14516 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14517 Header lines longer than the value of
14518 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14519 function.
14520
14521 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14522 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14523 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14524 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14525 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14526 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14527 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14528 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14529 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14530 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14531 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14532 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14533
14534 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14535 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14536 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14537 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14538 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14539 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14540 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14541 other kinds of entries.)
14542
14543 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14544 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14545 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14546 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14547 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14548 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14549 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14550 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14551 month's rent money.
14552
14553
14554 @node Mail Sources
14555 @subsection Mail Sources
14556
14557 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14558 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14559 maildir, for instance.
14560
14561 @menu
14562 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14563 * Mail Source Functions::
14564 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14565 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14566 @end menu
14567
14568
14569 @node Mail Source Specifiers
14570 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14571 @cindex POP
14572 @cindex mail server
14573 @cindex procmail
14574 @cindex mail spool
14575 @cindex mail source
14576
14577 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14578 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
14579
14580 Here's an example:
14581
14582 @lisp
14583 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
14584 @end lisp
14585
14586 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14587 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14588 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14589 default values.
14590
14591 The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14592 an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14593 @code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14594 @code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14595 a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14596 typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14597 group might look like this:
14598
14599 @lisp
14600 (mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
14601 @end lisp
14602
14603 This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14604 fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
14605
14606 The following mail source types are available:
14607
14608 @table @code
14609 @item file
14610 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
14611
14612 Keywords:
14613
14614 @table @code
14615 @item :path
14616 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14617 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14618 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
14619
14620 @item :prescript
14621 @itemx :postscript
14622 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14623 @end table
14624
14625 An example file mail source:
14626
14627 @lisp
14628 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14629 @end lisp
14630
14631 Or using the default file name:
14632
14633 @lisp
14634 (file)
14635 @end lisp
14636
14637 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14638 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14639 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14640 mail spool while moving the mail.
14641
14642 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
14643
14644 @lisp
14645 (setq mail-sources
14646 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14647 @end lisp
14648
14649 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
14650
14651 @example
14652 #!/bin/sh
14653 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14654 # flu@@iki.fi
14655
14656 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14657 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14658 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14659 @end example
14660
14661 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14662 file you want to use.
14663
14664
14665 @item directory
14666 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14667 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14668 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14669 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14670 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14671 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14672 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14673 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14674 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14675 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
14676
14677 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14678 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14679 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14680 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
14681
14682 Keywords:
14683
14684 @table @code
14685 @item :path
14686 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14687 value.
14688
14689 @item :suffix
14690 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14691 @samp{.spool}.
14692
14693 @item :predicate
14694 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14695 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14696 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14697 predicate are considered.
14698
14699 @item :prescript
14700 @itemx :postscript
14701 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14702
14703 @end table
14704
14705 An example directory mail source:
14706
14707 @lisp
14708 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14709 :suffix ".prcml")
14710 @end lisp
14711
14712 @item pop
14713 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14714
14715 Keywords:
14716
14717 @table @code
14718 @item :server
14719 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14720 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14721
14722 @item :port
14723 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (e.g.,
14724 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (e.g., @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
14725 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14726 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14727 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
14728
14729 @item :user
14730 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14731 name.
14732
14733 @item :password
14734 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14735 the user is prompted.
14736
14737 @item :program
14738 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14739 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
14740
14741 @example
14742 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14743 @end example
14744
14745 The valid format specifier characters are:
14746
14747 @table @samp
14748 @item t
14749 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14750 included in this string.
14751
14752 @item s
14753 The name of the server.
14754
14755 @item P
14756 The port number of the server.
14757
14758 @item u
14759 The user name to use.
14760
14761 @item p
14762 The password to use.
14763 @end table
14764
14765 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14766 corresponding keywords.
14767
14768 @item :prescript
14769 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14770 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14771
14772 One popular way to use this is to set up an SSH tunnel to access the
14773 @acronym{POP} server. Here's an example:
14774
14775 @lisp
14776 (pop :server "127.0.0.1"
14777 :port 1234
14778 :user "foo"
14779 :password "secret"
14780 :prescript
14781 "nohup ssh -f -L 1234:pop.server:110 remote.host sleep 3600 &")
14782 @end lisp
14783
14784 @item :postscript
14785 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14786 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14787
14788 @item :function
14789 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14790 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14791 mail should be moved to.
14792
14793 @item :authentication
14794 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14795 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14796 @code{password}.
14797
14798 @item :leave
14799 Non-@code{nil} if the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
14800 after fetching. Only the built-in @code{pop3-movemail} program (the
14801 default) supports this keyword.
14802
14803 If this is a number, leave mails on the server for this many days since
14804 you first checked new mails. In that case, mails once fetched will
14805 never be fetched again by the @acronym{UIDL} control. If this is
14806 @code{nil} (the default), mails will be deleted on the server right
14807 after fetching. If this is neither @code{nil} nor a number, all mails
14808 will be left on the server, and you will end up getting the same mails
14809 again and again.
14810
14811 @vindex pop3-uidl-file
14812 The @code{pop3-uidl-file} variable specifies the file to which the
14813 @acronym{UIDL} data are locally stored. The default value is
14814 @file{~/.pop3-uidl}.
14815
14816 Note that @acronym{POP} servers maintain no state information between
14817 sessions, so what the client believes is there and what is actually
14818 there may not match up. If they do not, then you may get duplicate
14819 mails or the whole thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt
14820 mailbox.
14821
14822 @end table
14823
14824 @findex pop3-movemail
14825 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14826 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
14827 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used.
14828
14829 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14830
14831 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14832 name, and default fetcher:
14833
14834 @lisp
14835 (pop)
14836 @end lisp
14837
14838 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
14839
14840 @lisp
14841 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14842 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14843 @end lisp
14844
14845 Leave mails on the server for 14 days:
14846
14847 @lisp
14848 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14849 :user "user-name" :password "secret"
14850 :leave 14)
14851 @end lisp
14852
14853 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
14854
14855 @lisp
14856 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14857 @end lisp
14858
14859 @item maildir
14860 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14861 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14862 contains exactly one mail.
14863
14864 Keywords:
14865
14866 @table @code
14867 @item :path
14868 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14869 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14870 @file{~/Maildir/}.
14871 @item :subdirs
14872 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14873 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
14874
14875 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14876 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14877 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14878 @c below.
14879
14880 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14881 from locking problems).
14882
14883 @end table
14884
14885 Two example maildir mail sources:
14886
14887 @lisp
14888 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14889 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14890 @end lisp
14891
14892 @lisp
14893 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14894 :subdirs ("new"))
14895 @end lisp
14896
14897 @item imap
14898 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
14899 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (i.e.,
14900 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14901 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14902 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{Using IMAP}, for more information.
14903
14904 Keywords:
14905
14906 @table @code
14907 @item :server
14908 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14909 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14910
14911 @item :port
14912 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14913 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14914
14915 @item :user
14916 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14917 name.
14918
14919 @item :password
14920 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14921 prompted.
14922
14923 @item :stream
14924 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14925 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14926 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14927 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
14928
14929 @item :authentication
14930 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14931 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14932 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14933 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
14934
14935 @item :program
14936 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
14937 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
14938 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
14939
14940 @example
14941 ssh %s imapd
14942 @end example
14943
14944 Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
14945 don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
14946 specifier characters are:
14947
14948 @table @samp
14949 @item s
14950 The name of the server.
14951
14952 @item l
14953 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
14954
14955 @item p
14956 The port number of the server.
14957 @end table
14958
14959 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14960 corresponding keywords.
14961
14962 @item :mailbox
14963 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
14964 which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
14965
14966 @item :predicate
14967 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
14968 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
14969 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
14970 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
14971 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
14972 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
14973
14974 @item :fetchflag
14975 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
14976 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
14977 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
14978 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
14979
14980 @item :dontexpunge
14981 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
14982 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
14983
14984 @end table
14985
14986 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
14987
14988 @lisp
14989 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
14990 :stream kerberos4
14991 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
14992 @end lisp
14993
14994 @item group
14995 Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
14996 @xref{Group Parameters}.
14997
14998 @end table
14999
15000 @table @dfn
15001 @item Common Keywords
15002 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
15003
15004 Keywords:
15005
15006 @table @code
15007 @item :plugged
15008 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
15009 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
15010 example:
15011
15012 @lisp
15013 (setq mail-sources
15014 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
15015 :suffix ""
15016 :plugged t)))
15017 @end lisp
15018
15019 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
15020 useful when you use local mail and news.
15021
15022 @end table
15023 @end table
15024
15025 @node Mail Source Functions
15026 @subsubsection Function Interface
15027
15028 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
15029 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
15030 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
15031 consider the following mail-source setting:
15032
15033 @lisp
15034 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
15035 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
15036 @end lisp
15037
15038 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
15039 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
15040 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
15041 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
15042 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
15043
15044 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
15045
15046
15047 @node Mail Source Customization
15048 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
15049
15050 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
15051 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
15052 variables.
15053
15054 @table @code
15055 @item mail-source-crash-box
15056 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
15057 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
15058 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
15059
15060 @cindex Incoming*
15061 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
15062 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15063 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15064 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15065 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15066 (the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15067 set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15068 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15069 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15070 and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
15071
15072 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15073 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15074 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15075 files. This variable only applies when
15076 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15077
15078 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
15079 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15080 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15081
15082 @item mail-source-directory
15083 @vindex mail-source-directory
15084 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15085 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15086 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15087 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15088
15089 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15090 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15091 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15092 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15093 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15094 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15095 number.
15096
15097 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
15098 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15099 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is @code{#o600}.
15100
15101 @item mail-source-movemail-program
15102 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15103 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15104 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15105
15106 @end table
15107
15108
15109 @node Fetching Mail
15110 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
15111
15112 @vindex mail-sources
15113 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15114 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15115 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15116
15117 If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15118 fetch mail by themselves.
15119
15120 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15121 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15122
15123 @lisp
15124 (setq mail-sources
15125 '((file)
15126 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15127 :password "secret")))
15128 @end lisp
15129
15130 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15131
15132 @lisp
15133 (setq mail-sources
15134 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15135 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15136 :user "user-name"
15137 :port "pop3"
15138 :password "secret")))
15139 @end lisp
15140
15141
15142 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15143 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15144 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15145 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15146 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15147 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15148
15149
15150
15151 @node Mail Back End Variables
15152 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
15153
15154 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15155 mail back ends.
15156
15157 @table @code
15158 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15159 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15160 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15161 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15162
15163 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
15164 @item nnmail-split-hook
15165 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15166 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15167 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15168 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15169 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15170 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15171 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15172 in the buffer will show up in any files.
15173 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15174 to this hook.
15175
15176 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15177 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15178 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15179 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15180 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15181 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15182 starting to handle the new mail) and
15183 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15184 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15185 default file modes the new mail files get:
15186
15187 @lisp
15188 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15189 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o700)))
15190
15191 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15192 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o775)))
15193 @end lisp
15194
15195 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15196 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15197 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15198 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15199 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15200 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15201 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15202
15203 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
15204 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15205 @findex delete-file
15206 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15207
15208 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15209 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15210 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15211 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15212 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15213
15214 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15215 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15216 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15217 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15218 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15219
15220 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15221 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15222 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15223
15224 @end table
15225
15226
15227 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
15228 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15229 @cindex mail splitting
15230 @cindex fancy mail splitting
15231
15232 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15233 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
15234 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15235 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15236 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15237 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15238
15239 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15240
15241 @lisp
15242 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15243 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15244 ;; @r{from real errors.}
15245 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15246 "mail.misc"))
15247 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15248 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15249 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15250 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15251 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15252 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15253 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15254 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15255 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15256 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15257 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15258 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15259 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15260 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15261 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15262 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15263 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15264 "misc.misc")
15265 @end lisp
15266
15267 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15268 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15269 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15270
15271 @table @code
15272
15273 @item group
15274 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15275 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15276
15277 @c Don't fold this line.
15278 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15279 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15280 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15281 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15282 @var{split}.
15283
15284 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15285 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15286 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15287 @var{split} is processed.
15288
15289 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15290 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15291 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15292 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15293
15294 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15295 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15296 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15297 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15298 stored in one or more groups.
15299
15300 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15301 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15302 process all @var{split}s in the list.
15303
15304 @item junk
15305 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15306 this message. Use with extreme caution.
15307
15308 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15309 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15310 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15311 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15312
15313 @cindex body split
15314 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15315 body of the messages:
15316
15317 @lisp
15318 (defun split-on-body ()
15319 (save-excursion
15320 (save-restriction
15321 (widen)
15322 (goto-char (point-min))
15323 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15324 "string.group"))))
15325 @end lisp
15326
15327 The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15328 @var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15329 after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15330 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15331 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15332 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15333 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
15334
15335 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15336 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15337 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15338 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15339 should return a split.
15340
15341 @item nil
15342 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15343
15344 @end table
15345
15346 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15347
15348 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15349 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15350 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15351 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15352 for example,
15353
15354 @example
15355 (any "joe" "joemail")
15356 @end example
15357
15358 @noindent
15359 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15360 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15361 of the following three ways:
15362
15363 @enumerate
15364 @item
15365 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15366 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15367 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15368 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15369 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15370 @code{nil}.
15371
15372 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15373
15374 @item
15375 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15376 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15377 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15378 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15379 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15380
15381 @item
15382 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15383 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15384 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15385 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15386 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15387 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15388 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15389 @end enumerate
15390
15391 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15392 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15393 they are expanded as specified by the variable
15394 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15395 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15396 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15397 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15398
15399 @table @code
15400 @item from
15401 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15402 @item to
15403 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15404 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15405 @item any
15406 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15407 @end table
15408
15409 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15410 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15411 when all this splitting is performed.
15412
15413 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15414 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15415 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15416
15417 @example
15418 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15419 @end example
15420
15421 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15422 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15423
15424 If the string contains the element @samp{\\&}, then the previously
15425 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15426 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15427 groupings 1 through 9.
15428
15429 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15430 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15431 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15432 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15433 groups when users send to an address using different case
15434 (i.e., mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15435 is @code{t}.
15436
15437 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15438 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15439 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15440 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15441 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15442 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15443 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15444 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15445 it once per thread.
15446
15447 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15448 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15449 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15450 using the colon feature, like so:
15451 @lisp
15452 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15453 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15454 nnmail-split-fancy
15455 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15456 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15457 ))
15458 @end lisp
15459
15460 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15461 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15462 in the file specified by the variable
15463 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15464 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15465 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15466 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15467 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15468 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15469 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15470 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15471 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15472 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15473 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15474 300 kBytes in size.)
15475 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15476 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15477 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15478 messages goes into the new group.
15479
15480 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15481 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15482 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15483 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15484 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15485 ``outgoing'' group.
15486
15487
15488 @node Group Mail Splitting
15489 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
15490 @cindex mail splitting
15491 @cindex group mail splitting
15492
15493 @findex gnus-group-split
15494 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15495 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15496 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15497 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15498 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15499 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15500 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15501 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15502
15503 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15504 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15505 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15506 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15507
15508 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15509 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15510 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15511 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15512 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15513 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15514 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15515
15516 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15517 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15518 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15519 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15520 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15521 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15522 @code{gnus-group-split}.
15523
15524 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15525 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15526 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15527 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15528 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15529 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15530 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15531 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15532 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15533 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15534 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15535 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15536 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15537
15538 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15539 been defined:
15540
15541 @example
15542 nnml:mail.bar:
15543 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15544 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15545 nnml:mail.foo:
15546 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15547 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15548 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15549 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15550 nnml:mail.others:
15551 ((split-spec . catch-all))
15552 @end example
15553
15554 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15555 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15556 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15557
15558 @lisp
15559 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15560 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15561 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15562 "mail.others")
15563 @end lisp
15564
15565 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15566 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15567 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15568 splits like this:
15569
15570 @lisp
15571 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15572 @end lisp
15573
15574 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15575 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15576 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15577 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15578 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15579 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15580 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15581 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15582 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
15583
15584 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
15585 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15586 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15587 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15588 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15589 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15590 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15591 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15592 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
15593
15594 @findex gnus-group-split-update
15595 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15596 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15597 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15598 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15599 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
15600
15601 @lisp
15602 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15603 @end lisp
15604
15605 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15606 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15607 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15608 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15609 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15610 value.
15611
15612 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15613 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15614 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15615 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
15616
15617 @node Incorporating Old Mail
15618 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15619 @cindex incorporating old mail
15620 @cindex import old mail
15621
15622 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15623 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15624 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15625 your mail groups.
15626
15627 Doing so can be quite easy.
15628
15629 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15630 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15631 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15632 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15633 your @code{nnml} groups.
15634
15635 Here's how:
15636
15637 @enumerate
15638 @item
15639 Go to the group buffer.
15640
15641 @item
15642 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15643 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15644
15645 @item
15646 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
15647
15648 @item
15649 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15650 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
15651
15652 @item
15653 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15654 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15655 @end enumerate
15656
15657 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15658 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15659 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15660 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15661 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
15662
15663 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15664 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15665 using the new mail back end.
15666
15667
15668 @node Expiring Mail
15669 @subsection Expiring Mail
15670 @cindex article expiry
15671 @cindex expiring mail
15672
15673 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15674 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15675 different approach to mail reading.
15676
15677 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15678 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15679 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15680 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15681 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15682 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15683 course.
15684
15685 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15686 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15687 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15688 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15689 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15690 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15691 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15692 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15693 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
15694
15695 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-marks
15696 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15697 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15698 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15699 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15700 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15701 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
15702 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} (and so on) are considered
15703 expirable. @code{gnus-auto-expirable-marks} has the full list of
15704 these marks.
15705
15706 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15707 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15708 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15709 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15710 into its own group.)
15711
15712 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15713 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15714 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15715 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15716 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15717 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15718 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15719 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15720 scoring.
15721
15722 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15723 Groups that match the regular expression
15724 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15725 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15726 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
15727
15728 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15729 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15730 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15731 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15732 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15733
15734 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
15735 @lisp
15736 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15737 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15738 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
15739 @end lisp
15740
15741 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15742 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15743 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15744 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15745 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15746
15747 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15748 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15749
15750 @lisp
15751 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15752 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
15753 @end lisp
15754
15755 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15756 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
15757
15758 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15759 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15760 don't really mix very well.
15761
15762 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15763 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15764 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15765 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15766 days.
15767
15768 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15769 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15770 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15771 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15772 everywhere else:
15773
15774 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15775 @lisp
15776 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15777 (lambda (group)
15778 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15779 31)
15780 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15781 1)
15782 ((string= group "important")
15783 'never)
15784 (t
15785 6))))
15786 @end lisp
15787
15788 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15789 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
15790
15791 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15792 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15793 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15794 @code{never}.
15795
15796 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15797 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
15798
15799 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15800 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15801 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15802 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15803 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15804 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15805 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15806 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15807 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15808 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15809 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15810 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15811 name or @code{delete}.
15812
15813 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15814 @lisp
15815 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15816 @end lisp
15817
15818 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15819 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15820 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15821 expire mail to groups according to the variable
15822 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
15823
15824 @lisp
15825 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15826 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15827 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15828 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15829 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15830 @end lisp
15831
15832 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15833 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15834 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15835 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15836 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15837 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
15838
15839 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15840 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15841 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15842 easier for procmail users.
15843
15844 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15845 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15846 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15847 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15848 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15849 caution. Even more dangerous is the
15850 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15851 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15852 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15853 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15854 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15855 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15856 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15857 with! So there!
15858
15859 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
15860
15861 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15862 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15863 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15864 auto-expire turned on.
15865
15866 @vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
15867 The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
15868 them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
15869 preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
15870 hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
15871 articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
15872 when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
15873 will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
15874 marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
15875 articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
15876 don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
15877 into auto-expire groups, you can set
15878 @code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
15879 non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
15880 be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
15881 group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
15882
15883
15884 @node Washing Mail
15885 @subsection Washing Mail
15886 @cindex mail washing
15887 @cindex list server brain damage
15888 @cindex incoming mail treatment
15889
15890 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15891 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15892 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15893 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15894 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15895 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
15896
15897 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15898 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15899 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15900 laugh.
15901
15902 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15903 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15904 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15905 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
15906
15907 @table @code
15908 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15909 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15910 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15911 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15912 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
15913
15914 @table @code
15915 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15916 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15917 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15918 Emacs running on MS machines.
15919
15920 @end table
15921
15922 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15923 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15924 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15925 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
15926
15927 @table @code
15928 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15929 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15930 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15931 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
15932
15933 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15934 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15935 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15936 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
15937 into a feature by documenting it.)
15938
15939 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15940 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15941 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
15942 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
15943 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
15944 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
15945 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
15946 @code{\\(..\\)}.
15947
15948 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
15949 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
15950
15951 @lisp
15952 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
15953 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
15954 @end lisp
15955
15956 This can also be done non-destructively with
15957 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
15958
15959 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
15960 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
15961 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
15962
15963 @item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15964 @findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15965 @c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
15966 @cindex Eudora
15967 @cindex Pegasus
15968 Some mail user agents (e.g., Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
15969 @code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
15970 function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
15971 contain a line matching the regular expression
15972 @code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
15973
15974 @end table
15975
15976 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15977 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15978 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
15979 include:
15980
15981 @table @code
15982 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
15983 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
15984 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
15985
15986 @end table
15987 @end table
15988
15989
15990 @node Duplicates
15991 @subsection Duplicates
15992
15993 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
15994 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
15995 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
15996 @cindex duplicate mails
15997 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
15998 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
15999 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
16000 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s:
16001 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
16002 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
16003 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
16004 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
16005 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
16006 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
16007 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
16008 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
16009 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
16010
16011 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
16012 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
16013 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
16014 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
16015
16016 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
16017 @code{nil}.
16018
16019 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
16020 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
16021 methods:
16022
16023 @lisp
16024 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
16025 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
16026 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
16027 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
16028 (any mail "mail.misc")
16029 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16030 [...] ))
16031 @end lisp
16032 @noindent
16033 Or something like:
16034 @lisp
16035 (setq nnmail-split-methods
16036 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
16037 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16038 [...]))
16039 @end lisp
16040
16041 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
16042 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
16043 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
16044 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
16045 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
16046
16047
16048 @node Not Reading Mail
16049 @subsection Not Reading Mail
16050
16051 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
16052 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
16053 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
16054
16055 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
16056 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
16057 mail, which should help.
16058
16059 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16060 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16061 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16062 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16063 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16064 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16065 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
16066 23) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16067 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16068 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16069 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16070
16071 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16072 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16073 incoming mail.
16074
16075
16076 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
16077 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16078
16079 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16080 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16081 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16082
16083 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16084 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16085 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16086 Spool}).
16087
16088 @menu
16089 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16090 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
16091 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16092 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16093 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16094 * nnmaildir Group Parameters::
16095 * Article Identification::
16096 * NOV Data::
16097 * Article Marks::
16098 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16099 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16100 @end menu
16101
16102
16103
16104 @node Unix Mail Box
16105 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16106 @cindex nnmbox
16107 @cindex unix mail box
16108
16109 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16110 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16111 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16112 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16113 which group it belongs in.
16114
16115 Virtual server settings:
16116
16117 @table @code
16118 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
16119 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16120 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16121 @file{~/mbox}.
16122
16123 @item nnmbox-active-file
16124 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16125 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16126 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
16127
16128 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16129 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16130 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16131 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16132 @end table
16133
16134
16135 @node Babyl
16136 @subsubsection Babyl
16137 @cindex nnbabyl
16138
16139 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16140 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16141 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16142 @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16143 group it belongs in.
16144
16145 Virtual server settings:
16146
16147 @table @code
16148 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16149 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16150 The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
16151
16152 @item nnbabyl-active-file
16153 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16154 The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
16155 @file{~/.rmail-active}
16156
16157 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16158 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16159 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16160 @code{t}
16161 @end table
16162
16163
16164 @node Mail Spool
16165 @subsubsection Mail Spool
16166 @cindex nnml
16167 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16168
16169 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16170 format. It should be used with some caution.
16171
16172 @vindex nnml-directory
16173 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16174 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16175 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16176 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16177
16178 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16179 care of all that.
16180
16181 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16182 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16183 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16184 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16185 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16186 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16187 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16188 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16189
16190 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16191 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16192 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16193 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16194
16195 Virtual server settings:
16196
16197 @table @code
16198 @item nnml-directory
16199 @vindex nnml-directory
16200 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16201 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16202 is @file{~/Mail}).
16203
16204 @item nnml-active-file
16205 @vindex nnml-active-file
16206 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16207 @file{~/Mail/active}.
16208
16209 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
16210 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16211 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16212 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16213
16214 @item nnml-get-new-mail
16215 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16216 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16217 @code{t}.
16218
16219 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
16220 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16221 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16222 default is @code{nil}.
16223
16224 @item nnml-nov-file-name
16225 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16226 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16227
16228 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16229 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16230 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16231
16232 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
16233 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16234 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16235 files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16236 (@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16237 If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16238 as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16239 to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16240 equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16241
16242 @item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16243 @vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16244 Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16245 bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16246 if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
16247
16248 @end table
16249
16250 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16251 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16252 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16253 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16254 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16255 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16256 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16257 Commands}).
16258
16259
16260 @node MH Spool
16261 @subsubsection MH Spool
16262 @cindex nnmh
16263 @cindex mh-e mail spool
16264
16265 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16266 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16267 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16268 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16269 for.
16270
16271 Virtual server settings:
16272
16273 @table @code
16274 @item nnmh-directory
16275 @vindex nnmh-directory
16276 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16277 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16278 @file{~/Mail})
16279
16280 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
16281 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16282 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16283 @code{t}.
16284
16285 @item nnmh-be-safe
16286 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
16287 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16288 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16289 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16290 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16291 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16292 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16293 @end table
16294
16295
16296 @node Maildir
16297 @subsubsection Maildir
16298 @cindex nnmaildir
16299 @cindex maildir
16300
16301 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16302 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16303 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16304 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16305 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16306 within a maildir.
16307
16308 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16309 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16310 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16311 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16312 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16313 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16314 that appear as group in Gnus.
16315
16316 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16317 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16318 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16319
16320 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16321 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16322 another, and you will keep your marks.
16323
16324 Virtual server settings:
16325
16326 @table @code
16327 @item directory
16328 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16329 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16330 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16331 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16332 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16333 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16334 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16335 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16336 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16337 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16338
16339 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16340 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16341 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16342 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16343 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16344 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16345 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16346 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16347 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16348 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16349 value.
16350
16351 @item target-prefix
16352 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16353 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16354 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16355 closed.
16356
16357 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16358 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16359 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16360 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16361 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16362 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16363 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16364 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16365 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
16366
16367 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16368 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16369 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16370 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16371 symlinks pointing to them will be).
16372
16373 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16374 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16375 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16376 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16377 @code{force} argument.
16378
16379 @item directory-files
16380 This should be a function with the same interface as
16381 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16382 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16383 parameter is optional; the default is
16384 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16385 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16386 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
16387 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16388 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16389 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16390
16391 @item get-new-mail
16392 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16393 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16394 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16395 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16396 value is @code{nil}.
16397
16398 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16399 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16400 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16401 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16402 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16403 @end table
16404
16405 @node nnmaildir Group Parameters
16406 @subsubsection Group parameters
16407
16408 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16409 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16410 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16411 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16412 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16413 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16414 another back end.
16415
16416 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16417 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16418 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16419 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16420 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16421 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16422 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16423 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16424 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16425
16426 @table @code
16427 @item expire-age
16428 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16429 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16430 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16431 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16432 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16433 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16434 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16435 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
16436 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16437 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16438 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16439 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16440 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16441
16442 @item expire-group
16443 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16444 @example
16445 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16446 @end example
16447 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16448 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16449 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16450 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16451 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16452 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16453 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16454 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16455 article. So that form can refer to
16456 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16457 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16458 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16459 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16460
16461 @item read-only
16462 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16463 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16464 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16465 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16466 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16467 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16468 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16469 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16470 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16471 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16472 contain extra copies of the articles.
16473
16474 @item directory-files
16475 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16476 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16477 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16478 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16479
16480 @item distrust-Lines:
16481 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16482 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16483 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16484
16485 @item always-marks
16486 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16487 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16488 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16489 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16490 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16491 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16492
16493 @item never-marks
16494 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16495 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16496 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16497 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16498 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16499 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16500 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16501
16502 @item nov-cache-size
16503 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16504 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16505 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16506 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16507 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16508 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16509 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16510 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16511 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16512 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16513 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
16514 @end table
16515
16516 @node Article Identification
16517 @subsubsection Article identification
16518 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16519 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16520 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16521 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16522 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16523 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16524 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16525 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16526 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16527 request the article in the summary buffer.
16528
16529 @node NOV Data
16530 @subsubsection NOV data
16531 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16532 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16533 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16534 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16535 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16536 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16537 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16538 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16539 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16540 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16541 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16542
16543 @node Article Marks
16544 @subsubsection Article marks
16545 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16546 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16547 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16548 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16549 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16550 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16551 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16552 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16553
16554 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16555 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16556 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16557 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16558 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16559 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16560 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16561 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16562 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16563
16564
16565 @node Mail Folders
16566 @subsubsection Mail Folders
16567 @cindex nnfolder
16568 @cindex mbox folders
16569 @cindex mail folders
16570
16571 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16572 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16573 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16574 numbers and arrival dates.
16575
16576 Virtual server settings:
16577
16578 @table @code
16579 @item nnfolder-directory
16580 @vindex nnfolder-directory
16581 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16582 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16583 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
16584
16585 @item nnfolder-active-file
16586 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
16587 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
16588
16589 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16590 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16591 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16592 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
16593
16594 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16595 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16596 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16597 default is @code{t}
16598
16599 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16600 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16601 @cindex backup files
16602 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16603 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16604 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16605 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
16606
16607 @lisp
16608 (defun turn-off-backup ()
16609 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
16610
16611 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16612 @end lisp
16613
16614 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16615 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16616 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16617 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16618 extract some information from it before removing it.
16619
16620 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16621 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16622 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16623 default is @code{nil}.
16624
16625 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16626 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16627 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
16628
16629 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
16630 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16631 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16632 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16633
16634 @end table
16635
16636
16637 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16638 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16639 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16640 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16641 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16642 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16643 though.
16644
16645 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16646 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
16647
16648 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16649 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16650 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16651 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16652 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
16653
16654 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16655 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16656 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16657 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16658 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16659 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16660 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16661 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16662 via NFS).
16663
16664 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16665 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16666 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16667 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
16668
16669 @table @code
16670 @item nnmbox
16671
16672 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-defined
16673 format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
16674 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16675 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16676 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16677 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16678 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16679 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16680 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16681 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16682 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16683 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16684 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16685 what's where.
16686
16687 @item nnbabyl
16688
16689 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16690 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16691 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16692 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16693 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16694 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16695 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
16696 Rmail was Emacs's first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
16697 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16698 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16699 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16700 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16701 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16702 course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
16703 uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
16704
16705 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16706 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16707 look at your mail.
16708
16709 @item nnml
16710
16711 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16712 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16713 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16714 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16715 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16716 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16717 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16718 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16719 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16720 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16721 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16722 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16723 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16724 provided by the active file and overviews.
16725
16726 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16727 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16728 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16729 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16730 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16731 wins big.
16732
16733 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16734 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16735 tiny files.
16736
16737 @item nnmh
16738
16739 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16740 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16741 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16742 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16743 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16744 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16745 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
16746
16747 @item nnfolder
16748
16749 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16750 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16751 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16752 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16753 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16754 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16755 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16756 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16757 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
16758
16759 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16760 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16761 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16762 friendly mail back end all over.
16763
16764 @item nnmaildir
16765
16766 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16767 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16768 mail back ends.
16769
16770 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16771 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16772 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16773 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16774 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}.
16775 (Use @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this
16776 slows you down or takes up very much space, a non-block-structured
16777 file system.
16778
16779 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16780 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16781 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16782 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16783 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16784 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16785 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16786 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16787 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16788 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16789 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
16790
16791 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16792 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16793 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
16794 else, and still have your marks.
16795
16796 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16797 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16798 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16799 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16800 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16801 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16802 removed in the future.
16803
16804 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16805 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16806 on your file system.
16807
16808 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16809 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
16810
16811 @end table
16812
16813
16814 @node Browsing the Web
16815 @section Browsing the Web
16816 @cindex web
16817 @cindex browsing the web
16818 @cindex www
16819 @cindex http
16820
16821 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16822 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16823 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16824 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16825 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16826 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16827 even know what a news group is.
16828
16829 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16830 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16831 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16832 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16833 you mad in the end.
16834
16835 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16836 to do it instead?
16837
16838 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16839 interfaces to these sources.
16840
16841 @menu
16842 * Archiving Mail::
16843 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16844 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16845 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
16846 @end menu
16847
16848 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
16849 alternatives to work.
16850
16851 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16852 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16853 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16854 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16855 though, you should be ok.
16856
16857 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16858 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16859 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16860 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16861 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
16862
16863 @node Archiving Mail
16864 @subsection Archiving Mail
16865 @cindex archiving mail
16866 @cindex backup of mail
16867
16868 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16869 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16870 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16871 marks is fairly simple.
16872
16873 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16874 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16875 though.)
16876
16877 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16878 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16879 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16880 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16881 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16882 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16883 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16884 before you restore the data.
16885
16886 @node Web Searches
16887 @subsection Web Searches
16888 @cindex nnweb
16889 @cindex Google
16890 @cindex dejanews
16891 @cindex gmane
16892 @cindex Usenet searches
16893 @cindex searching the Usenet
16894
16895 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16896 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16897 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16898 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16899 searches without having to use a browser.
16900
16901 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16902 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16903 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16904 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16905 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
16906
16907 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16908 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16909 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16910 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16911 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16912 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16913 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16914 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16915 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16916 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16917 group as read.
16918
16919 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16920 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
16921 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
16922 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16923 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16924 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
16925
16926 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
16927 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
16928 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
16929
16930 Virtual server variables:
16931
16932 @table @code
16933 @item nnweb-type
16934 @vindex nnweb-type
16935 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16936 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16937 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
16938
16939 @item nnweb-search
16940 @vindex nnweb-search
16941 The search string to feed to the search engine.
16942
16943 @item nnweb-max-hits
16944 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
16945 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16946 999.
16947
16948 @item nnweb-type-definition
16949 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
16950 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
16951 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
16952 present:
16953
16954 @table @code
16955 @item article
16956 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
16957 understands.
16958
16959 @item map
16960 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
16961
16962 @item search
16963 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
16964
16965 @item address
16966 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16967 to.
16968
16969 @item id
16970 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16971 @end table
16972
16973 @end table
16974
16975
16976 @node RSS
16977 @subsection RSS
16978 @cindex nnrss
16979 @cindex RSS
16980
16981 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16982 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16983 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16984 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16985 changes to a wiki (e.g., @url{http://cliki.net/site/recent-changes}).
16986
16987 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16988 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16989
16990 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16991 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16992 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16993 group names.
16994
16995 @kindex G R (Group)
16996 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16997 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16998 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16999 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
17000
17001 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
17002 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
17003 subscribe to groups.
17004
17005 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
17006 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
17007 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
17008 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
17009 variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
17010 information.
17011
17012 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
17013 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
17014 and a @samp{text/html} part.
17015
17016 @cindex OPML
17017 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
17018 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
17019 Markup Language).
17020
17021 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
17022 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
17023 file.
17024 @end defun
17025
17026 @defun nnrss-opml-export
17027 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
17028 @acronym{OPML} format.
17029 @end defun
17030
17031 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
17032
17033 @table @code
17034 @item nnrss-directory
17035 @vindex nnrss-directory
17036 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
17037 @file{~/News/rss/}.
17038
17039 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
17040 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
17041 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
17042 data files. The default is the value of
17043 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
17044 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
17045
17046 @item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17047 @vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17048 Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
17049 e.g., to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
17050 a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
17051 is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
17052 variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
17053 @code{'(slash:comments)}.
17054
17055 @item nnrss-use-local
17056 @vindex nnrss-use-local
17057 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17058 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17059 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17060 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17061 download script using @command{wget}.
17062 @end table
17063
17064 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17065 the summary buffer.
17066
17067 @lisp
17068 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17069 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
17070
17071 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17072 (let ((descr
17073 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17074 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17075 @end lisp
17076
17077 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17078 summary buffer.
17079
17080 @lisp
17081 (require 'browse-url)
17082
17083 (defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17084 (interactive "p")
17085 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17086 (mail-header-extra
17087 (gnus-data-header
17088 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17089 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17090 (if url
17091 (progn
17092 (browse-url (cdr url))
17093 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17094 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17095
17096 (eval-after-load "gnus"
17097 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17098 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17099 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17100 @end lisp
17101
17102 Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17103 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17104 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17105 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17106 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17107 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17108 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17109 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17110 @code{nnrss} groups:
17111
17112 @lisp
17113 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17114 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17115 '(add-to-list
17116 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17117 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17118 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17119
17120 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17121 (add-to-list
17122 'gnus-parameters
17123 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17124 @end lisp
17125
17126
17127 @node Customizing W3
17128 @subsection Customizing W3
17129 @cindex W3
17130 @cindex html
17131 @cindex url
17132 @cindex Netscape
17133
17134 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17135 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17136 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17137 users.
17138
17139 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17140 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17141 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
17142
17143 @lisp
17144 (eval-after-load "w3"
17145 '(progn
17146 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17147 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17148 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17149 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17150 (browse-url url)
17151 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17152 @end lisp
17153
17154 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17155 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17156 follow the link.
17157
17158
17159 @node Other Sources
17160 @section Other Sources
17161
17162 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17163 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17164 newsgroups.
17165
17166 @menu
17167 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17168 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17169 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17170 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17171 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
17172 @end menu
17173
17174
17175 @node Directory Groups
17176 @subsection Directory Groups
17177 @cindex nndir
17178 @cindex directory groups
17179
17180 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17181 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17182 names, of course.
17183
17184 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17185 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17186 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17187 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17188
17189 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17190 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17191 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17192 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17193 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17194
17195 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17196
17197 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17198 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17199 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17200 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17201
17202
17203 @node Anything Groups
17204 @subsection Anything Groups
17205 @cindex nneething
17206
17207 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17208 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17209 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17210 true.
17211
17212 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17213 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17214 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17215 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17216 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17217 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17218 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17219 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g., a C source file),
17220 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17221 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17222 elements.
17223
17224 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17225 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17226 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17227 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17228
17229 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17230 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17231 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17232 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17233
17234 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17235 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17236 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17237 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17238 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17239 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17240 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17241 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17242
17243 Some variables:
17244
17245 @table @code
17246 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17247 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17248 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17249 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17250
17251 @item nneething-exclude-files
17252 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17253 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17254 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17255
17256 @item nneething-include-files
17257 @vindex nneething-include-files
17258 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17259 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17260
17261 @item nneething-map-file
17262 @vindex nneething-map-file
17263 Name of the map files.
17264 @end table
17265
17266
17267 @node Document Groups
17268 @subsection Document Groups
17269 @cindex nndoc
17270 @cindex documentation group
17271 @cindex help group
17272
17273 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17274 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17275
17276 @table @code
17277 @cindex Babyl
17278 @item babyl
17279 The Babyl format.
17280
17281 @cindex mbox
17282 @cindex Unix mbox
17283 @item mbox
17284 The standard Unix mbox file.
17285
17286 @cindex MMDF mail box
17287 @item mmdf
17288 The MMDF mail box format.
17289
17290 @item news
17291 Several news articles appended into a file.
17292
17293 @cindex rnews batch files
17294 @item rnews
17295 The rnews batch transport format.
17296
17297 @item nsmail
17298 Netscape mail boxes.
17299
17300 @item mime-parts
17301 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17302
17303 @item standard-digest
17304 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17305
17306 @item mime-digest
17307 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17308
17309 @item lanl-gov-announce
17310 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17311
17312 @cindex git commit messages
17313 @item git
17314 @code{git} commit messages.
17315
17316 @cindex forwarded messages
17317 @item rfc822-forward
17318 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17319
17320 @item outlook
17321 The Outlook mail box.
17322
17323 @item oe-dbx
17324 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17325
17326 @item exim-bounce
17327 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17328
17329 @item forward
17330 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17331
17332 @item rfc934
17333 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17334
17335 @item mailman
17336 A mailman digest.
17337
17338 @item clari-briefs
17339 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17340
17341 @item slack-digest
17342 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17343
17344 @item mail-in-mail
17345 The last resort.
17346 @end table
17347
17348 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17349 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17350 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17351 file is.
17352
17353 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17354 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17355 group. And that's it.
17356
17357 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17358 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17359 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17360 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17361 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17362 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17363 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17364 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17365 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17366 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17367
17368 Virtual server variables:
17369
17370 @table @code
17371 @item nndoc-article-type
17372 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17373 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17374 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17375 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17376 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17377 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17378
17379 @item nndoc-post-type
17380 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17381 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17382 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17383 and @code{news}.
17384 @end table
17385
17386 @menu
17387 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17388 @end menu
17389
17390
17391 @node Document Server Internals
17392 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17393
17394 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17395 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17396 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17397 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17398
17399 First, here's an example document type definition:
17400
17401 @example
17402 (mmdf
17403 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17404 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17405 @end example
17406
17407 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17408 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17409 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17410 types can be defined with very few settings:
17411
17412 @table @code
17413 @item first-article
17414 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17415 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17416 totally ignored.
17417
17418 @item article-begin
17419 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17420 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17421 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17422 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17423
17424 @item article-begin-function
17425 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17426 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17427
17428 @item head-begin
17429 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17430 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17431 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17432
17433 @item head-begin-function
17434 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17435 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17436
17437 @item head-end
17438 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17439 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17440
17441 @item body-begin
17442 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17443 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17444 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17445
17446 @item body-begin-function
17447 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17448 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17449
17450 @item body-end
17451 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17452 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17453 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17454
17455 @item body-end-function
17456 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17457 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17458
17459 @item file-begin
17460 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17461 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17462
17463 @item file-end
17464 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17465 regexp will be totally ignored.
17466
17467 @end table
17468
17469 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17470 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17471 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17472 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17473 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17474
17475 @table @code
17476 @item prepare-body-function
17477 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17478 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17479 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17480
17481 @item article-transform-function
17482 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17483 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17484 body of the article.
17485
17486 @item generate-head-function
17487 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17488 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17489 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17490 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17491
17492 @item generate-article-function
17493 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17494 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17495 parameter when requesting all articles.
17496
17497 @item dissection-function
17498 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17499 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17500 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17501 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17502 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17503 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17504
17505 @end table
17506
17507 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17508 digests:
17509
17510 @example
17511 (standard-digest
17512 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17513 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17514 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17515 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17516 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17517 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17518 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17519 (subtype digest guess))
17520 @end example
17521
17522 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17523 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17524 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17525 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17526 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17527
17528 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17529 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17530 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17531 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17532 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17533 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17534 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17535 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17536 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17537 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17538 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17539 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17540
17541
17542 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17543 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17544 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17545 @cindex gateways
17546
17547 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17548 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17549 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17550
17551 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17552 used to post with.
17553
17554 Server variables:
17555
17556 @table @code
17557 @item nngateway-address
17558 @vindex nngateway-address
17559 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17560
17561 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17562 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17563 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17564 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17565 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17566 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17567 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17568 gateway address.
17569
17570 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17571 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17572 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17573
17574 @example
17575 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17576 @end example
17577
17578 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17579
17580 @example
17581 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17582 @end example
17583
17584 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17585
17586 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17587 @table @code
17588
17589 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17590 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17591 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17592
17593 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17594
17595 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17596 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17597 @code{nngateway-address}.
17598 @end table
17599
17600 @end table
17601
17602 Here's an example:
17603
17604 @lisp
17605 (setq gnus-post-method
17606 '(nngateway
17607 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17608 (nngateway-header-transformation
17609 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17610 @end lisp
17611
17612 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17613
17614 @lisp
17615 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17616 @end lisp
17617
17618
17619 @node The Empty Backend
17620 @subsection The Empty Backend
17621 @cindex nnnil
17622
17623 @code{nnnil} is a backend that can be used as a placeholder if you
17624 have to specify a backend somewhere, but don't really want to. The
17625 classical example is if you don't want to have a primary select
17626 methods, but want to only use secondary ones:
17627
17628 @lisp
17629 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnnil ""))
17630 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17631 '((nnimap "foo")
17632 (nnml "")))
17633 @end lisp
17634
17635
17636 @node Combined Groups
17637 @section Combined Groups
17638
17639 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17640 groups.
17641
17642 @menu
17643 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17644 @end menu
17645
17646
17647 @node Virtual Groups
17648 @subsection Virtual Groups
17649 @cindex nnvirtual
17650 @cindex virtual groups
17651 @cindex merging groups
17652
17653 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17654 other groups.
17655
17656 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17657 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17658 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17659
17660 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17661 regexp to match component groups.
17662
17663 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17664 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17665 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17666 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17667 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17668 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17669 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17670 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17671
17672 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17673 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17674
17675 @lisp
17676 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17677 @end lisp
17678
17679 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17680 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17681
17682 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17683 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17684 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17685 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17686
17687 @example
17688 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17689 @end example
17690
17691 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17692 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17693 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17694
17695 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17696 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17697 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17698 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17699 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17700
17701 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17702 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17703 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17704
17705 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17706 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17707 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17708 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17709 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17710 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17711 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17712 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17713 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17714 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17715 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17716
17717 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17718 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17719 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17720 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17721 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17722 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17723 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17724
17725 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17726 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17727
17728 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17729 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17730 inherited.
17731
17732
17733 @node Email Based Diary
17734 @section Email Based Diary
17735 @cindex diary
17736 @cindex email based diary
17737 @cindex calendar
17738
17739 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17740 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17741 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17742 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17743 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17744 namely, as event reminders.
17745
17746 Here is a typical scenario:
17747
17748 @itemize @bullet
17749 @item
17750 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17751 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17752 @item
17753 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17754 @item
17755 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17756 @item
17757 From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17758 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17759 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17760 @item
17761 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17762 of the night you're gonna have.
17763 @item
17764 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17765 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17766 @end itemize
17767
17768 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17769 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17770 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17771 explained in the sections below.
17772
17773 @menu
17774 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17775 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17776 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17777 @end menu
17778
17779
17780 @node The NNDiary Back End
17781 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
17782 @cindex nndiary
17783 @cindex the nndiary back end
17784
17785 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17786 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17787 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17788 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17789 directory per group.
17790
17791 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17792 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17793 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17794 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
17795
17796 @menu
17797 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17798 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17799 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17800 @end menu
17801
17802 @node Diary Messages
17803 @subsubsection Diary Messages
17804 @cindex nndiary messages
17805 @cindex nndiary mails
17806
17807 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17808 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17809 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17810 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17811 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17812 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17813 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
17814
17815 @itemize @bullet
17816 @item
17817 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17818 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17819 (separated by a comma).
17820 @item
17821 A field is either an integer, or a range.
17822 @item
17823 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17824 @item
17825 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
17826 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
17827 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
17828 @item
17829 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
17830 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
17831 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
17832 @item
17833 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
17834 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
17835 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
17836 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
17837 list of available time zone values, see the variable
17838 @code{nndiary-headers}.
17839 @end itemize
17840
17841 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
17842 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
17843 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
17844 what to do then):
17845
17846 @example
17847 X-Diary-Minute: 0
17848 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
17849 X-Diary-Dom: 1
17850 X-Diary-Month: *
17851 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
17852 X-Diary-Dow: 1
17853 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
17854 @end example
17855
17856 @node Running NNDiary
17857 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
17858 @cindex running nndiary
17859 @cindex nndiary operation modes
17860
17861 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
17862 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
17863 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
17864 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
17865 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
17866 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
17867
17868 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
17869 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
17870 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
17871 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
17872 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
17873 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
17874 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
17875 mode.
17876
17877 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
17878 things to do:
17879
17880 @itemize @bullet
17881 @item
17882 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
17883 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17884
17885 @lisp
17886 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
17887 @end lisp
17888 @item
17889 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
17890 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
17891 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
17892 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
17893 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
17894
17895 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
17896 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
17897
17898 @example
17899 :0 HD :
17900 * ^X-Diary
17901 .nndiary
17902 @end example
17903 @end itemize
17904
17905 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
17906 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
17907
17908 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
17909 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17910 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
17911 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
17912 @end defvar
17913
17914 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
17915 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17916 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
17917 @end defvar
17918
17919 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
17920 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
17921 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
17922
17923 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
17924 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
17925 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
17926 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
17927 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
17928
17929 @node Customizing NNDiary
17930 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
17931 @cindex customizing nndiary
17932 @cindex nndiary customization
17933
17934 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
17935 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
17936 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
17937 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
17938
17939 @defvar nndiary-reminders
17940 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
17941 appointments (e.g., 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
17942 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
17943 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
17944 mail.
17945 @end defvar
17946
17947 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
17948 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
17949 default).
17950 @end defvar
17951
17952
17953 @node The Gnus Diary Library
17954 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
17955 @cindex gnus-diary
17956 @cindex the gnus diary library
17957
17958 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
17959 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
17960 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
17961 useful things for you.
17962
17963 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17964
17965 @lisp
17966 (require 'gnus-diary)
17967 @end lisp
17968
17969 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
17970 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
17971 (sorry if you used them before).
17972
17973
17974 @menu
17975 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
17976 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
17977 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
17978 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
17979 @end menu
17980
17981 @node Diary Summary Line Format
17982 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
17983 @cindex diary summary buffer line
17984 @cindex diary summary line format
17985
17986 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
17987 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
17988 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
17989 see the event's date.
17990
17991 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
17992 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
17993 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
17994 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximate remaining time until the
17995 next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
17996
17997 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
17998 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
17999 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
18000
18001 @example
18002 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
18003 @end example
18004
18005 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
18006 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
18007
18008 @lisp
18009 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
18010 @end lisp
18011
18012 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
18013 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
18014 with the following user options:
18015
18016 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
18017 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
18018 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
18019 diary groups'parameters.
18020 @end defvar
18021
18022 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
18023 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
18024 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
18025 @end defvar
18026
18027 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
18028 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
18029 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
18030 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
18031 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
18032 @end defvar
18033
18034 @node Diary Articles Sorting
18035 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
18036 @cindex diary articles sorting
18037 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
18038 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
18039 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
18040 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
18041
18042 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
18043 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18044 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18045 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18046 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
18047
18048 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18049 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18050 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18051 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18052 Parameters}).
18053
18054 @node Diary Headers Generation
18055 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18056 @cindex diary headers generation
18057 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
18058
18059 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18060 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18061 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18062 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18063 needed.
18064
18065 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18066 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18067 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
18068 @code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
18069 process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
18070
18071 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18072 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18073 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18074 instance.
18075
18076 @node Diary Group Parameters
18077 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18078 @cindex diary group parameters
18079
18080 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18081 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18082 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18083 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18084 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18085 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18086 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18087 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18088
18089 @node Sending or Not Sending
18090 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18091
18092 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18093 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18094
18095 @itemize @bullet
18096 @item
18097 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18098 messages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18099 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18100 sending the diary message to them as well.
18101 @item
18102 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18103 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18104 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18105 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18106 @end itemize
18107
18108 @node Gnus Unplugged
18109 @section Gnus Unplugged
18110 @cindex offline
18111 @cindex unplugged
18112 @cindex agent
18113 @cindex Gnus agent
18114 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18115
18116 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18117 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18118 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18119 read news. Believe it or not.
18120
18121 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18122 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18123 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18124 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18125 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18126
18127 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18128 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18129 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18130 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18131 reading news on a machine.
18132
18133 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18134 fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18135 by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
18136
18137 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18138
18139 @menu
18140 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18141 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18142 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18143 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18144 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18145 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18146 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18147 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
18148 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18149 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18150 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18151 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18152 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18153 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18154 @end menu
18155
18156
18157 @node Agent Basics
18158 @subsection Agent Basics
18159
18160 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18161
18162 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18163 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18164 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18165 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18166
18167 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18168 connected to the net continuously.
18169
18170 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18171 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18172
18173 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18174 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18175 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18176 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18177 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18178
18179 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18180 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18181 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18182 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18183 they're kinda like plugged always).
18184
18185 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18186 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18187 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18188 the culprit.
18189
18190 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18191 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18192 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18193 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18194 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18195
18196 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18197
18198 @itemize @bullet
18199
18200 @item
18201 @findex gnus-unplugged
18202 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18203 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18204 already fetched while in this mode.
18205
18206 @item
18207 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18208 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18209 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18210 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18211 Source Specifiers}).
18212
18213 @item
18214 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18215 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18216 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18217 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18218 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18219
18220 @item
18221 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18222 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18223 then you read the news offline.
18224
18225 @item
18226 And then you go to step 2.
18227 @end itemize
18228
18229 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18230 the Agent.
18231
18232 @itemize @bullet
18233
18234 @item
18235 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18236 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18237 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18238 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18239 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18240 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18241 no servers are agentized.
18242
18243 @item
18244 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18245 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18246 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18247 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18248
18249 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18250 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18251 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18252 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18253 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18254 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18255 configure them.
18256
18257 @item
18258 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18259 @end itemize
18260
18261
18262 @node Agent Categories
18263 @subsection Agent Categories
18264
18265 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18266 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18267 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18268 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18269 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18270 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18271 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18272
18273 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18274 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18275 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18276 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18277 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18278
18279 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18280 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18281 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18282 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18283 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18284 sink.
18285
18286 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18287 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18288 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18289 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18290 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18291 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18292 your settings.
18293
18294 @menu
18295 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18296 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18297 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18298 @end menu
18299
18300
18301 @node Category Syntax
18302 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18303
18304 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18305 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18306 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18307 listed below.
18308
18309 @cindex Agent Parameters
18310 @table @code
18311 @item agent-groups
18312 The list of groups that are in this category.
18313
18314 @item agent-predicate
18315 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18316 are eligible for downloading; and
18317
18318 @item agent-score
18319 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18320 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18321 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18322
18323 @item agent-enable-expiration
18324 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18325 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18326 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18327 only groups that should not be expired.
18328
18329 @item agent-days-until-old
18330 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18331 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18332
18333 @item agent-low-score
18334 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18335
18336 @item agent-high-score
18337 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18338
18339 @item agent-short-article
18340 an integer that overrides the value of
18341 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18342
18343 @item agent-long-article
18344 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18345
18346 @item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
18347 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18348 undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
18349 faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
18350 undownloaded faces.
18351 @end table
18352
18353 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18354 created.
18355
18356 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18357 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18358 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18359 category.
18360
18361 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18362 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18363 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18364 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18365
18366 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18367 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18368 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18369
18370 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18371 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18372 operators sprinkled in between.
18373
18374 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18375
18376 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18377 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18378
18379 @lisp
18380 short
18381 @end lisp
18382
18383 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18384 short (for some value of ``short'').
18385
18386 Here's a more complex predicate:
18387
18388 @lisp
18389 (or high
18390 (and
18391 (not low)
18392 (not long)))
18393 @end lisp
18394
18395 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18396 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18397 drift.
18398
18399 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18400 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18401 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18402
18403 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18404 you want to do, you can write your own.
18405
18406 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18407 bound to the value determined by calling
18408 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18409 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18410 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18411 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18412 predicate to individual groups.
18413
18414 @table @code
18415 @item short
18416 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18417 lines; default 100.
18418
18419 @item long
18420 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18421 lines; default 200.
18422
18423 @item low
18424 True if the article has a download score less than
18425 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18426
18427 @item high
18428 True if the article has a download score greater than
18429 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18430
18431 @item spam
18432 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18433 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18434 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18435
18436 @item true
18437 Always true.
18438
18439 @item false
18440 Always false.
18441 @end table
18442
18443 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18444 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18445 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18446 useful values.
18447
18448 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18449 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g., posted
18450 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18451 something along the lines of the following:
18452
18453 @lisp
18454 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18455 "Say whether an article is old."
18456 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18457 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18458 @end lisp
18459
18460 with the predicate then defined as:
18461
18462 @lisp
18463 (not my-article-old-p)
18464 @end lisp
18465
18466 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18467 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18468 wherever.
18469
18470 @lisp
18471 (require 'gnus-agent)
18472 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18473 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18474 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18475 @end lisp
18476
18477 and simply specify your predicate as:
18478
18479 @lisp
18480 (not old)
18481 @end lisp
18482
18483 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18484 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18485 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18486 just don't give a damn.
18487
18488 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18489 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18490 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18491 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18492 parameters like so:
18493
18494 @lisp
18495 (agent-predicate . short)
18496 @end lisp
18497
18498 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18499 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18500 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18501
18502 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18503
18504 @lisp
18505 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18506 @end lisp
18507
18508 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18509 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18510 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18511
18512
18513 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18514 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18515 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18516 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18517 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18518 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18519
18520 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18521 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18522 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18523 if it's to be specific to that group.
18524
18525 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18526 three forms:
18527
18528 @enumerate
18529 @item
18530 Score rule
18531
18532 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18533 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18534
18535 example:
18536
18537 @itemize @bullet
18538 @item
18539 Category specification
18540
18541 @lisp
18542 (("from"
18543 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18544 ("lines"
18545 (500 -100 nil <)))
18546 @end lisp
18547
18548 @item
18549 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18550
18551 @lisp
18552 (agent-score ("from"
18553 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18554 ("lines"
18555 (500 -100 nil <)))
18556 @end lisp
18557
18558 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18559 @end itemize
18560
18561 @item
18562 Agent score file
18563
18564 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18565 keywords stated above.
18566
18567 example:
18568
18569 @itemize @bullet
18570 @item
18571 Category specification
18572
18573 @lisp
18574 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18575 @end lisp
18576
18577 or perhaps
18578
18579 @lisp
18580 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18581 @end lisp
18582
18583 @item
18584 Group Parameter specification
18585
18586 @lisp
18587 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18588 @end lisp
18589
18590 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18591 about parenthesis?
18592 @end itemize
18593
18594 @item
18595 Use @code{normal} score files
18596
18597 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18598 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18599 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18600 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18601
18602 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18603 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18604 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18605 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18606
18607 @itemize @bullet
18608 @item
18609 Category Specification
18610
18611 @lisp
18612 file
18613 @end lisp
18614
18615 @item
18616 Group Parameter specification
18617
18618 @lisp
18619 (agent-score . file)
18620 @end lisp
18621 @end itemize
18622 @end enumerate
18623
18624 @node Category Buffer
18625 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18626
18627 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18628 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18629 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18630
18631 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18632
18633 @table @kbd
18634 @item q
18635 @kindex q (Category)
18636 @findex gnus-category-exit
18637 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18638
18639 @item e
18640 @kindex e (Category)
18641 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18642 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18643 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18644
18645 @item k
18646 @kindex k (Category)
18647 @findex gnus-category-kill
18648 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18649
18650 @item c
18651 @kindex c (Category)
18652 @findex gnus-category-copy
18653 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18654
18655 @item a
18656 @kindex a (Category)
18657 @findex gnus-category-add
18658 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18659
18660 @item p
18661 @kindex p (Category)
18662 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18663 Edit the predicate of the current category
18664 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18665
18666 @item g
18667 @kindex g (Category)
18668 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18669 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18670 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18671
18672 @item s
18673 @kindex s (Category)
18674 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18675 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18676 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18677
18678 @item l
18679 @kindex l (Category)
18680 @findex gnus-category-list
18681 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18682 @end table
18683
18684
18685 @node Category Variables
18686 @subsubsection Category Variables
18687
18688 @table @code
18689 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18690 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18691 Hook run in category buffers.
18692
18693 @item gnus-category-line-format
18694 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18695 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18696 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18697
18698 @table @samp
18699 @item c
18700 The name of the category.
18701
18702 @item g
18703 The number of groups in the category.
18704 @end table
18705
18706 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18707 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18708 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18709
18710 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18711 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18712 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18713
18714 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18715 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18716 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18717
18718 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18719 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18720 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18721 0.
18722
18723 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18724 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18725 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18726 0.
18727
18728 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18729 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18730 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18731 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18732 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18733 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18734 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18735 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18736 read.
18737 Default 7.
18738
18739 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18740 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18741 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18742 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18743 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18744 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18745 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18746
18747 @end table
18748
18749
18750 @node Agent Commands
18751 @subsection Agent Commands
18752 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18753 @kindex J j (Agent)
18754
18755 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18756 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18757 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18758
18759
18760 @menu
18761 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18762 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18763 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18764 @end menu
18765
18766
18767
18768
18769 @node Group Agent Commands
18770 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18771
18772 @table @kbd
18773 @item J u
18774 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18775 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18776 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18777 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18778
18779 @item J c
18780 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18781 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18782 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18783
18784 @item J s
18785 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18786 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18787 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18788 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18789
18790 @item J S
18791 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18792 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18793 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18794 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18795
18796 @item J a
18797 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18798 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18799 Add the current group to an Agent category
18800 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18801 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18802
18803 @item J r
18804 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18805 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18806 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18807 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18808 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18809
18810 @item J Y
18811 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18812 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18813 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18814
18815
18816 @end table
18817
18818
18819 @node Summary Agent Commands
18820 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18821
18822 @table @kbd
18823 @item J #
18824 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18825 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18826 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18827
18828 @item J M-#
18829 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18830 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18831 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18832 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18833
18834 @cindex %
18835 @item @@
18836 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18837 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18838 Toggle whether to download the article
18839 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18840 default.
18841
18842 @item J c
18843 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18844 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18845 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18846
18847 @item J S
18848 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18849 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18850 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18851 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18852
18853 @item J s
18854 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18855 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
18856 Download all processable articles in this group.
18857 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
18858
18859 @item J u
18860 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18861 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18862 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18863 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18864
18865 @end table
18866
18867
18868 @node Server Agent Commands
18869 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18870
18871 @table @kbd
18872 @item J a
18873 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18874 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18875 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18876 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18877
18878 @item J r
18879 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18880 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18881 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18882 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18883
18884 @end table
18885
18886
18887 @node Agent Visuals
18888 @subsection Agent Visuals
18889
18890 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18891 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18892 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18893 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18894 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18895 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18896 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18897 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18898 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18899 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18900
18901 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18902 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18903 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18904 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18905 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18906 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18907 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18908 articles will be available when unplugged.
18909
18910 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18911 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18912 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18913 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18914 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18915 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18916 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18917 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18918
18919 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18920 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18921 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18922 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18923 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18924 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18925 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18926 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18927 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18928
18929 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18930 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18931 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18932 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18933 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
18934 users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
18935 database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
18936 to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
18937 of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
18938 normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
18939
18940 If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
18941 undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
18942 group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
18943 parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
18944 a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
18945 (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18946
18947 The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
18948 can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
18949 even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
18950 is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
18951 This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
18952 fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
18953 the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
18954 expiring'' articles.
18955
18956 @node Agent as Cache
18957 @subsection Agent as Cache
18958
18959 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18960 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18961 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18962 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18963 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18964 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18965 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18966 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18967 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18968
18969 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18970 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18971 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18972 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18973 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18974
18975 @node Agent Expiry
18976 @subsection Agent Expiry
18977
18978 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18979 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18980 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18981 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18982 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18983 @cindex agent expiry
18984 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18985 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
18986
18987 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18988 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18989 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18990 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18991 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18992 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18993 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18994 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18995
18996 Note that other functions might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you
18997 to keep the agent synchronized with the group.
18998
18999 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
19000 prevent expiration in selected groups.
19001
19002 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
19003 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
19004 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
19005 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
19006 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
19007 be kept indefinitely.
19008
19009 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
19010 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
19011 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
19012 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
19013
19014 @node Agent Regeneration
19015 @subsection Agent Regeneration
19016
19017 @cindex agent regeneration
19018 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
19019 @cindex regeneration
19020
19021 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
19022 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
19023 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
19024 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
19025 internal inconsistencies.
19026
19027 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
19028 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
19029 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
19030 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
19031 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
19032 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
19033
19034 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
19035 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
19036 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
19037 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
19038 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
19039 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
19040
19041 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19042 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19043 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19044 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19045 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19046 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19047 agent as unread.
19048
19049 @node Agent and flags
19050 @subsection Agent and flags
19051
19052 The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
19053 nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc.)@: on the server. Sadly,
19054 the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
19055 the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
19056 Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
19057 to the flags in its own files.
19058
19059 When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
19060 changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
19061 server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
19062
19063 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19064 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19065 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19066 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19067 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19068 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19069
19070 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19071 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19072 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19073 in the group buffer.
19074
19075 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19076 all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19077 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19078 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19079 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19080 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19081 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19082 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19083
19084 @node Agent and IMAP
19085 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19086
19087 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19088 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19089 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19090 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19091
19092 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19093 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19094
19095 @itemize @bullet
19096
19097 @item
19098 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19099
19100 @item
19101 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19102
19103 @end itemize
19104
19105 @node Outgoing Messages
19106 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19107
19108 By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19109 and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19110 You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19111
19112 You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19113 (see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19114 news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
19115
19116 You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19117 commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19118 group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19119 Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19120 mail at any time.
19121
19122 If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19123 about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19124 ask you to confirm your action (see
19125 @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
19126
19127 @node Agent Variables
19128 @subsection Agent Variables
19129
19130 @table @code
19131 @item gnus-agent
19132 @vindex gnus-agent
19133 Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19134 the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19135 automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19136 back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
19137
19138 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19139 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
19140
19141
19142 @item gnus-agent-directory
19143 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19144 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19145 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19146
19147 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19148 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19149 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19150 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19151 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19152 by default.
19153
19154 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19155 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19156 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19157
19158 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19159 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19160 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19161
19162 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19163 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19164 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19165
19166 @item gnus-agent-cache
19167 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19168 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19169 articles when plugged, e.g., essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19170 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19171
19172 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19173 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19174 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19175 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19176 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19177 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19178 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19179 online status.
19180
19181 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19182 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19183 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19184 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19185 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19186 read. The default is @code{t}.
19187
19188 @item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19189 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19190 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19191 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19192 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19193 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19194 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19195
19196 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19197 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19198 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19199 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19200 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19201 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19202 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19203 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19204 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19205 over and over again.
19206
19207 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19208 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19209 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19210 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19211 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19212 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19213 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19214 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19215 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19216 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19217 However, all articles parsed prior to losing the connection will be
19218 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19219 see any cycling.
19220
19221 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19222 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19223 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19224 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19225 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19226 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19227 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19228 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19229 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19230
19231 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19232 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19233 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19234 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19235 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19236 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19237
19238 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19239 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19240 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19241 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19242 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19243
19244 @item gnus-agent-queue-mail
19245 @vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
19246 When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
19247 queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
19248 will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
19249 mail. The default is @code{t}.
19250
19251 @item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19252 @vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19253 When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
19254 prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
19255 @kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
19256
19257 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19258 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19259 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19260 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19261 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19262 which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19263 to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19264 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19265 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19266 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19267 start Gnus. The default is @samp{nil}.
19268
19269 @end table
19270
19271
19272 @node Example Setup
19273 @subsection Example Setup
19274
19275 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19276 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19277 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19278
19279 @lisp
19280 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19281 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19282 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19283
19284 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19285 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19286 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19287
19288 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19289 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19290
19291 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19292 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19293 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19294 @end lisp
19295
19296 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19297 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19298 gnus}.
19299
19300 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19301 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19302 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19303 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19304 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19305 once.
19306
19307 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19308 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19309 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19310 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19311 back all the killed groups.)
19312
19313 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19314 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19315 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19316
19317
19318 @node Batching Agents
19319 @subsection Batching Agents
19320 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19321
19322 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19323 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19324 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19325
19326 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19327 following incantation:
19328
19329 @example
19330 #!/bin/sh
19331 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19332 @end example
19333
19334
19335 @node Agent Caveats
19336 @subsection Agent Caveats
19337
19338 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19339 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19340 may ask:
19341
19342 @table @dfn
19343 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19344
19345 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19346 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19347 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19348
19349 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19350 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19351
19352 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19353
19354 @end table
19355
19356 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19357 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19358 locally stored articles.
19359
19360
19361 @node Scoring
19362 @chapter Scoring
19363 @cindex scoring
19364
19365 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19366 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19367 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19368 attention!
19369
19370 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19371 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19372 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19373 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19374 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19375
19376 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19377 before generating the summary buffer.
19378
19379 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19380 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19381 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19382
19383 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19384 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19385 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19386 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19387
19388 @menu
19389 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19390 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19391 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19392 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19393 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19394 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19395 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19396 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19397 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19398 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19399 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19400 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19401 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19402 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19403 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19404 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19405 @end menu
19406
19407
19408 @node Summary Score Commands
19409 @section Summary Score Commands
19410 @cindex score commands
19411
19412 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19413 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19414 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19415 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19416 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19417
19418 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19419 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19420 some other score file (e.g., @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19421 score file the current one.
19422
19423 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19424
19425 @table @kbd
19426
19427 @item V s
19428 @kindex V s (Summary)
19429 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19430 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19431
19432 @item V S
19433 @kindex V S (Summary)
19434 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19435 Display the score of the current article
19436 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19437
19438 @item V t
19439 @kindex V t (Summary)
19440 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19441 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19442 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19443 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19444 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19445 score file and edit it.
19446
19447 @item V w
19448 @kindex V w (Summary)
19449 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19450 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19451
19452 @item V R
19453 @kindex V R (Summary)
19454 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19455 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19456 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19457 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19458 effect you're having.
19459
19460 @item V c
19461 @kindex V c (Summary)
19462 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19463 Make a different score file the current
19464 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19465
19466 @item V e
19467 @kindex V e (Summary)
19468 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19469 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19470 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19471 File Editing}).
19472
19473 @item V f
19474 @kindex V f (Summary)
19475 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19476 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19477 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19478
19479 @item V F
19480 @kindex V F (Summary)
19481 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19482 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19483 after editing score files.
19484
19485 @item V C
19486 @kindex V C (Summary)
19487 @findex gnus-score-customize
19488 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19489 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19490
19491 @end table
19492
19493 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19494
19495 @table @kbd
19496
19497 @item V m
19498 @kindex V m (Summary)
19499 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19500 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19501 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19502
19503 @item V x
19504 @kindex V x (Summary)
19505 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19506 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19507 expunge all articles below this score
19508 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19509 @end table
19510
19511 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19512 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19513 them.)
19514
19515 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19516 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19517
19518 @enumerate
19519 @item
19520 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19521 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19522 @item
19523 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19524 keys are available:
19525 @table @kbd
19526
19527 @item a
19528 Score on the author name.
19529
19530 @item s
19531 Score on the subject line.
19532
19533 @item x
19534 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19535
19536 @item r
19537 Score on the @code{References} line.
19538
19539 @item d
19540 Score on the date.
19541
19542 @item l
19543 Score on the number of lines.
19544
19545 @item i
19546 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19547
19548 @item e
19549 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19550 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19551
19552 @item f
19553 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19554 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19555 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19556
19557 @item b
19558 Score on the body.
19559
19560 @item h
19561 Score on the head.
19562
19563 @item t
19564 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19565 files.)
19566
19567 @end table
19568
19569 @item
19570 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19571 what headers you are scoring on.
19572
19573 @table @code
19574
19575 @item strings
19576
19577 @table @kbd
19578
19579 @item e
19580 Exact matching.
19581
19582 @item s
19583 Substring matching.
19584
19585 @item f
19586 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19587
19588 @item r
19589 Regexp matching
19590 @end table
19591
19592 @item date
19593 @table @kbd
19594
19595 @item b
19596 Before date.
19597
19598 @item a
19599 After date.
19600
19601 @item n
19602 This date.
19603 @end table
19604
19605 @item number
19606 @table @kbd
19607
19608 @item <
19609 Less than number.
19610
19611 @item =
19612 Equal to number.
19613
19614 @item >
19615 Greater than number.
19616 @end table
19617 @end table
19618
19619 @item
19620 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19621 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19622 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19623 file.
19624 @table @kbd
19625
19626 @item t
19627 Temporary score entry.
19628
19629 @item p
19630 Permanent score entry.
19631
19632 @item i
19633 Immediately scoring.
19634 @end table
19635
19636 @item
19637 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19638 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19639 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19640
19641 @end enumerate
19642
19643 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19644 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19645 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19646 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19647
19648 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19649 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19650 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19651 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19652 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19653
19654 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19655 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19656 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19657 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19658 current score file.
19659
19660 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19661 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19662 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19663
19664
19665 @node Group Score Commands
19666 @section Group Score Commands
19667 @cindex group score commands
19668
19669 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19670
19671 @table @kbd
19672
19673 @item W e
19674 @kindex W e (Group)
19675 @findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
19676 Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
19677 a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
19678
19679 @item W f
19680 @kindex W f (Group)
19681 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19682 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19683 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19684 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19685
19686 @end table
19687
19688 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19689
19690 @findex gnus-batch-score
19691 @cindex batch scoring
19692 @example
19693 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19694 @end example
19695
19696
19697 @node Score Variables
19698 @section Score Variables
19699 @cindex score variables
19700
19701 @table @code
19702
19703 @item gnus-use-scoring
19704 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19705 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19706 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19707
19708 @item gnus-kill-killed
19709 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19710 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19711 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19712 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19713 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19714 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19715 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19716
19717 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19718 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19719 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19720 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19721 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19722
19723 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19724 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19725 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19726 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19727
19728 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19729 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19730 @cindex score cache
19731 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19732 score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19733 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19734 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19735 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19736 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19737 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19738 be cached.
19739
19740 @item gnus-save-score
19741 @vindex gnus-save-score
19742 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19743 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19744 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19745
19746 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19747 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19748 across group visits.
19749
19750 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19751 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19752 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19753 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19754 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19755 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19756 manually entered data.
19757
19758 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19759 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19760 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19761
19762 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19763 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19764 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19765 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19766 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19767 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19768
19769 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19770 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19771 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19772 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19773
19774 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19775 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19776 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19777 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19778
19779 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19780 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19781 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19782 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19783
19784 Predefined functions available are:
19785 @table @code
19786
19787 @item gnus-score-find-single
19788 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19789 Only apply the group's own score file.
19790
19791 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19792 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19793 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19794 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19795 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19796 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19797 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19798 then a regexp match is done.
19799
19800 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19801 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19802
19803 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19804 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19805 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19806 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19807
19808 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19809 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19810 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19811 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19812 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19813 server.
19814
19815 @end table
19816 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19817 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19818 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19819 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19820 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19821 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19822 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19823 Phu.
19824
19825 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19826 overall score file, you could use the value
19827 @example
19828 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19829 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19830 @end example
19831
19832 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19833 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19834 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19835 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19836 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19837
19838 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19839 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19840 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19841 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19842 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19843 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19844 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19845 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19846
19847 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19848 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19849 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19850
19851 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19852 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19853 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19854 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19855 threading---according to the current value of
19856 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19857 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19858 simplified in this manner.
19859
19860 @end table
19861
19862
19863 @node Score File Format
19864 @section Score File Format
19865 @cindex score file format
19866
19867 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19868 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19869 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19870
19871 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19872
19873 @lisp
19874 (("from"
19875 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19876 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19877 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19878 ("subject"
19879 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19880 ("xref"
19881 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19882 ("lines"
19883 (2 -100 nil <))
19884 (mark 0)
19885 (expunge -1000)
19886 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19887 (read-only nil)
19888 (orphan -10)
19889 (adapt t)
19890 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19891 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19892 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19893 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19894 (eval (ding)))
19895 @end lisp
19896
19897 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19898 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19899
19900 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19901 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19902 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19903
19904 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19905
19906 @table @code
19907
19908 @item STRING
19909 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19910 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19911 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19912 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19913 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19914 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19915 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19916 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19917 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19918 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19919 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19920 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19921 to articles that matches these score entries.
19922
19923 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19924 score entry has one to four elements.
19925 @enumerate
19926
19927 @item
19928 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19929 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19930 integer.
19931
19932 @item
19933 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19934 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19935 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19936 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19937 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19938 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19939
19940 @item
19941 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19942 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19943 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19944 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19945 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19946
19947 @item
19948 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19949 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19950 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19951 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19952 @table @dfn
19953
19954 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19955 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19956 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19957 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19958 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19959 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19960 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19961 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19962 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19963 instead, if you feel like.
19964
19965 @item Extra
19966 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19967 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19968 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19969 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19970 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19971 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19972 overviews:
19973
19974 @lisp
19975 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19976 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19977 @end lisp
19978
19979 @item Lines, Chars
19980 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19981 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19982
19983 These predicates are true if
19984
19985 @example
19986 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19987 @end example
19988
19989 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19990 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19991 following form:
19992
19993 @lisp
19994 (< header-value 4)
19995 @end lisp
19996
19997 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19998 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19999 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
20000 it's not. I think.)
20001
20002 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
20003 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
20004 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
20005 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
20006
20007 @item Date
20008 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
20009 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
20010 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
20011 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
20012 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
20013 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
20014 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
20015
20016 @cindex ISO8601
20017 @cindex date
20018 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
20019 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
20020 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
20021 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
20022 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
20023 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
20024 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
20025 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
20026 whole family, eh?)
20027
20028 @item Head, Body, All
20029 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc.)@:
20030 header uses.
20031
20032 @item Followup
20033 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
20034 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
20035 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
20036 you to increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
20037 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
20038 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
20039 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
20040 files.)
20041
20042 @item Thread
20043 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20044 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20045 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20046 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20047 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20048 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20049 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20050 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20051 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
20052 nondeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
20053 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20054 @end table
20055 @end enumerate
20056
20057 @cindex score file atoms
20058 @item mark
20059 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20060 lower than this number will be marked as read.
20061
20062 @item expunge
20063 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20064 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
20065
20066 @item mark-and-expunge
20067 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20068 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20069 summary buffer.
20070
20071 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
20072 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20073 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20074 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20075 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20076
20077 @item files
20078 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20079 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20080 this one was.
20081
20082 @item exclude-files
20083 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20084 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20085 other.
20086
20087 @item eval
20088 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
20089 ignored when handling global score files.
20090
20091 @item read-only
20092 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20093 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20094 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20095 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20096
20097 @item orphan
20098 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20099 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20100 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20101 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20102
20103 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20104
20105 @example
20106 (orphan -500)
20107 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20108 @end example
20109
20110 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20111 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20112 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
20113 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20114 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20115
20116 I.e., the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20117 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20118 scoring rules exist.
20119
20120 @item adapt
20121 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20122 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20123 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20124 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20125 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20126 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20127 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20128 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20129 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20130 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20131 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20132 it.
20133
20134 @item adapt-file
20135 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20136 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20137 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20138 file for a number of groups.
20139
20140 @item local
20141 @cindex local variables
20142 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20143 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20144 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20145 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20146 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20147 be evaluated.
20148 @end table
20149
20150
20151 @node Score File Editing
20152 @section Score File Editing
20153
20154 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20155 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20156 with a mode for that.
20157
20158 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20159 additional commands:
20160
20161 @table @kbd
20162
20163 @item C-c C-c
20164 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20165 @findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20166 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20167 (@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
20168
20169 @item C-c C-d
20170 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20171 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20172 Insert the current date in numerical format
20173 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20174 you were wondering.
20175
20176 @item C-c C-p
20177 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20178 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20179 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20180 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20181 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20182 you.
20183
20184 @end table
20185
20186 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20187
20188 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20189 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20190
20191 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20192 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20193
20194
20195 @node Adaptive Scoring
20196 @section Adaptive Scoring
20197 @cindex adaptive scoring
20198
20199 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20200 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20201 stupidity, to be precise.
20202
20203 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20204 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20205 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20206 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20207 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20208 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20209 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20210 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20211 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20212
20213 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20214 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20215 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20216 might look something like this:
20217
20218 @lisp
20219 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20220 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20221 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20222 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20223 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20224 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20225 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20226 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20227 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20228 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20229 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20230 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20231 @end lisp
20232
20233 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20234 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20235 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20236 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20237 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20238 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20239 entries.
20240
20241 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20242 will be applied to each article.
20243
20244 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20245 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20246 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20247 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20248
20249 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20250 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20251 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20252 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20253
20254 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20255 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20256 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20257 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20258
20259 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20260 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20261 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20262 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20263 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20264 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20265
20266 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20267 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20268 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20269
20270 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20271 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20272 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20273
20274 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20275 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20276 let you use different rules in different groups.
20277
20278 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20279 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20280 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20281 is @file{ADAPT}.
20282
20283 @vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
20284 Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
20285 human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
20286 default) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
20287
20288 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20289 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20290 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20291 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20292 the length of the match is less than
20293 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20294 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20295 this problem.
20296
20297 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20298 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20299 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20300 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20301 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20302
20303 @lisp
20304 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20305 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20306 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20307 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20308 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20309 @end lisp
20310
20311 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20312 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20313 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20314 score with 30 points.
20315
20316 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20317 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20318 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20319 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20320 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20321
20322 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20323 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20324 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20325 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20326 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20327
20328 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20329 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20330 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20331 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20332
20333 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20334 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20335 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20336 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20337
20338 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20339 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20340 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20341 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20342 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20343
20344 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20345 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20346 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20347
20348 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20349 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20350 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20351 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20352
20353
20354 @node Home Score File
20355 @section Home Score File
20356
20357 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20358 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20359 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20360 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20361
20362 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20363 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20364 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20365
20366 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20367 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20368 be:
20369
20370 @enumerate
20371 @item
20372 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20373 groups.
20374
20375 @item
20376 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20377 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20378 parameter.
20379
20380 @item
20381 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20382
20383 @enumerate
20384 @item
20385 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20386 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20387
20388 @item
20389 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20390 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20391 name of the group as the parameter.
20392
20393 @item
20394 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20395 @end enumerate
20396
20397 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20398 for matches.
20399
20400 @end enumerate
20401
20402 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20403
20404 @lisp
20405 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20406 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20407 @end lisp
20408
20409 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20410 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20411
20412 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20413 @lisp
20414 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20415 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20416 @end lisp
20417
20418 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20419 Other functions include
20420
20421 @table @code
20422 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20423 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20424 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20425 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20426
20427 @end table
20428
20429 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20430 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20431 their own home score files:
20432
20433 @lisp
20434 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20435 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20436 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20437 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20438 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20439 @end lisp
20440
20441 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20442 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20443 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20444 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20445 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20446
20447 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20448 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20449 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20450 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20451 precedence over this variable.
20452
20453
20454 @node Followups To Yourself
20455 @section Followups To Yourself
20456
20457 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20458 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20459 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20460 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20461 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20462 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20463
20464 @table @code
20465
20466 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20467 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20468 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20469 article.
20470
20471 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20472 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20473 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20474 your own article.
20475 @end table
20476
20477 @vindex message-sent-hook
20478 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20479 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20480 @lisp
20481 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20482 @end lisp
20483
20484
20485 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20486 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20487 mine:
20488
20489 @example
20490 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20491 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20492 @end example
20493
20494 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20495 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20496 myself:
20497
20498 @lisp
20499 ("references"
20500 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20501 1000 nil r))
20502 @end lisp
20503
20504 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20505 is system-dependent.
20506
20507
20508 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20509 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20510 @cindex scoring on other headers
20511
20512 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20513 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20514 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20515 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20516 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20517
20518 @vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
20519 You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
20520 variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
20521 @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
20522 the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
20523 inhibited for all groups.
20524
20525 Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
20526 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20527 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20528 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20529 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20530
20531 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20532
20533 @lisp
20534 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20535 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20536 @end lisp
20537
20538 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20539 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20540 time if you have much mail.
20541
20542 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20543 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20544
20545 See? Simple.
20546
20547
20548 @node Scoring Tips
20549 @section Scoring Tips
20550 @cindex scoring tips
20551
20552 @table @dfn
20553
20554 @item Crossposts
20555 @cindex crossposts
20556 @cindex scoring crossposts
20557 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20558 the @code{Xref} header.
20559 @lisp
20560 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20561 @end lisp
20562
20563 @item Multiple crossposts
20564 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20565 more than, say, 3 groups:
20566 @lisp
20567 ("xref"
20568 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20569 -1000 nil r))
20570 @end lisp
20571
20572 @item Matching on the body
20573 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20574 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20575 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20576 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20577 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20578 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20579 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20580 the matches.
20581
20582 @item Marking as read
20583 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20584 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20585 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20586 @lisp
20587 ((mark -100))
20588 @end lisp
20589 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20590
20591 @item Negated character classes
20592 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20593 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20594 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20595 @end table
20596
20597
20598 @node Reverse Scoring
20599 @section Reverse Scoring
20600 @cindex reverse scoring
20601
20602 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20603 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20604 like this in your score file:
20605
20606 @lisp
20607 (("subject"
20608 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20609 (mark 1)
20610 (expunge 1))
20611 @end lisp
20612
20613 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20614 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20615
20616
20617 @node Global Score Files
20618 @section Global Score Files
20619 @cindex global score files
20620
20621 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20622 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20623 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20624
20625 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20626 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20627 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20628
20629 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20630 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20631 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20632 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20633 files are applicable to which group.
20634
20635 To use the score file
20636 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20637 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20638 say this:
20639
20640 @lisp
20641 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20642 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20643 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20644 @end lisp
20645
20646 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20647 @noindent
20648 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20649 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20650 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20651 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20652
20653 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20654 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20655
20656 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20657 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20658 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20659 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20660 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20661 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20662
20663 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20664 head:
20665
20666 @itemize @bullet
20667
20668 @item
20669 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20670 @item
20671 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20672 @item
20673 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20674 @item
20675 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20676 lowered out of existence.
20677 @item
20678 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20679 articles completely.
20680
20681 @item
20682 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20683 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20684 old articles for a long time.
20685 @end itemize
20686
20687 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20688 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20689 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20690 holding our breath yet?
20691
20692
20693 @node Kill Files
20694 @section Kill Files
20695 @cindex kill files
20696
20697 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20698 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20699 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20700
20701 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20702 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20703 files into score files.
20704
20705 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20706 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20707 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20708 that isn't a very good idea.
20709
20710 Normal kill files look like this:
20711
20712 @lisp
20713 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20714 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20715 (gnus-expunge "X")
20716 @end lisp
20717
20718 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20719 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20720
20721 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20722 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20723 interpreting it.
20724
20725 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20726
20727 @table @kbd
20728
20729 @item M-k
20730 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20731 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20732 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20733
20734 @item M-K
20735 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20736 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20737 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20738 @end table
20739
20740 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20741
20742 @table @kbd
20743
20744 @item M-k
20745 @kindex M-k (Group)
20746 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20747 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20748
20749 @item M-K
20750 @kindex M-K (Group)
20751 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20752 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20753 @end table
20754
20755 Kill file variables:
20756
20757 @table @code
20758 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20759 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20760 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20761 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20762 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20763 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20764 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20765
20766 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20767 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20768 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20769 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20770 kills.
20771
20772 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20773 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20774 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20775 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20776 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20777 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20778 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20779 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20780 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20781
20782 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20783 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20784 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20785
20786 @end table
20787
20788
20789 @node Converting Kill Files
20790 @section Converting Kill Files
20791 @cindex kill files
20792 @cindex converting kill files
20793
20794 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20795 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20796 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20797 by hand.
20798
20799 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
20800 You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
20801 from
20802 @uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20803
20804 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20805 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20806 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20807 before.
20808
20809
20810 @node Advanced Scoring
20811 @section Advanced Scoring
20812
20813 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20814 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20815 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20816 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20817 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20818
20819 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20820 scoring patterns.
20821
20822 @menu
20823 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20824 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20825 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20826 @end menu
20827
20828
20829 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20830 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20831
20832 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20833 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20834 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20835 non-@code{nil} value.
20836
20837 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20838 operator, and various match operators.
20839
20840 Logical operators:
20841
20842 @table @code
20843 @item &
20844 @itemx and
20845 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20846 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20847 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20848 @code{true}.
20849
20850 @item |
20851 @itemx or
20852 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20853 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20854 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20855
20856 @item !
20857 @itemx not
20858 @itemx ¬
20859 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20860 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20861
20862 @end table
20863
20864 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20865 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20866 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20867 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20868 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20869 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20870 the ancestry you want to go.
20871
20872 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20873 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20874 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20875 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20876 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20877
20878
20879 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20880 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20881
20882 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20883 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20884 of parentheses.
20885
20886 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20887 when he's talking about Gnus:
20888
20889 @example
20890 @group
20891 ((&
20892 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20893 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20894 1000)
20895 @end group
20896 @end example
20897
20898 Quite simple, huh?
20899
20900 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20901
20902 @example
20903 ((&
20904 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20905 (|
20906 ("subject" "Gnus")
20907 ("lines" 100 >)))
20908 1000)
20909 @end example
20910
20911 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20912 really don't want to read what he's written:
20913
20914 @example
20915 ((&
20916 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20917 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20918 -100000)
20919 @end example
20920
20921 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20922 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20923 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20924 very interesting:
20925
20926 @example
20927 ((&
20928 (1-
20929 (&
20930 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20931 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20932 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20933 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20934 1000)
20935 @end example
20936
20937 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20938 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20939 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20940 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20941
20942 @example
20943 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20944 -200)
20945 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20946 200)
20947 @end example
20948
20949 The possibilities are endless.
20950
20951 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20952 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20953
20954 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20955 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20956 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20957 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20958 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20959 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20960 @samp{subject}) first.
20961
20962 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20963 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20964 something like:
20965
20966 @example
20967 ...
20968 (1-
20969 (1-
20970 ("from" "lars")))
20971 ...
20972 @end example
20973
20974 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20975 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20976
20977 @example
20978 (1-
20979 (&
20980 ("from" "Lars")
20981 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20982 @end example
20983
20984 than it is to say:
20985
20986 @example
20987 (&
20988 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20989 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20990 @end example
20991
20992
20993 @node Score Decays
20994 @section Score Decays
20995 @cindex score decays
20996 @cindex decays
20997
20998 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20999 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
21000 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
21001 use them in any sensible way.
21002
21003 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
21004 @findex gnus-decay-score
21005 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
21006 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
21007 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
21008 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
21009 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
21010 If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
21011 regexp are treated. E.g., you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
21012 @emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
21013 performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
21014 @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
21015 function:
21016
21017 @lisp
21018 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
21019 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
21020 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
21021 (let ((n (- score
21022 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
21023 (min (abs score)
21024 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
21025 (* (abs score)
21026 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
21027 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
21028 ;; XEmacs's floor can handle only the floating point
21029 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
21030 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
21031 (string-to-number
21032 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
21033 (floor n))))
21034 @end lisp
21035
21036 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
21037 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
21038 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
21039 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
21040
21041 @enumerate
21042 @item
21043 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
21044
21045 @item
21046 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
21047
21048 @item
21049 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
21050 score.
21051 @end enumerate
21052
21053 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
21054 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
21055 the new score, which should be an integer.
21056
21057 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21058 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
21059
21060 @node Searching
21061 @chapter Searching
21062 @cindex searching
21063
21064 FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
21065 comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
21066 as well.
21067
21068 This chapter describes tools for searching groups and servers for
21069 articles matching a query and then retrieving those articles. Gnus
21070 provides a simpler mechanism for searching through articles in a summary buffer
21071 to find those matching a pattern. @xref{Searching for Articles}.
21072
21073 @menu
21074 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
21075 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
21076 @end menu
21077
21078 @node nnir
21079 @section nnir
21080 @cindex nnir
21081
21082 This section describes how to use @code{nnir} to search for articles
21083 within gnus.
21084
21085 @menu
21086 * What is nnir?:: What does @code{nnir} do?
21087 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
21088 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up @code{nnir}.
21089 @end menu
21090
21091 @node What is nnir?
21092 @subsection What is nnir?
21093
21094 @code{nnir} is a Gnus interface to a number of tools for searching
21095 through mail and news repositories. Different backends (like
21096 @code{nnimap} and @code{nntp}) work with different tools (called
21097 @dfn{engines} in @code{nnir} lingo), but all use the same basic search
21098 interface.
21099
21100 The @code{nnimap} and @code{gmane} search engines should work with no
21101 configuration. Other engines require a local index that needs to be
21102 created and maintained outside of Gnus.
21103
21104
21105 @node Basic Usage
21106 @subsection Basic Usage
21107
21108 In the group buffer typing @kbd{G G} will search the group on the
21109 current line by calling @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. This prompts
21110 for a query string, creates an ephemeral @code{nnir} group containing
21111 the articles that match this query, and takes you to a summary buffer
21112 showing these articles. Articles may then be read, moved and deleted
21113 using the usual commands.
21114
21115 The @code{nnir} group made in this way is an @code{ephemeral} group,
21116 and some changes are not permanent: aside from reading, moving, and
21117 deleting, you can't act on the original article. But there is an
21118 alternative: you can @emph{warp} (i.e., jump) to the original group
21119 for the article on the current line with @kbd{A W}, aka
21120 @code{gnus-warp-to-article}. Even better, the function
21121 @code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}, bound by default in summary buffers
21122 to @kbd{A T}, will first warp to the original group before it works
21123 its magic and includes all the articles in the thread. From here you
21124 can read, move and delete articles, but also copy them, alter article
21125 marks, whatever. Go nuts.
21126
21127 You say you want to search more than just the group on the current line?
21128 No problem: just process-mark the groups you want to search. You want
21129 even more? Calling for an nnir search with the cursor on a topic heading
21130 will search all the groups under that heading.
21131
21132 Still not enough? OK, in the server buffer
21133 @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group} (now bound to @kbd{G}) will search all
21134 groups from the server on the current line. Too much? Want to ignore
21135 certain groups when searching, like spam groups? Just customize
21136 @code{nnir-ignored-newsgroups}.
21137
21138 One more thing: individual search engines may have special search
21139 features. You can access these special features by giving a prefix-arg
21140 to @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. If you are searching multiple
21141 groups with different search engines you will be prompted for the
21142 special search features for each engine separately.
21143
21144
21145 @node Setting up nnir
21146 @subsection Setting up nnir
21147
21148 To set up nnir you may need to do some prep work. Firstly, you may need
21149 to configure the search engines you plan to use. Some of them, like
21150 @code{imap} and @code{gmane}, need no special configuration. Others,
21151 like @code{namazu} and @code{swish}, require configuration as described
21152 below. Secondly, you need to associate a search engine with a server or
21153 a backend.
21154
21155 If you just want to use the @code{imap} engine to search @code{nnimap}
21156 servers, and the @code{gmane} engine to search @code{gmane} then you
21157 don't have to do anything. But you might want to read the details of the
21158 query language anyway.
21159
21160 @menu
21161 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
21162 * The imap Engine:: Imap configuration and usage.
21163 * The gmane Engine:: Gmane configuration and usage.
21164 * The swish++ Engine:: Swish++ configuration and usage.
21165 * The swish-e Engine:: Swish-e configuration and usage.
21166 * The namazu Engine:: Namazu configuration and usage.
21167 * The notmuch Engine:: Notmuch configuration and usage.
21168 * The hyrex Engine:: Hyrex configuration and usage.
21169 * Customizations:: User customizable settings.
21170 @end menu
21171
21172 @node Associating Engines
21173 @subsubsection Associating Engines
21174
21175
21176 When searching a group, @code{nnir} needs to know which search engine to
21177 use. You can configure a given server to use a particular engine by
21178 setting the server variable @code{nnir-search-engine} to the engine
21179 name. For example to use the @code{namazu} engine to search the server
21180 named @code{home} you can use
21181
21182 @lisp
21183 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
21184 '((nnml "home"
21185 (nnimap-address "localhost")
21186 (nnir-search-engine namazu))))
21187 @end lisp
21188
21189 Alternatively you might want to use a particular engine for all servers
21190 with a given backend. For example, you might want to use the @code{imap}
21191 engine for all servers using the @code{nnimap} backend. In this case you
21192 can customize the variable @code{nnir-method-default-engines}. This is
21193 an alist of pairs of the form @code{(backend . engine)}. By default this
21194 variable is set to use the @code{imap} engine for all servers using the
21195 @code{nnimap} backend, and the @code{gmane} backend for @code{nntp}
21196 servers. (Don't worry, the @code{gmane} search engine won't actually try
21197 to search non-gmane @code{nntp} servers.) But if you wanted to use
21198 @code{namazu} for all your servers with an @code{nnimap} backend you
21199 could change this to
21200
21201 @lisp
21202 '((nnimap . namazu)
21203 (nntp . gmane))
21204 @end lisp
21205
21206 @node The imap Engine
21207 @subsubsection The imap Engine
21208
21209 The @code{imap} engine requires no configuration.
21210
21211 Queries using the @code{imap} engine follow a simple query language.
21212 The search is always case-insensitive and supports the following
21213 features (inspired by the Google search input language):
21214
21215 @table @samp
21216
21217 @item Boolean query operators
21218 AND, OR, and NOT are supported, and parentheses can be used to control
21219 operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux. Note that
21220 operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21221 recognized. Also preceding a term with a @minus{} sign is equivalent to NOT
21222 term.
21223
21224 @item Automatic AND queries
21225 If you specify multiple words then they will be treated as an AND
21226 expression intended to match all components.
21227
21228 @item Phrase searches
21229 If you wrap your query in double-quotes then it will be treated as a
21230 literal string.
21231
21232 @end table
21233
21234 By default the whole message will be searched. The query can be limited
21235 to a specific part of a message by using a prefix-arg. After inputting
21236 the query this will prompt (with completion) for a message part.
21237 Choices include ``Whole message'', ``Subject'', ``From'', and
21238 ``To''. Any unrecognized input is interpreted as a header name. For
21239 example, typing @kbd{Message-ID} in response to this prompt will limit
21240 the query to the Message-ID header.
21241
21242 Finally selecting ``Imap'' will interpret the query as a raw
21243 @acronym{IMAP} search query. The format of such queries can be found in
21244 RFC3501.
21245
21246 If you don't like the default of searching whole messages you can
21247 customize @code{nnir-imap-default-search-key}. For example to use
21248 @acronym{IMAP} queries by default
21249
21250 @lisp
21251 (setq nnir-imap-default-search-key "Imap")
21252 @end lisp
21253
21254 @node The gmane Engine
21255 @subsubsection The gmane Engine
21256
21257 The @code{gmane} engine requires no configuration.
21258
21259 Gmane queries follow a simple query language:
21260
21261 @table @samp
21262 @item Boolean query operators
21263 AND, OR, NOT (or AND NOT), and XOR are supported, and brackets can be
21264 used to control operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux.
21265 Note that operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21266 recognized.
21267
21268 @item Required and excluded terms
21269 + and @minus{} can be used to require or exclude terms, e.g., football
21270 @minus{}american
21271
21272 @item Unicode handling
21273 The search engine converts all text to utf-8, so searching should work
21274 in any language.
21275
21276 @item Stopwords
21277 Common English words (like 'the' and 'a') are ignored by default. You
21278 can override this by prefixing such words with a + (e.g., +the) or
21279 enclosing the word in quotes (e.g., "the").
21280
21281 @end table
21282
21283 The query can be limited to articles by a specific author using a
21284 prefix-arg. After inputting the query this will prompt for an author
21285 name (or part of a name) to match.
21286
21287 @node The swish++ Engine
21288 @subsubsection The swish++ Engine
21289
21290 FIXME: Say something more here.
21291
21292 Documentation for swish++ may be found at the swish++ sourceforge page:
21293 @uref{http://swishplusplus.sourceforge.net}
21294
21295 @table @code
21296
21297 @item nnir-swish++-program
21298 The name of the swish++ executable. Defaults to @code{search}
21299
21300 @item nnir-swish++-additional-switches
21301 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21302 swish++. @code{nil} by default.
21303
21304 @item nnir-swish++-remove-prefix
21305 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish++ in order
21306 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21307
21308 @end table
21309
21310 @node The swish-e Engine
21311 @subsubsection The swish-e Engine
21312
21313 FIXME: Say something more here.
21314
21315 Documentation for swish-e may be found at the swish-e homepage
21316 @uref{http://swish-e.org}
21317
21318 @table @code
21319
21320 @item nnir-swish-e-program
21321 The name of the swish-e search program. Defaults to @code{swish-e}.
21322
21323 @item nnir-swish-e-additional-switches
21324 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21325 swish-e. @code{nil} by default.
21326
21327 @item nnir-swish-e-remove-prefix
21328 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish-e in order
21329 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21330
21331 @end table
21332
21333 @node The namazu Engine
21334 @subsubsection The namazu Engine
21335
21336 Using the namazu engine requires creating and maintaining index files.
21337 One directory should contain all the index files, and nnir must be told
21338 where to find them by setting the @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory}
21339 variable.
21340
21341 To work correctly the @code{nnir-namazu-remove-prefix} variable must
21342 also be correct. This is the prefix to remove from each file name
21343 returned by Namazu in order to get a proper group name (albeit with `/'
21344 instead of `.').
21345
21346 For example, suppose that Namazu returns file names such as
21347 @samp{/home/john/Mail/mail/misc/42}. For this example, use the
21348 following setting: @code{(setq nnir-namazu-remove-prefix
21349 "/home/john/Mail/")} Note the trailing slash. Removing this prefix from
21350 the directory gives @samp{mail/misc/42}. @code{nnir} knows to remove
21351 the @samp{/42} and to replace @samp{/} with @samp{.} to arrive at the
21352 correct group name @samp{mail.misc}.
21353
21354 Extra switches may be passed to the namazu search command by setting the
21355 variable @code{nnir-namazu-additional-switches}. It is particularly
21356 important not to pass any any switches to namazu that will change the
21357 output format. Good switches to use include `--sort', `--ascending',
21358 `--early' and `--late'. Refer to the Namazu documentation for further
21359 information on valid switches.
21360
21361 Mail must first be indexed with the `mknmz' program. Read the documentation
21362 for namazu to create a configuration file. Here is an example:
21363
21364 @cartouche
21365 @example
21366 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
21367
21368 # Paths which will not be indexed. Don't use `^' or `$' anchors.
21369 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "spam|sent";
21370
21371 # Header fields which should be searchable. case-insensitive
21372 $REMAIN_HEADER = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21373
21374 # Searchable fields. case-insensitive
21375 $SEARCH_FIELD = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21376
21377 # The max length of a word.
21378 $WORD_LENG_MAX = 128;
21379
21380 # The max length of a field.
21381 $MAX_FIELD_LENGTH = 256;
21382 @end example
21383 @end cartouche
21384
21385 For this example, mail is stored in the directories @samp{~/Mail/mail/},
21386 @samp{~/Mail/lists/} and @samp{~/Mail/archive/}, so to index them go to
21387 the index directory set in @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory} and issue
21388 the following command:
21389
21390 @example
21391 mknmz --mailnews ~/Mail/archive/ ~/Mail/mail/ ~/Mail/lists/
21392 @end example
21393
21394 For maximum searching efficiency you might want to have a cron job run
21395 this command periodically, say every four hours.
21396
21397
21398 @node The notmuch Engine
21399 @subsubsection The notmuch Engine
21400
21401 @table @code
21402 @item nnir-notmuch-program
21403 The name of the notmuch search executable. Defaults to
21404 @samp{notmuch}.
21405
21406 @item nnir-notmuch-additional-switches
21407 A list of strings, to be given as additional arguments to notmuch.
21408
21409 @item nnir-notmuch-remove-prefix
21410 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by notmuch in order
21411 to get a group name (albeit with @samp{/} instead of @samp{.}). This
21412 is a regular expression.
21413
21414 @end table
21415
21416
21417 @node The hyrex Engine
21418 @subsubsection The hyrex Engine
21419 This engine is obsolete.
21420
21421 @node Customizations
21422 @subsubsection Customizations
21423
21424 @table @code
21425
21426 @item nnir-method-default-engines
21427 Alist of pairs of server backends and search engines. The default associations
21428 are
21429 @example
21430 (nnimap . imap)
21431 (nntp . gmane)
21432 @end example
21433
21434 @item nnir-ignored-newsgroups
21435 A regexp to match newsgroups in the active file that should be skipped
21436 when searching all groups on a server.
21437
21438 @item nnir-summary-line-format
21439 The format specification to be used for lines in an nnir summary buffer.
21440 All the items from `gnus-summary-line-format' are available, along with
21441 three items unique to nnir summary buffers:
21442
21443 @example
21444 %Z Search retrieval score value (integer)
21445 %G Article original full group name (string)
21446 %g Article original short group name (string)
21447 @end example
21448
21449 If nil (the default) this will use @code{gnus-summary-line-format}.
21450
21451 @item nnir-retrieve-headers-override-function
21452 If non-nil, a function that retrieves article headers rather than using
21453 the gnus built-in function. This function takes an article list and
21454 group as arguments and populates the `nntp-server-buffer' with the
21455 retrieved headers. It should then return either 'nov or 'headers
21456 indicating the retrieved header format. Failure to retrieve headers
21457 should return @code{nil}
21458
21459 If this variable is nil, or if the provided function returns nil for a
21460 search result, @code{gnus-retrieve-headers} will be called instead."
21461
21462
21463 @end table
21464
21465
21466 @node nnmairix
21467 @section nnmairix
21468
21469 @cindex mairix
21470 @cindex nnmairix
21471 This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
21472 @code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
21473 Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
21474 bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
21475
21476 @menu
21477 * About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
21478 * nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
21479 * What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
21480 * Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
21481 * Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
21482 * nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
21483 * Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
21484 * nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
21485 * nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
21486 @end menu
21487
21488 @c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
21489 @c E.g., adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
21490 @c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
21491
21492 @node About mairix
21493 @subsection About mairix
21494
21495 Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
21496 mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
21497 GPL@. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
21498 runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
21499 be found at
21500 @uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
21501
21502 Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
21503 swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
21504 has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
21505 can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
21506 thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
21507 necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
21508 done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
21509 therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
21510 up.
21511
21512 For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
21513 @code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
21514 end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
21515 results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
21516 which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
21517 made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
21518 mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
21519 for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
21520 searches.
21521
21522 @node nnmairix requirements
21523 @subsection nnmairix requirements
21524
21525 Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
21526 direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
21527 server (e.g., an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
21528 access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g., via ssh.
21529
21530 Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
21531 ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
21532 one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
21533 @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
21534
21535 If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
21536 you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
21537 @code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
21538 files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
21539 really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
21540 the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
21541
21542 @node What nnmairix does
21543 @subsection What nnmairix does
21544
21545 The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
21546 either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
21547 database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
21548 several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g., to quickly
21549 search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
21550 display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
21551 mails are in different folders.
21552
21553 Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
21554 to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
21555 containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
21556 even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID@. If you check for
21557 new mail in these folders (e.g., by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
21558 automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
21559
21560 You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
21561 creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
21562 then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
21563 does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
21564 strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
21565 claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
21566 the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
21567 its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g., if you
21568 use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
21569 about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
21570 group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
21571
21572 @code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
21573 a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
21574 the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
21575 different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
21576 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
21577 binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
21578 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
21579 present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
21580 You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
21581 but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
21582 groups alongside your other mail, you can also create, e.g., a new
21583 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
21584 make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
21585 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
21586 mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
21587 folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
21588
21589 @node Setting up mairix
21590 @subsection Setting up mairix
21591
21592 First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
21593
21594 Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
21595 (at least) the following entries:
21596
21597 @example
21598 # Your Maildir/MH base folder
21599 base=~/Maildir
21600 @end example
21601
21602 This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
21603 are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
21604 with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
21605 directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
21606
21607 @example
21608 maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
21609 mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
21610 mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
21611 @end example
21612
21613 This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
21614 base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
21615 @code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
21616 directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
21617 section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
21618
21619 @example
21620 omit=zz_mairix-*
21621 @end example
21622
21623 @vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
21624 This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
21625 search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
21626 variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
21627
21628 @example
21629 mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
21630 database= ... location of database file ...
21631 @end example
21632
21633 The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
21634 search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
21635 with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
21636
21637 To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
21638
21639 @example
21640 base=~/Maildir
21641 maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
21642 mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
21643 mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
21644 mformat=maildir
21645 omit=zz_mairix-*
21646 database=~/.mairixdatabase
21647 @end example
21648
21649 In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
21650 folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
21651 colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
21652 because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
21653 @code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
21654 @code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
21655 to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
21656 notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
21657 to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
21658 dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
21659 old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
21660 The other lines should be obvious.
21661
21662 See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
21663 especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
21664 than you are used to.
21665
21666 Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
21667 Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
21668 the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
21669
21670 @node Configuring nnmairix
21671 @subsection Configuring nnmairix
21672
21673 In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
21674 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
21675 necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
21676 server. You will have to specify the following:
21677
21678 @itemize @bullet
21679
21680 @item
21681 The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
21682 want.
21683
21684 @item
21685 The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
21686 searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
21687 Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
21688 which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
21689 @code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
21690 mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
21691 However, you can also create, e.g., a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
21692 server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
21693 (@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
21694 just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
21695 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might lose mail
21696 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
21697 @acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
21698 @code{nnimap} server here.
21699
21700 @item
21701 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
21702 The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
21703 be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
21704 SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g., on your
21705 @acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
21706 mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
21707 @code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
21708
21709 @item
21710 The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
21711 where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e., all searches which
21712 are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
21713 like.
21714
21715 @item
21716 If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
21717 asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e., with hidden maildir
21718 folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
21719 @samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
21720 server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
21721
21722 @end itemize
21723
21724 @node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21725 @subsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21726
21727 In group mode:
21728
21729 @table @kbd
21730
21731 @item G b c
21732 @kindex G b c (Group)
21733 @findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
21734 Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
21735 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
21736 this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
21737
21738 @item G b s
21739 @kindex G b s (Group)
21740 @findex nnmairix-search
21741 Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
21742 results are put into the default search group which is automatically
21743 displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
21744
21745 @item G b m
21746 @kindex G b m (Group)
21747 @findex nnmairix-widget-search
21748 Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
21749 comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
21750 group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
21751
21752 @item G b i
21753 @kindex G b i (Group)
21754 @findex nnmairix-search-interactive
21755 Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
21756 only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
21757
21758 @item G b g
21759 @kindex G b g (Group)
21760 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group
21761 Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
21762 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
21763 automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
21764 @kbd{M-g}.
21765
21766 @item G b q
21767 @kindex G b q (Group)
21768 @findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
21769 Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
21770 (@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
21771
21772 @item G b t
21773 @kindex G b t (Group)
21774 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
21775 Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
21776 i.e., if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
21777 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
21778
21779 @item G b u
21780 @kindex G b u (Group)
21781 @findex nnmairix-update-database
21782 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
21783 Calls mairix binary for updating the database
21784 (@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
21785 and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
21786 @code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
21787 options).
21788
21789 @item G b r
21790 @kindex G b r (Group)
21791 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
21792 Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
21793 marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
21794
21795 @item G b d
21796 @kindex G b d (Group)
21797 @findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
21798 Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
21799 (@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
21800 you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
21801
21802 @item G b a
21803 @kindex G b a (Group)
21804 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
21805 Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
21806 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
21807 behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
21808 update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
21809 mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
21810 upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
21811 lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
21812 entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
21813
21814 @item G b p
21815 @kindex G b p (Group)
21816 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
21817 Toggle marks propagation for this group
21818 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
21819 marks}).
21820
21821 @item G b o
21822 @kindex G b o (Group)
21823 @findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
21824 Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
21825 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
21826
21827 @end table
21828
21829 In summary mode:
21830
21831 @table @kbd
21832
21833 @item $ m
21834 @kindex $ m (Summary)
21835 @findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
21836 Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
21837 message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
21838 (@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
21839
21840 @item $ g
21841 @kindex $ g (Summary)
21842 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
21843 Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
21844 message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
21845 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
21846
21847 @item $ t
21848 @kindex $ t (Summary)
21849 @findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
21850 Searches thread for the current article
21851 (@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
21852 shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
21853 current article and enabled threads.
21854
21855 @item $ f
21856 @kindex $ f (Summary)
21857 @findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
21858 Searches all messages from sender of the current article
21859 (@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
21860 calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
21861
21862 @item $ o
21863 @kindex $ o (Summary)
21864 @findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
21865 (Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
21866 originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that,
21867 e.g., replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
21868 parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
21869 function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
21870 article file name as a fallback method.
21871
21872 @item $ u
21873 @kindex $ u (Summary)
21874 @findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
21875 Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
21876 (@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
21877 tips and tricks}).
21878
21879 @end table
21880
21881 @node Propagating marks
21882 @subsection Propagating marks
21883
21884 First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
21885 propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
21886 the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
21887
21888 @uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
21889
21890 You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
21891 is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
21892 marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
21893 fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
21894 be useful to you.
21895
21896 With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
21897 alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
21898 example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
21899 into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
21900 @samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
21901 all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
21902 create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
21903 can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
21904 implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
21905 groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
21906
21907 There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
21908 @samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
21909 ``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
21910 search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
21911 enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
21912 marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
21913 mail group it will be still shown as unread.
21914
21915 You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
21916 tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
21917 created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
21918 @code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
21919 shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
21920 even more cumbersome.
21921
21922 Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
21923 automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
21924 @emph{marks propagation} is about.
21925
21926 Marks propagation is inactive by default. You can activate it for a
21927 certain @code{nnmairix} group with
21928 @code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
21929 p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
21930 search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
21931 temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
21932 this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
21933
21934 With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
21935 group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
21936 you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
21937 magically be set for the original article, too.
21938
21939 A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
21940
21941 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
21942 Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
21943 not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
21944 dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
21945 will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
21946 via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
21947 details).
21948
21949 Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
21950 article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
21951 the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
21952 fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
21953 marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
21954 set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
21955 the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
21956
21957 @vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
21958 If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
21959 original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
21960 search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
21961 way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
21962 marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
21963 setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
21964
21965 Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e., if you
21966 tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
21967 article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
21968 reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
21969 immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
21970 @code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
21971 not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
21972 groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
21973 maildir as its file format.
21974
21975 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
21976 If you work with this setup, just set
21977 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
21978 happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
21979 problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
21980 usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
21981 groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
21982 back end using @kbd{G b d}.
21983
21984 @node nnmairix tips and tricks
21985 @subsection nnmairix tips and tricks
21986
21987 @itemize
21988 @item
21989 Checking Mail
21990
21991 @findex nnmairix-update-groups
21992 I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
21993 have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
21994 Levels}).
21995
21996 I use the following to check for mails:
21997
21998 @lisp
21999 (defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
22000 (interactive "P")
22001 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
22002 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
22003 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
22004 (gnus-group-list-groups))
22005
22006 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
22007 @end lisp
22008
22009 Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
22010 server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
22011 details.
22012
22013 @item
22014 Example: search group for ticked articles
22015
22016 For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
22017 articles always stay unread:
22018
22019 Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g., @samp{important}), use
22020 @samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
22021
22022 Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
22023 activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
22024
22025 So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
22026 group? There are two options: You may simply use
22027 @code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
22028 tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
22029 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
22030 comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
22031 also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
22032 e.g., by marking an article as read.
22033
22034 When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
22035 article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
22036 mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
22037 for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
22038 snippet and the doc string for details.
22039
22040 @item
22041 Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
22042
22043 As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
22044 the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
22045 see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
22046 should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
22047 usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
22048 @code{nnml}, i.e., you will suddenly see groups of the form
22049 @samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
22050 simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
22051 auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
22052 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
22053 Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
22054 for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
22055
22056 @lisp
22057 (setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
22058 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
22059 @end lisp
22060
22061 @end itemize
22062
22063 @node nnmairix caveats
22064 @subsection nnmairix caveats
22065
22066 @itemize
22067 @item
22068 You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
22069 you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
22070 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
22071 put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
22072 an example server definition:
22073
22074 @lisp
22075 (nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
22076 @end lisp
22077
22078 (The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variable
22079 @code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
22080 have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
22081 mairix.)
22082
22083 @item
22084 If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
22085 @code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
22086 @code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}; this is the default). Be
22087 @emph{extra careful} if you use
22088 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are split
22089 into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as you
22090 check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
22091
22092 @item
22093 Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
22094 groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
22095
22096 @item
22097 If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
22098 @code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
22099
22100 @item
22101 mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
22102
22103 @item
22104 @code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
22105 completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
22106 called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
22107 back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
22108 don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
22109 own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
22110 folders.
22111
22112 @item
22113 All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
22114 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
22115 is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
22116 it is gone for good.
22117
22118 @item
22119 @findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
22120 If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
22121 ``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
22122 delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
22123 @code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
22124 save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
22125 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
22126 @code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
22127 @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
22128
22129 @item
22130 The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
22131 for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
22132
22133 A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
22134 comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
22135 @samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
22136 file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
22137 update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
22138 mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
22139 while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
22140 @samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
22141 after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
22142 non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
22143 ``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
22144 to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
22145
22146 @end itemize
22147
22148 @iftex
22149 @iflatex
22150 @chapter Message
22151 @include message.texi
22152 @chapter Emacs MIME
22153 @include emacs-mime.texi
22154 @chapter Sieve
22155 @include sieve.texi
22156 @chapter EasyPG
22157 @include epa.texi
22158 @chapter SASL
22159 @include sasl.texi
22160 @end iflatex
22161 @end iftex
22162
22163 @node Various
22164 @chapter Various
22165
22166 @menu
22167 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22168 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22169 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22170 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22171 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22172 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
22173 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22174 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
22175 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
22176 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22177 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22178 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22179 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22180 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22181 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22182 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22183 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
22184 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
22185 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22186 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22187 @end menu
22188
22189
22190 @node Process/Prefix
22191 @section Process/Prefix
22192 @cindex process/prefix convention
22193
22194 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22195 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22196
22197 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22198 command to be performed on.
22199
22200 It goes like this:
22201
22202 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22203 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22204 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22205 with the current one.
22206
22207 @vindex transient-mark-mode
22208 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22209 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22210
22211 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22212 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22213 the process mark.
22214
22215 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22216 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22217
22218 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22219 are avoided.
22220
22221 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22222 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22223 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22224 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22225
22226 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22227 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22228 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22229 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22230 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22231 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22232 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22233 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22234
22235 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22236 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22237 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22238 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22239 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22240
22241
22242 @node Interactive
22243 @section Interactive
22244 @cindex interaction
22245
22246 @table @code
22247
22248 @item gnus-novice-user
22249 @vindex gnus-novice-user
22250 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22251 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22252 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22253 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22254 default.
22255
22256 @item gnus-expert-user
22257 @vindex gnus-expert-user
22258 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
22259 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing,
22260 no matter how strange. For example, quitting Gnus, exiting a group
22261 without an update, catching up with a group, deleting expired
22262 articles, and replying by mail to a news message will not require
22263 confirmation.
22264
22265 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
22266 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22267 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22268 is @code{t} by default.
22269
22270 @item gnus-interactive-exit
22271 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
22272 If non-@code{nil}, require a confirmation when exiting Gnus. If
22273 @code{quiet}, update any active summary buffers automatically without
22274 querying. The default value is @code{t}.
22275 @end table
22276
22277
22278 @node Symbolic Prefixes
22279 @section Symbolic Prefixes
22280 @cindex symbolic prefixes
22281
22282 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22283 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22284 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22285 rule of 900 to the current article.
22286
22287 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22288 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22289 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22290 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22291 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22292 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22293 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22294
22295 @kindex M-i (Summary)
22296 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22297 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22298 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22299 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22300 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22301 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22302 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22303 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
22304
22305 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22306 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22307 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22308
22309 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22310 Interactive}.
22311
22312
22313 @node Formatting Variables
22314 @section Formatting Variables
22315 @cindex formatting variables
22316
22317 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22318 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22319 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22320 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22321 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22322 be annoyed by.
22323
22324 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22325 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22326 lots of percentages everywhere.
22327
22328 @menu
22329 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22330 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22331 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22332 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22333 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22334 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22335 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22336 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22337 @end menu
22338
22339 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22340 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22341 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22342 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22343 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22344 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22345 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22346 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22347
22348 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22349 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22350
22351 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22352 @findex gnus-update-format
22353 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22354 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22355 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22356 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22357
22358
22359
22360 @node Formatting Basics
22361 @subsection Formatting Basics
22362
22363 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22364 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22365 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22366
22367 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22368 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22369 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22370 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22371 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22372 the right instead.
22373
22374 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22375 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22376 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22377 less than 4 characters wide.
22378
22379 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22380 @samp{%&user-date;}.
22381
22382
22383 @node Mode Line Formatting
22384 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
22385
22386 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22387 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22388 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22389 with the following two differences:
22390
22391 @enumerate
22392
22393 @item
22394 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22395
22396 @item
22397 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22398 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22399 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22400 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22401 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22402 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22403 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
22404
22405 @end enumerate
22406
22407
22408 @node Advanced Formatting
22409 @subsection Advanced Formatting
22410
22411 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22412 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22413 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22414 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22415
22416 These are the valid modifiers:
22417
22418 @table @code
22419 @item pad
22420 @itemx pad-left
22421 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22422 length.
22423
22424 @item pad-right
22425 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22426 length.
22427
22428 @item max
22429 @itemx max-left
22430 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22431
22432 @item max-right
22433 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22434 length.
22435
22436 @item cut
22437 @itemx cut-left
22438 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22439
22440 @item cut-right
22441 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22442
22443 @item ignore
22444 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22445
22446 @item form
22447 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22448 used.
22449
22450 Here's an example:
22451
22452 @lisp
22453 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22454 @end lisp
22455
22456 @end table
22457
22458 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22459 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22460 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22461 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22462 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22463 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22464 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22465
22466 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22467 last operation, padding.
22468
22469
22470 @node User-Defined Specs
22471 @subsection User-Defined Specs
22472
22473 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22474 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22475 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22476 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22477 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22478 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22479 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22480 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22481 should protect against that.
22482
22483 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22484 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22485
22486 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22487 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22488 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22489 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22490 inserted.
22491
22492
22493 @node Formatting Fonts
22494 @subsection Formatting Fonts
22495
22496 @cindex %(, %)
22497 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22498 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22499 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22500 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22501 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22502 over it.
22503
22504 @cindex %@{, %@}
22505 @vindex gnus-face-0
22506 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22507 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
22508 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
22509 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
22510 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
22511 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
22512
22513 @cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
22514 @c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
22515 @vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
22516 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
22517 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
22518 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
22519 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
22520 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
22521 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
22522 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
22523 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
22524 (in Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
22525 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
22526 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
22527 paragraph.)
22528
22529 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
22530
22531 @lisp
22532 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
22533 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
22534 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
22535
22536 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
22537 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
22538 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
22539 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
22540 ;; @r{Set the color.}
22541 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
22542 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
22543
22544 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
22545 (setq gnus-group-line-format
22546 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
22547 @end lisp
22548
22549 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
22550 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
22551
22552 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
22553 mode-line variables.
22554
22555 @node Positioning Point
22556 @subsection Positioning Point
22557
22558 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
22559 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
22560 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
22561
22562 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
22563
22564 @findex gnus-goto-colon
22565 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
22566 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
22567
22568 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
22569 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
22570 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
22571 place point there.
22572
22573
22574 @node Tabulation
22575 @subsection Tabulation
22576
22577 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
22578 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
22579 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
22580 about lining up the following text afterwards.
22581
22582 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
22583 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
22584
22585 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22586 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
22587 This is the soft tabulator.
22588
22589 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22590 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
22591 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
22592
22593
22594 @node Wide Characters
22595 @subsection Wide Characters
22596
22597 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
22598 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
22599 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
22600
22601 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
22602 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
22603 these countries, that's not true.
22604
22605 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
22606 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
22607 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
22608 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
22609 for Emacs.
22610
22611
22612 @node Window Layout
22613 @section Window Layout
22614 @cindex window layout
22615
22616 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
22617
22618 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
22619 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
22620 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
22621 @code{t} by default.
22622
22623 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
22624 glitches. Use at your own peril.
22625
22626 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
22627 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
22628 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
22629
22630 @lisp
22631 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)))
22632 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22633 (article 1.0))))
22634 @end lisp
22635
22636 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
22637 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
22638 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
22639 possible names is listed below.
22640
22641 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
22642 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example:
22643
22644 @lisp
22645 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22646 (article 1.0)))
22647 @end lisp
22648
22649 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
22650 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
22651 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
22652 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
22653 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
22654 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
22655 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
22656 size spec per split.
22657
22658 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
22659 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
22660 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e., is the third or
22661 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
22662 present) gets focus.
22663
22664 Here's a more complicated example:
22665
22666 @lisp
22667 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
22668 (summary 0.25 point)
22669 (article 1.0)))
22670 @end lisp
22671
22672 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
22673 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
22674 occupy, not a percentage.
22675
22676 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
22677 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
22678 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
22679 be used as a split.
22680
22681 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
22682
22683 @lisp
22684 (article (horizontal 1.0
22685 (vertical 0.5
22686 (group 1.0))
22687 (vertical 1.0
22688 (summary 0.25 point)
22689 (article 1.0))))
22690 @end lisp
22691
22692 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
22693 @code{horizontal} thingie?
22694
22695 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
22696 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
22697 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
22698 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
22699 the screen is to be given to this strip.
22700
22701 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
22702 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
22703 lines from the splits.
22704
22705 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
22706 may look like:
22707
22708 @example
22709 @group
22710 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22711 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22712 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22713 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22714 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22715 size = number | frame-params
22716 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22717 @end group
22718 @end example
22719
22720 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22721 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22722 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22723 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22724
22725 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
22726 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
22727 @cindex window height
22728 @cindex window width
22729 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22730 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22731 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22732 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22733 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22734 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22735
22736 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22737 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22738 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22739 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22740
22741 @findex gnus-configure-frame
22742 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22743 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22744 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22745 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22746 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22747 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22748 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22749 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22750 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22751 configuration list.
22752
22753 @lisp
22754 (gnus-configure-frame
22755 '(horizontal 1.0
22756 (vertical 10
22757 (group 1.0)
22758 (article 0.3 point))
22759 (vertical 1.0
22760 (article 1.0)
22761 (horizontal 4
22762 (group 1.0)
22763 (article 10)))))
22764 @end lisp
22765
22766 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22767 @code{frame} split:
22768
22769 @lisp
22770 (gnus-configure-frame
22771 '(frame 1.0
22772 (vertical 1.0
22773 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22774 (article 1.0))
22775 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22776 (user-position . t)
22777 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22778 (picon 1.0))))
22779
22780 @end lisp
22781
22782 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22783 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22784 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22785 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22786 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22787 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22788 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22789 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22790 is such a plist.
22791 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22792 be found in its default value.
22793
22794 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22795 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22796 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22797 might be used:
22798
22799 @lisp
22800 (message (horizontal 1.0
22801 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22802 (vertical 0.24
22803 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22804 '(summary 0.5))
22805 (group 1.0))))
22806 @end lisp
22807
22808 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22809 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22810 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22811
22812 @lisp
22813 (message
22814 (frame 1.0
22815 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22816 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22817 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22818 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22819 (name . "Message"))
22820 (message 1.0 point))))
22821 @end lisp
22822
22823 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22824 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22825 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22826 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22827 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22828
22829 @lisp
22830 (gnus-add-configuration
22831 '(article (vertical 1.0
22832 (group 4)
22833 (summary .25 point)
22834 (article 1.0))))
22835 @end lisp
22836
22837 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22838 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22839 Gnus has been loaded.
22840
22841 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22842 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22843 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22844 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22845 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22846
22847 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22848 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22849 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22850 windows resized.
22851
22852 @subsection Window Configuration Names
22853
22854 Here's a list of most of the currently known window configurations,
22855 and when they're used:
22856
22857 @table @code
22858 @item group
22859 The group buffer.
22860
22861 @item summary
22862 Entering a group and showing only the summary.
22863
22864 @item article
22865 Selecting an article.
22866
22867 @item server
22868 The server buffer.
22869
22870 @item browse
22871 Browsing groups from the server buffer.
22872
22873 @item message
22874 Composing a (new) message.
22875
22876 @item only-article
22877 Showing only the article buffer.
22878
22879 @item edit-article
22880 Editing an article.
22881
22882 @item edit-form
22883 Editing group parameters and the like.
22884
22885 @item edit-score
22886 Editing a server definition.
22887
22888 @item post
22889 Composing a news message.
22890
22891 @item reply
22892 Replying or following up an article without yanking the text.
22893
22894 @item forward
22895 Forwarding a message.
22896
22897 @item reply-yank
22898 Replying or following up an article with yanking the text.
22899
22900 @item mail-bound
22901 Bouncing a message.
22902
22903 @item pipe
22904 Sending an article to an external process.
22905
22906 @item bug
22907 Sending a bug report.
22908
22909 @item score-trace
22910 Displaying the score trace.
22911
22912 @item score-words
22913 Displaying the score words.
22914
22915 @item split-trace
22916 Displaying the split trace.
22917
22918 @item compose-bounce
22919 Composing a bounce message.
22920
22921 @item mml-preview
22922 Previewing a @acronym{MIME} part.
22923
22924 @end table
22925
22926
22927 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22928
22929 @itemize @bullet
22930 @item
22931 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22932 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22933
22934 @ifinfo
22935 @example
22936 +---+---------+
22937 | G | Summary |
22938 | r +---------+
22939 | o | |
22940 | u | Article |
22941 | p | |
22942 +---+---------+
22943 @end example
22944 @end ifinfo
22945
22946 @lisp
22947 (gnus-add-configuration
22948 '(article
22949 (horizontal 1.0
22950 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22951 (vertical 1.0
22952 (summary 0.16 point)
22953 (article 1.0)))))
22954
22955 (gnus-add-configuration
22956 '(summary
22957 (horizontal 1.0
22958 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22959 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22960 @end lisp
22961
22962 @end itemize
22963
22964
22965 @node Faces and Fonts
22966 @section Faces and Fonts
22967 @cindex faces
22968 @cindex fonts
22969 @cindex colors
22970
22971 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22972 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22973 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22974 interface.
22975
22976
22977 @node Mode Lines
22978 @section Mode Lines
22979 @cindex mode lines
22980
22981 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22982 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22983 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22984 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22985 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22986 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22987 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22988 quicker.
22989
22990 @cindex display-time
22991
22992 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22993 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22994 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
22995 to display (e.g., the subject of the article) is often longer than the
22996 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
22997 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
22998 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
22999 additional elements on the mode line (e.g., a clock), you should modify
23000 this variable:
23001
23002 @c Hook written by Francesco Potortì <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
23003 @lisp
23004 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
23005 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
23006 (+ 21
23007 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
23008 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
23009 (length display-time-string)))))
23010 @end lisp
23011
23012 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
23013 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
23014 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
23015 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
23016 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
23017
23018
23019 @node Highlighting and Menus
23020 @section Highlighting and Menus
23021 @cindex visual
23022 @cindex highlighting
23023 @cindex menus
23024
23025 @vindex gnus-visual
23026 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
23027 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
23028 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
23029 file.
23030
23031 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
23032 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
23033
23034 @table @code
23035 @item group-highlight
23036 Do highlights in the group buffer.
23037 @item summary-highlight
23038 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
23039 @item article-highlight
23040 Do highlights in the article buffer.
23041 @item highlight
23042 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
23043 @item group-menu
23044 Create menus in the group buffer.
23045 @item summary-menu
23046 Create menus in the summary buffers.
23047 @item article-menu
23048 Create menus in the article buffer.
23049 @item browse-menu
23050 Create menus in the browse buffer.
23051 @item server-menu
23052 Create menus in the server buffer.
23053 @item score-menu
23054 Create menus in the score buffers.
23055 @item menu
23056 Create menus in all buffers.
23057 @end table
23058
23059 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
23060 buffers, you could say something like:
23061
23062 @lisp
23063 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
23064 @end lisp
23065
23066 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
23067
23068 @lisp
23069 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
23070 @end lisp
23071
23072 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
23073 in all Gnus buffers.
23074
23075 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
23076
23077 @table @code
23078 @item gnus-mouse-face
23079 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
23080 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
23081 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
23082
23083 @end table
23084
23085 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
23086
23087 @table @code
23088
23089 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
23090 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
23091 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
23092
23093 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
23094 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23095 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23096
23097 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23098 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23099 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23100
23101 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
23102 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23103 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23104
23105 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23106 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23107 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23108
23109 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
23110 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23111 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23112
23113 @end table
23114
23115
23116 @node Daemons
23117 @section Daemons
23118 @cindex demons
23119 @cindex daemons
23120
23121 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23122 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23123 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23124 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23125 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23126
23127 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23128 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23129 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23130
23131 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23132 been idle for thirty minutes:
23133
23134 @lisp
23135 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23136 @end lisp
23137
23138 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23139 Emacs is idle:
23140
23141 @lisp
23142 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23143 @end lisp
23144
23145 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23146 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23147 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23148
23149 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23150 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23151 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23152 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23153
23154 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23155 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23156 @var{idle} minutes.
23157
23158 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23159 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23160 minutes.
23161
23162 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23163 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23164 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23165
23166 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23167 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23168 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23169 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23170
23171 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23172 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23173
23174 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23175 @lisp
23176 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23177 @end lisp
23178
23179 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23180 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23181 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23182 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23183 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
23184 @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
23185 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23186 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23187 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23188 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23189
23190 @findex gnus-demon-init
23191 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
23192 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23193 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23194 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23195 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23196
23197 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23198 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23199 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23200 behave.
23201
23202
23203 @node Undo
23204 @section Undo
23205 @cindex undo
23206
23207 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23208 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23209 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23210
23211 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23212 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23213 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23214 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23215 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23216 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23217 @code{undo} function.
23218
23219 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23220 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23221 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23222 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23223 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23224 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23225 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23226 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23227 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23228 never be totally undoable.
23229
23230 @findex gnus-undo-mode
23231 @vindex gnus-use-undo
23232 @findex gnus-undo
23233 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23234 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23235 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23236 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23237 command.
23238
23239
23240 @node Predicate Specifiers
23241 @section Predicate Specifiers
23242 @cindex predicate specifiers
23243
23244 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23245 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23246 to type all that much.
23247
23248 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23249
23250 Here's an example:
23251
23252 @lisp
23253 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
23254 gnus-article-unread-p)
23255 @end lisp
23256
23257 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23258 functions all take one parameter.
23259
23260 @findex gnus-make-predicate
23261 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23262 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23263 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23264 specifier.
23265
23266
23267 @node Moderation
23268 @section Moderation
23269 @cindex moderation
23270
23271 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23272 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23273 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23274 get a copy.
23275
23276 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23277 buffers. Put
23278
23279 @lisp
23280 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23281 @end lisp
23282
23283 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23284
23285 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23286 supposed to work:
23287
23288 @enumerate
23289 @item
23290 You split your incoming mail by matching on
23291 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23292 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23293
23294 @item
23295 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23296 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23297
23298 @item
23299 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23300 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23301 @kbd{c} command.
23302 @end enumerate
23303
23304 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23305
23306 @lisp
23307 (setq gnus-moderated-list
23308 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23309 @end lisp
23310
23311
23312 @node Fetching a Group
23313 @section Fetching a Group
23314 @cindex fetching a group
23315
23316 @findex gnus-fetch-group
23317 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23318 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23319 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23320 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23321 It takes the group name as a parameter.
23322
23323
23324 @node Image Enhancements
23325 @section Image Enhancements
23326
23327 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23328 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23329 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23330
23331 @menu
23332 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23333 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23334 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23335 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
23336 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
23337 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23338 @end menu
23339
23340
23341 @node X-Face
23342 @subsection X-Face
23343 @cindex x-face
23344
23345 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23346 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23347 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23348 readers.
23349
23350 @cindex x-face
23351 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23352 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23353 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23354 @iftex
23355 @iflatex
23356 \include{xface}
23357 @end iflatex
23358 @end iftex
23359 @c @anchor{X-Face}
23360
23361 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
23362 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
23363 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
23364 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
23365 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
23366 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
23367 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
23368 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
23369 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
23370 @code{display} program.
23371
23372 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
23373 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
23374 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
23375 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
23376 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
23377 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
23378 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
23379 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
23380
23381 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
23382 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
23383 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
23384 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
23385 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
23386 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
23387
23388 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
23389 @code{xface}).
23390
23391 @noindent
23392 Face and variable:
23393
23394 @table @code
23395 @item gnus-x-face
23396 @vindex gnus-x-face
23397 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
23398 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
23399 default colors are black and white.
23400
23401 @item gnus-face-properties-alist
23402 @vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
23403 Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
23404 X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
23405 (png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
23406 XEmacs. Here are examples:
23407
23408 @lisp
23409 ;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
23410 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23411 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
23412 (png . (:ascent 80))))
23413
23414 ;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
23415 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23416 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
23417 (png . (:relief -2))))
23418 @end lisp
23419
23420 @pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
23421 Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
23422 Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
23423 for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
23424 on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
23425 @samp{libcompface} library.
23426 @end table
23427
23428 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
23429 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
23430 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
23431 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
23432 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
23433 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
23434
23435 @findex gnus-random-x-face
23436 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
23437 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
23438 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
23439 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
23440 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
23441 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
23442 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
23443 header data as a string.
23444
23445 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
23446 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
23447 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
23448 randomly generated data.
23449
23450 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
23451 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
23452 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
23453 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
23454 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
23455
23456 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
23457 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23458
23459 @lisp
23460 (setq message-required-news-headers
23461 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23462 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
23463 @end lisp
23464
23465 Using the last function would be something like this:
23466
23467 @lisp
23468 (setq message-required-news-headers
23469 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23470 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
23471 (gnus-x-face-from-file
23472 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
23473 @end lisp
23474
23475
23476 @node Face
23477 @subsection Face
23478 @cindex face
23479
23480 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
23481
23482 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
23483 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
23484 represent the author of the message.
23485
23486 @cindex face
23487 @findex gnus-article-display-face
23488 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
23489 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
23490 specifications.
23491
23492 The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
23493 displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
23494
23495 Viewing a @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
23496 PNG images.
23497 @c Maybe add this:
23498 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
23499 @c (featurep 'png)
23500 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
23501
23502 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
23503 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
23504
23505 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
23506 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
23507 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
23508
23509 @findex gnus-face-from-file
23510 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
23511 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
23512 converts the file to Face format by using the
23513 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
23514
23515 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
23516 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23517
23518 @lisp
23519 (setq message-required-news-headers
23520 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23521 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
23522 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
23523 @end lisp
23524
23525
23526 @node Smileys
23527 @subsection Smileys
23528 @cindex smileys
23529
23530 @iftex
23531 @iflatex
23532 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
23533 \input{smiley}
23534 @end iflatex
23535 @end iftex
23536
23537 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
23538 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
23539
23540 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
23541 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23542
23543 @lisp
23544 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
23545 @end lisp
23546
23547 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
23548 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
23549 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
23550 text and maps that to file names.
23551
23552 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
23553 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
23554 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
23555 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
23556 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
23557 displayed.
23558
23559 The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
23560
23561 @table @code
23562
23563 @item smiley-style
23564 @vindex smiley-style
23565 Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
23566 @code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
23567 (more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
23568 images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
23569 face.
23570
23571 @item smiley-data-directory
23572 @vindex smiley-data-directory
23573 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
23574 variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
23575
23576 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
23577 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
23578 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
23579
23580 @end table
23581
23582
23583 @node Picons
23584 @subsection Picons
23585
23586 @iftex
23587 @iflatex
23588 \include{picons}
23589 @end iflatex
23590 @end iftex
23591
23592 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
23593 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
23594 over your shoulder as you read news.
23595
23596 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
23597
23598 @iftex
23599 @iflatex
23600 \margindex{}
23601 @end iflatex
23602 @end iftex
23603
23604 @quotation
23605 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23606 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23607 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23608 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23609 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23610 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23611 @code{GIF} formats.
23612 @end quotation
23613
23614 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23615 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23616 point your Web browser at
23617 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23618
23619 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23620 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23621
23622 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23623 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23624 Picons databases.
23625
23626 @vindex gnus-picon-style
23627 The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
23628 If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
23629 @code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
23630
23631 @vindex gnus-picon-properties
23632 The value of the variable @code{gnus-picon-properties} is a list of
23633 properties applied to picons.
23634
23635 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23636
23637 @table @code
23638
23639 @item gnus-picon-databases
23640 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23641 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23642 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23643 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23644 "/usr/local/faces")}.
23645
23646 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
23647 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23648 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23649 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23650
23651 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
23652 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23653 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23654 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23655
23656 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23657 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23658 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23659 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23660 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23661
23662 @item gnus-picon-file-types
23663 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23664 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23665 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23666
23667 @item gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23668 @vindex gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23669 If non-@code{nil} (which is the default), don't display picons for
23670 things like @samp{.net} and @samp{.de}, which aren't usually very
23671 interesting.
23672
23673 @end table
23674
23675 @node Gravatars
23676 @subsection Gravatars
23677
23678 @iftex
23679 @iflatex
23680 \include{gravatars}
23681 @end iflatex
23682 @end iftex
23683
23684 A gravatar is an image registered to an e-mail address.
23685
23686 You can submit yours on-line at @uref{http://www.gravatar.com}.
23687
23688 The following variables offer control over how things are displayed.
23689
23690 @table @code
23691
23692 @item gnus-gravatar-size
23693 @vindex gnus-gravatar-size
23694 The size in pixels of gravatars. Gravatars are always square, so one
23695 number for the size is enough.
23696
23697 @item gnus-gravatar-properties
23698 @vindex gnus-gravatar-properties
23699 List of image properties applied to Gravatar images.
23700
23701 @item gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23702 @vindex gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23703 Regexp that matches mail addresses or names of people of which avatars
23704 should not be displayed, or @code{nil}. It default to the value of
23705 @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (@pxref{X-Face}).
23706
23707 @end table
23708
23709 If you want to see them in the From field, set:
23710 @lisp
23711 (setq gnus-treat-from-gravatar 'head)
23712 @end lisp
23713
23714 If you want to see them in the Cc and To fields, set:
23715
23716 @lisp
23717 (setq gnus-treat-mail-gravatar 'head)
23718 @end lisp
23719
23720
23721 @node XVarious
23722 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23723
23724 @table @code
23725 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23726 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23727 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23728 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23729 unusual directory structure.
23730
23731 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23732 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23733 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23734 default.
23735
23736 @end table
23737
23738 @subsubsection Toolbar
23739
23740 @table @code
23741
23742 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23743 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23744 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23745 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23746 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23747 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23748 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23749 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23750
23751 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23752 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23753 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23754 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23755 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23756 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23757
23758 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23759 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23760 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23761
23762 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23763 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23764 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23765
23766 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23767 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23768 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23769
23770 @end table
23771
23772 @iftex
23773 @iflatex
23774 \margindex{}
23775 @end iflatex
23776 @end iftex
23777
23778
23779 @node Fuzzy Matching
23780 @section Fuzzy Matching
23781 @cindex fuzzy matching
23782
23783 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23784 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23785
23786 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23787 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23788 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23789
23790 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23791 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23792 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23793 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23794 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23795
23796
23797 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23798 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23799 @cindex email spam
23800 @cindex spam
23801 @cindex UCE
23802 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23803
23804 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23805 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23806 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23807 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23808 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23809 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23810 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23811 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23812 in the end.
23813
23814 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23815 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23816 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23817 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23818 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23819 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23820
23821 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23822
23823 @menu
23824 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23825 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23826 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23827 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23828 @end menu
23829
23830 @node The problem of spam
23831 @subsection The problem of spam
23832 @cindex email spam
23833 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23834 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23835 @cindex UCE
23836 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23837
23838 First, some background on spam.
23839
23840 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23841 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23842 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23843 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23844 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23845 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23846 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23847 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23848 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23849
23850 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23851 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23852 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23853 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23854 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23855 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23856 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23857 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23858 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23859 and processing.
23860
23861 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23862 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23863 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23864 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23865 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23866 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23867 from Bulgarian IPs.
23868
23869 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23870 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23871 etc.)@: or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.)@: from contacting
23872 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23873
23874 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23875 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23876 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23877 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23878
23879 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23880 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23881 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23882 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23883 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23884 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23885 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23886 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23887 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23888
23889 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23890 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23891 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23892 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23893 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23894 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23895 down for some time because of the incident.
23896
23897 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23898 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23899 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23900 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23901 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23902 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23903 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23904 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23905 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23906 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23907 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23908
23909 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23910 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23911 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23912 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23913 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23914 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23915 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23916 spam plague.
23917
23918 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23919 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23920 @cindex email spam
23921 @cindex spam
23922 @cindex UCE
23923 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23924
23925 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23926 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23927
23928 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23929 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23930 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23931 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23932 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23933 part of the mail address.)
23934
23935 @lisp
23936 (setq message-default-news-headers
23937 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23938 @end lisp
23939
23940 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23941 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23942
23943 @lisp
23944 (...
23945 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23946 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23947 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23948 "spam"))
23949 ...)
23950 @end lisp
23951
23952 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23953 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23954 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23955 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23956
23957 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23958 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23959 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23960 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23961 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23962 your fancy split rule in this way:
23963
23964 @lisp
23965 (
23966 ...
23967 (to "larsi" "misc")
23968 "spam")
23969 @end lisp
23970
23971 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23972 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23973 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23974 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23975 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23976
23977 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23978 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23979 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23980 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23981
23982 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23983
23984
23985 @node SpamAssassin
23986 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23987 @cindex SpamAssassin
23988 @cindex Vipul's Razor
23989 @cindex DCC
23990
23991 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23992 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23993 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23994 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23995 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23996 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23997 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23998
23999 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
24000 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
24001 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
24002 recipes.
24003
24004 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
24005 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
24006 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
24007 Specifiers}) follow.
24008
24009 @lisp
24010 (setq mail-sources
24011 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
24012 (pop :user "jrl"
24013 :server "pophost"
24014 :postscript
24015 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
24016 @end lisp
24017
24018 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
24019 the mail contain, e.g., a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
24020 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
24021
24022 @lisp
24023 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
24024 ...))
24025 @end lisp
24026
24027 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
24028
24029 @lisp
24030 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
24031 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
24032 ...))
24033 @end lisp
24034
24035 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
24036 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
24037 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
24038 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
24039
24040 @lisp
24041 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
24042 ...))
24043 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
24044 (save-excursion
24045 (save-restriction
24046 (widen)
24047 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
24048 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
24049 "spam"))))
24050 @end lisp
24051
24052 Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
24053 downloaded by default. You need to set
24054 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
24055 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
24056
24057 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
24058 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
24059 spam. And here is the nifty function:
24060
24061 @lisp
24062 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
24063 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
24064 (interactive)
24065 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d" t)
24066 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
24067 @end lisp
24068
24069 @node Hashcash
24070 @subsection Hashcash
24071 @cindex hashcash
24072
24073 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
24074 costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
24075 the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
24076 using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
24077 but it may be useful in smaller communities.
24078
24079 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
24080 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
24081 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
24082 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
24083 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
24084 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
24085 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
24086 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
24087 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
24088 one of them separately.
24089
24090 @cindex X-Hashcash
24091 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
24092 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
24093 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24094 For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24095 need to install to use this feature, see
24096 @uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24097 at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
24098
24099 If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24100 customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24101 Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
24102
24103 @lisp
24104 (setq message-generate-hashcash t)
24105 @end lisp
24106
24107 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24108
24109 @table @code
24110
24111 @item hashcash-default-payment
24112 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
24113 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
24114 should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24115 include 17 to 29.
24116
24117 @item hashcash-payment-alist
24118 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24119 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24120 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24121 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24122 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24123 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24124 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24125 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24126
24127 @item hashcash-path
24128 @vindex hashcash-path
24129 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24130 be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24131 (usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24132 you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24133 when you generate hashcash payments.
24134
24135 @end table
24136
24137 Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24138 hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24139 in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24140 @code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24141 package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24142 cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24143 Hashcash Payments}).
24144
24145 @node Spam Package
24146 @section Spam Package
24147 @cindex spam filtering
24148 @cindex spam
24149
24150 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24151 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24152 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24153 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24154
24155 @menu
24156 * Spam Package Introduction::
24157 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
24158 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
24159 * Spam and Ham Processors::
24160 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24161 * Spam Back Ends::
24162 * Extending the Spam package::
24163 * Spam Statistics Package::
24164 @end menu
24165
24166 @node Spam Package Introduction
24167 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
24168 @cindex spam filtering
24169 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24170 @cindex spam
24171
24172 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24173 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24174
24175 Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24176 events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24177
24178 @cindex spam-initialize
24179 @vindex spam-use-stat
24180 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24181 @code{spam-initialize}:
24182
24183 @example
24184 (spam-initialize)
24185 @end example
24186
24187 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24188 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24189 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24190 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24191 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24192
24193 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24194 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24195
24196 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24197 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24198
24199 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24200 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24201 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24202 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24203 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24204
24205 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24206 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24207 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24208 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24209 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24210 Groups}.
24211
24212 @cindex spam back ends
24213 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24214 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24215 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24216 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24217 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24218
24219 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24220 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24221
24222 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24223 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24224 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24225 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24226 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24227 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24228 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24229
24230 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24231 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24232 point, the Spam package does several things:
24233
24234 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24235 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24236 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24237 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24238 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24239 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24240 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24241 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24242 Ham Processors}.
24243
24244 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24245 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24246 group:
24247
24248 @table @kbd
24249 @item $
24250 @itemx M-d
24251 @itemx M s x
24252 @itemx S x
24253 @kindex $ (Summary)
24254 @kindex M-d (Summary)
24255 @kindex S x (Summary)
24256 @kindex M s x (Summary)
24257 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24258 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24259 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24260 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24261 @end table
24262
24263 @noindent
24264 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24265 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24266
24267 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24268 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24269 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24270 to be processed as ham by setting
24271 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24272 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24273
24274 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24275 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24276 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24277 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24278 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24279 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24280 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24281 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24282 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24283 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24284 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24285 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24286
24287 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24288 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24289 want each article to be processed only once, load the
24290 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24291 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24292 Configuration Examples}.
24293
24294 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24295 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24296 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24297 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24298
24299 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24300 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24301
24302 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24303 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
24304 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24305
24306 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
24307 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24308 @cindex spam filtering
24309 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24310 @cindex spam
24311
24312 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24313 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24314 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24315 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24316 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24317
24318 @example
24319 (: spam-split)
24320 @end example
24321
24322 @vindex spam-split-group
24323 @noindent
24324 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24325 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24326 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24327 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24328 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24329 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24330 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24331 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24332 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24333
24334 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24335
24336 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24337 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24338 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
24339 you should also set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to
24340 @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can ``scan''
24341 the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only retrieves
24342 the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells it to
24343 retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by default
24344 because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24345 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Client-Side
24346 IMAP Splitting}.
24347
24348 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24349 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24350 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24351 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24352 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24353 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24354 ends, and the following split rule:
24355
24356 @example
24357 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24358 (any "ding" "ding")
24359 (: spam-split)
24360 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24361 "mail")
24362 @end example
24363
24364 @noindent
24365 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24366 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24367 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24368 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24369 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24370 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24371
24372 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24373 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24374 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24375 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24376
24377 @example
24378 nnimap-split-fancy
24379 '(|
24380 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24381 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24382 (any "ding" "ding")
24383 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24384 (: spam-split)
24385 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24386 "mail")
24387 @end example
24388
24389 @noindent
24390 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24391 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24392 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24393 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24394 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24395 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24396 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24397
24398 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24399 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24400 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24401 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24402
24403 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24404 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24405 @c don't.}
24406
24407 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
24408 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24409
24410 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24411 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24412 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24413 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24414
24415 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24416 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24417 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24418 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
24419
24420 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
24421 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
24422 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
24423
24424 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
24425 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
24426 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
24427 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
24428 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
24429 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
24430 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
24431
24432 @node Spam and Ham Processors
24433 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
24434 @cindex spam filtering
24435 @cindex spam filtering variables
24436 @cindex spam variables
24437 @cindex spam
24438
24439 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
24440 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
24441 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
24442 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
24443 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
24444 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
24445 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
24446
24447 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
24448 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
24449 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
24450 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
24451
24452 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24453 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
24454 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
24455 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
24456 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
24457 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
24458 by customizing the corresponding variable
24459 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
24460 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
24461 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
24462 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
24463 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
24464 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
24465 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
24466 default.
24467
24468 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
24469 @cindex $
24470 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
24471 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
24472 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
24473 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
24474 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
24475 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
24476 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
24477 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
24478 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
24479 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
24480 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
24481 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
24482 processor which will study them as spam samples.
24483
24484 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
24485 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
24486 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
24487 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
24488 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
24489 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
24490 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
24491 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
24492
24493 @defvar ham-marks
24494 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24495 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
24496 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
24497 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
24498 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
24499 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
24500 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
24501 happy for you.
24502 @end defvar
24503
24504 @defvar spam-marks
24505 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24506 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
24507 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
24508 you really want to.
24509 @end defvar
24510
24511 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
24512 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
24513 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
24514 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
24515 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
24516 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
24517 and nothing else.
24518
24519 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24520 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
24521 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
24522 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
24523 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
24524 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
24525 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
24526 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
24527 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
24528 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
24529 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
24530 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
24531 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
24532 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
24533 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
24534
24535 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24536 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24537
24538 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24539 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
24540 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
24541
24542 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
24543 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
24544
24545 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
24546 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
24547 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
24548 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
24549 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
24550
24551 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
24552 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
24553 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
24554 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
24555 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
24556 it there.
24557
24558 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24559 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
24560 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
24561 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
24562 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
24563 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
24564 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
24565 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
24566 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
24567 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
24568 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
24569 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
24570 group buffer then you need it here as well.
24571
24572 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24573 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24574
24575 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24576 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
24577 training} groups.
24578
24579 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
24580 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
24581 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
24582 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
24583 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
24584 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
24585 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
24586
24587 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
24588 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
24589 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
24590 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
24591
24592 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
24593 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
24594 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
24595 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
24596 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
24597 from the mail server.
24598
24599 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
24600 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
24601 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
24602 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
24603
24604 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
24605 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
24606 @cindex spam filtering
24607 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
24608 @cindex spam configuration examples
24609 @cindex spam
24610
24611 @subsubheading Ted's setup
24612
24613 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
24614 @example
24615 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
24616 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
24617 (gnus-registry-initialize)
24618 (spam-initialize)
24619
24620 (setq
24621 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
24622 spam-use-BBDB t
24623 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
24624 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
24625 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24626 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24627 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
24628 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
24629 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
24630 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
24631 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
24632 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
24633 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24634 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
24635 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
24636 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
24637 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24638 (any "ding" "ding")
24639 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
24640 (: spam-split)
24641 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24642 "mail"))
24643
24644 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
24645
24646 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
24647 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
24648 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
24649 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
24650
24651 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24652
24653 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
24654 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
24655 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
24656 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
24657 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24658
24659 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
24660 ((spam-autodetect . t))
24661
24662 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
24663
24664 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
24665 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
24666
24667 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
24668 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
24669 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
24670
24671 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
24672
24673 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24674 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24675
24676 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24677 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24678 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24679 (ham-marks
24680 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24681 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24682 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24683 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24684
24685 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24686 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24687 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24688
24689 @end example
24690
24691 @subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
24692 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24693
24694 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24695 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24696 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
24697 i.e., to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
24698 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24699 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24700 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24701 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24702 @samp{training.spam} folders.
24703
24704 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24705 does most of the job for me:
24706
24707 @lisp
24708 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24709 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24710 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24711 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24712 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24713 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24714 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24715 @end lisp
24716
24717 @itemize
24718
24719 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
24720
24721 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
24722 (i.e., legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
24723 bogofilter or DCC).
24724
24725 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24726 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24727 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24728 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24729 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24730 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24731 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24732
24733 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24734 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
24735 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e., chars) makes finding
24736 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24737 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24738 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24739
24740 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24741
24742 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24743 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24744 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24745 @samp{training.spam}.
24746 @end itemize
24747
24748 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24749
24750 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24751
24752 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24753 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24754 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24755
24756 @lisp
24757 ("^gmane\\."
24758 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24759 @end lisp
24760
24761 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24762 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24763 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e., the article numbers are
24764 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24765 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24766
24767 @node Spam Back Ends
24768 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24769 @cindex spam back ends
24770
24771 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24772 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24773 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24774 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24775 Processors}).
24776
24777 @menu
24778 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24779 * BBDB Whitelists::
24780 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24781 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24782 * Blackholes::
24783 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24784 * Bogofilter::
24785 * SpamAssassin back end::
24786 * ifile spam filtering::
24787 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24788 * SpamOracle::
24789 @end menu
24790
24791 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24792 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24793 @cindex spam filtering
24794 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24795 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24796 @cindex spam
24797
24798 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24799
24800 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24801 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24802 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24803 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24804 be spammers.
24805
24806 @end defvar
24807
24808 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24809
24810 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24811 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24812 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24813 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24814 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24815
24816 @end defvar
24817
24818 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24819
24820 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24821 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24822 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24823
24824 @end defvar
24825
24826 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24827
24828 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24829 customizing the group parameters or the
24830 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24831 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24832 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24833
24834 @emph{WARNING}
24835
24836 Instead of the obsolete
24837 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24838 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24839 the same way, we promise.
24840
24841 @end defvar
24842
24843 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24844
24845 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24846 customizing the group parameters or the
24847 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24848 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24849 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24850 whitelist.
24851
24852 @emph{WARNING}
24853
24854 Instead of the obsolete
24855 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24856 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24857 the same way, we promise.
24858
24859 @end defvar
24860
24861 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24862 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24863 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24864 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24865 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24866
24867 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24868 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24869 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24870 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24871
24872 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24873 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24874 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24875 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24876 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24877 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24878
24879 @node BBDB Whitelists
24880 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24881 @cindex spam filtering
24882 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24883 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24884 @cindex spam
24885
24886 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24887
24888 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24889 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24890 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24891 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24892 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24893 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24894 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24895
24896 @end defvar
24897
24898 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24899
24900 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24901 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24902 unless the sender is in the BBDB@. Use with care. Only sender
24903 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24904 classified as spammers.
24905
24906 While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
24907 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
24908 @emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
24909 @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to t, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
24910 will be exclusive.
24911
24912 @end defvar
24913
24914 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24915
24916 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24917 customizing the group parameters or the
24918 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24919 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24920 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24921 BBDB.
24922
24923 @emph{WARNING}
24924
24925 Instead of the obsolete
24926 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24927 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24928 the same way, we promise.
24929
24930 @end defvar
24931
24932 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24933 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24934 @cindex spam reporting
24935 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24936 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24937 @cindex spam
24938
24939 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24940
24941 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24942 customizing the group parameters or the
24943 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24944 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24945 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24946 HTTP request.
24947
24948 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24949
24950 @emph{WARNING}
24951
24952 Instead of the obsolete
24953 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24954 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24955 same way, we promise.
24956
24957 @end defvar
24958
24959 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24960
24961 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24962 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24963 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24964 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24965 @code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
24966
24967 @end defvar
24968
24969 @defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
24970
24971 Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
24972 the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
24973 default is @code{user-mail-address}.
24974
24975 @end defvar
24976
24977 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24978 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24979 @cindex spam filtering
24980 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24981 @cindex spam
24982
24983 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
24984
24985 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24986 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
24987 instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
24988 token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
24989 filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
24990 are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24991
24992 @end defvar
24993
24994 @node Blackholes
24995 @subsubsection Blackholes
24996 @cindex spam filtering
24997 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24998 @cindex spam
24999
25000 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
25001
25002 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
25003 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
25004 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
25005 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
25006 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
25007 contains outdated servers.
25008
25009 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
25010 @code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
25011 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
25012 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
25013 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
25014 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
25015
25016 @end defvar
25017
25018 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
25019
25020 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
25021
25022 @end defvar
25023
25024 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
25025
25026 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
25027 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
25028
25029 @end defvar
25030
25031 @defvar spam-use-dig
25032
25033 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
25034 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
25035
25036 @end defvar
25037
25038 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
25039 ham processor for blackholes.
25040
25041 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
25042 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
25043 @cindex spam filtering
25044 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
25045 @cindex spam
25046
25047 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
25048
25049 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
25050 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
25051 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
25052 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
25053 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
25054 message is spam or ham, respectively.
25055
25056 @end defvar
25057
25058 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
25059
25060 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25061 the message, positively identify it as spam.
25062
25063 @end defvar
25064
25065 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
25066
25067 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25068 the message, positively identify it as ham.
25069
25070 @end defvar
25071
25072 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
25073 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
25074
25075 @node Bogofilter
25076 @subsubsection Bogofilter
25077 @cindex spam filtering
25078 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
25079 @cindex spam
25080
25081 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
25082
25083 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25084 speedy Bogofilter.
25085
25086 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
25087 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
25088 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
25089 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
25090 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
25091 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
25092
25093 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25094 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25095 documentation.
25096
25097 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25098 processing will be turned off.
25099
25100 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25101
25102 @end defvar
25103
25104 @table @kbd
25105 @item M s t
25106 @itemx S t
25107 @kindex M s t
25108 @kindex S t
25109 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
25110 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25111 @end table
25112
25113 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25114
25115 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25116 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25117 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25118 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25119 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25120 installation documents for details.
25121
25122 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25123
25124 @end defvar
25125
25126 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25127 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25128 customizing the group parameters or the
25129 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25130 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25131 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25132
25133 @emph{WARNING}
25134
25135 Instead of the obsolete
25136 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25137 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25138 the same way, we promise.
25139 @end defvar
25140
25141 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25142 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25143 customizing the group parameters or the
25144 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25145 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25146 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
25147 of non-spam messages.
25148
25149 @emph{WARNING}
25150
25151 Instead of the obsolete
25152 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25153 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25154 the same way, we promise.
25155 @end defvar
25156
25157 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25158
25159 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25160 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25161 database directory.
25162
25163 @end defvar
25164
25165 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25166 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25167 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25168 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25169 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25170 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25171
25172 @node SpamAssassin back end
25173 @subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25174 @cindex spam filtering
25175 @cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25176 @cindex spam
25177
25178 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25179
25180 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25181
25182 SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25183 and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25184 trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25185 spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25186 mode.
25187
25188 If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25189 SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25190 preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25191 SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25192 instead.
25193
25194 You should not enable this if you use
25195 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25196
25197 @end defvar
25198
25199 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25200
25201 Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25202 want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25203
25204 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25205
25206 @end defvar
25207
25208 @defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25209
25210 This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25211 @code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25212 executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25213 for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25214
25215 @end defvar
25216
25217 SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25218 variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25219 provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25220 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25221 spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25222 been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25223 to test this functionality.
25224
25225 @node ifile spam filtering
25226 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25227 @cindex spam filtering
25228 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
25229 @cindex spam
25230
25231 @defvar spam-use-ifile
25232
25233 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25234 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25235
25236 @end defvar
25237
25238 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25239
25240 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25241 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25242 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25243
25244 @end defvar
25245
25246 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25247
25248 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25249 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25250 the default value of @samp{spam}.
25251 @end defvar
25252
25253 @defvar spam-ifile-database
25254
25255 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25256 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25257
25258 @end defvar
25259
25260 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25261 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25262 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25263 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25264 functionality.
25265
25266 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
25267 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25268 @cindex spam filtering
25269 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25270 @cindex spam-stat
25271 @cindex spam
25272
25273 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25274 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25275 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25276 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25277 spam-stat dictionary}.
25278
25279 @defvar spam-use-stat
25280
25281 @end defvar
25282
25283 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25284 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25285 customizing the group parameters or the
25286 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25287 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25288 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25289
25290 @emph{WARNING}
25291
25292 Instead of the obsolete
25293 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25294 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25295 the same way, we promise.
25296 @end defvar
25297
25298 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25299 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25300 customizing the group parameters or the
25301 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25302 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25303 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
25304 of non-spam messages.
25305
25306 @emph{WARNING}
25307
25308 Instead of the obsolete
25309 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25310 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25311 the same way, we promise.
25312 @end defvar
25313
25314 This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
25315 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25316 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25317 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25318 @code{spam-split} are provided.
25319
25320 @node SpamOracle
25321 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25322 @cindex spam filtering
25323 @cindex SpamOracle
25324 @cindex spam
25325
25326 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25327 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25328 installed separately.
25329
25330 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25331 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25332 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25333 mail as a spam mail or not.
25334
25335 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25336 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25337 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25338
25339 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25340 call SpamOracle.
25341
25342 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
25343 To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
25344 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25345 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25346 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25347 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25348 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25349 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25350
25351 @example
25352 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25353 spam-split-group "Junk"
25354 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
25355 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
25356 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25357 @end example
25358
25359 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25360 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25361 SpamOracle.
25362 @end defvar
25363
25364 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25365 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
25366 user's PATH@. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
25367 can be customized.
25368 @end defvar
25369
25370 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25371 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25372 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25373 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25374 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25375 database to live somewhere special, set
25376 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25377 @end defvar
25378
25379 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25380 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25381 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25382 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25383 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25384 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25385 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25386 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25387 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25388 @xref{Spam Package}.
25389
25390 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25391 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25392 customizing the group parameter or the
25393 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25394 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25395 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25396
25397 @emph{WARNING}
25398
25399 Instead of the obsolete
25400 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25401 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25402 the same way, we promise.
25403 @end defvar
25404
25405 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25406 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25407 customizing the group parameter or the
25408 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25409 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25410 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
25411 messages.
25412
25413 @emph{WARNING}
25414
25415 Instead of the obsolete
25416 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25417 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25418 the same way, we promise.
25419 @end defvar
25420
25421 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
25422 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
25423 messages.
25424 @example
25425 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
25426 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
25427 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
25428 @end example
25429 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
25430 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
25431 (e.g., because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
25432 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
25433 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
25434 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
25435
25436 @node Extending the Spam package
25437 @subsection Extending the Spam package
25438 @cindex spam filtering
25439 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
25440 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
25441
25442 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
25443 incoming mail, provide the following:
25444
25445 @enumerate
25446
25447 @item
25448 Code
25449
25450 @lisp
25451 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
25452 "True if blackbox should be used.")
25453 @end lisp
25454
25455 Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
25456
25457 Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
25458 @code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
25459 register/unregister routines as a start, or other register/unregister
25460 routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
25461 register/unregister spam and ham.
25462
25463 @item
25464 Functionality
25465
25466 The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
25467 @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
25468 existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
25469 do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
25470 why you aren't.
25471
25472 @end enumerate
25473
25474 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
25475
25476 @enumerate
25477
25478 @item
25479 Code
25480
25481 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
25482 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
25483
25484 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
25485 variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
25486 @code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
25487 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
25488
25489 @lisp
25490 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
25491 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
25492 Only applicable to spam groups.")
25493
25494 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
25495 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
25496 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
25497
25498 @end lisp
25499
25500 @item
25501 Gnus parameters
25502
25503 Add
25504 @lisp
25505 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
25506 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
25507 @end lisp
25508 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
25509 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
25510 variable customization.
25511
25512 Add
25513 @lisp
25514 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
25515 @end lisp
25516 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
25517 @code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
25518
25519 Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
25520 @code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
25521
25522
25523 @enumerate
25524
25525 @item
25526 @code{spam-install-backend-alias}
25527
25528 This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
25529 everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
25530 make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
25531
25532 @item
25533 @code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
25534
25535 This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
25536 register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
25537 such a back end.
25538
25539 @item
25540 @code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
25541
25542 This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
25543 for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
25544 @code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
25545 back ends.
25546
25547 @item
25548 @code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
25549
25550 This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
25551 full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
25552 for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
25553
25554 @item
25555 @code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
25556
25557 This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
25558 registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
25559 set up this way.
25560
25561 @item
25562 @code{spam-install-backend}
25563
25564 This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
25565 check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
25566 abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
25567
25568 @item
25569 @code{spam-install-mover-backend}
25570
25571 Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
25572 articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
25573 never install such a back end.
25574 @end enumerate
25575
25576 @end enumerate
25577
25578 @node Spam Statistics Package
25579 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
25580 @cindex Paul Graham
25581 @cindex Graham, Paul
25582 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
25583 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
25584 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
25585
25586 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
25587 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
25588 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
25589 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
25590 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
25591 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
25592 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
25593 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
25594 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
25595 or not.
25596
25597 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
25598 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
25599 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
25600 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
25601 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
25602 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
25603 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
25604 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
25605
25606 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
25607 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
25608 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
25609
25610 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
25611 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
25612 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
25613 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
25614 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
25615
25616 @menu
25617 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
25618 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
25619 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
25620 @end menu
25621
25622 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25623 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25624
25625 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
25626 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
25627 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
25628 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
25629 need several hundred emails in both collections.
25630
25631 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
25632 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
25633 per mail. Use the following:
25634
25635 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
25636 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
25637 is treated as one spam mail.
25638 @end defun
25639
25640 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
25641 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
25642 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
25643 @end defun
25644
25645 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
25646 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
25647 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
25648 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
25649 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
25650 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
25651
25652 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
25653 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
25654 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
25655 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
25656 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
25657
25658 @defvar spam-stat
25659 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
25660 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
25661 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
25662 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
25663 @end defvar
25664
25665 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
25666 reset the dictionary.
25667
25668 @defun spam-stat-reset
25669 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
25670 @end defun
25671
25672 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
25673 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
25674 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
25675 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
25676 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
25677 only non-spam mails.
25678
25679 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
25680 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
25681 to update the dictionary incrementally.
25682 @end defun
25683
25684 @defun spam-stat-save
25685 Save the dictionary.
25686 @end defun
25687
25688 @defvar spam-stat-file
25689 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
25690 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
25691 @end defvar
25692
25693 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
25694 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
25695
25696 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
25697 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
25698
25699 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25700
25701 @lisp
25702 (require 'spam-stat)
25703 (spam-stat-load)
25704 @end lisp
25705
25706 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
25707 created.
25708
25709 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
25710 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
25711 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
25712 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
25713
25714 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
25715 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
25716 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
25717 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
25718
25719 @lisp
25720 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25721 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25722 "mail.misc"))
25723 @end lisp
25724
25725 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
25726 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
25727 @end defvar
25728
25729 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
25730 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
25731 expression are considered potential spam.
25732
25733 @lisp
25734 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25735 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25736 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25737 "mail.misc"))
25738 @end lisp
25739
25740 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
25741 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
25742 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
25743 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
25744 mails, when creating the dictionary!
25745
25746 @lisp
25747 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25748 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25749 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25750 "mail.misc"))
25751 @end lisp
25752
25753 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
25754 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
25755 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
25756 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
25757 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
25758 dictionary!
25759
25760 @lisp
25761 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25762 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
25763 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25764 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25765 "mail.misc"))
25766 @end lisp
25767
25768
25769 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25770 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25771
25772 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25773
25774 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25775 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25776 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25777 @end defun
25778
25779 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25780 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25781 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25782 @end defun
25783
25784 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25785 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25786 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25787 already been processed as non-spam.
25788 @end defun
25789
25790 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25791 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25792 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25793 been processed as spam.
25794 @end defun
25795
25796 @defun spam-stat-save
25797 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25798 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25799 @end defun
25800
25801 @defun spam-stat-load
25802 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25803 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25804 @end defun
25805
25806 @defun spam-stat-score-word
25807 Return the spam score for a word.
25808 @end defun
25809
25810 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25811 Return the spam score for a buffer.
25812 @end defun
25813
25814 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25815 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25816 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25817 @end defun
25818
25819 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25820 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25821
25822 @lisp
25823 (require 'spam-stat)
25824 (spam-stat-load)
25825 @end lisp
25826
25827 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25828
25829 @smallexample
25830 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25831 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25832 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25833 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25834 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25835 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25836 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25837 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25838 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25839 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25840 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25841 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25842 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25843 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25844 @end smallexample
25845
25846 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25847
25848 @smallexample
25849 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25850 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25851 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25852 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25853 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25854 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25855 @end smallexample
25856
25857 @node The Gnus Registry
25858 @section The Gnus Registry
25859 @cindex registry
25860 @cindex split
25861 @cindex track
25862
25863 The Gnus registry is a package that tracks messages by their
25864 Message-ID across all backends. This allows Gnus users to do several
25865 cool things, be the envy of the locals, get free haircuts, and be
25866 experts on world issues. Well, maybe not all of those, but the
25867 features are pretty cool.
25868
25869 Although they will be explained in detail shortly, here's a quick list
25870 of said features in case your attention span is... never mind.
25871
25872 @enumerate
25873 @item
25874 Split messages to their parent
25875
25876 This keeps discussions in the same group. You can use the subject and
25877 the sender in addition to the Message-ID@. Several strategies are
25878 available.
25879
25880 @item
25881 Refer to messages by ID
25882
25883 Commands like @code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article} can take
25884 advantage of the registry to jump to the referred article, regardless
25885 of the group the message is in.
25886
25887 @item
25888 Store custom flags and keywords
25889
25890 The registry can store custom flags and keywords for a message. For
25891 instance, you can mark a message ``To-Do'' this way and the flag will
25892 persist whether the message is in the nnimap, nnml, nnmaildir,
25893 etc. backends.
25894
25895 @item
25896 Store arbitrary data
25897
25898 Through a simple ELisp API, the registry can remember any data for a
25899 message. A built-in inverse map, when activated, allows quick lookups
25900 of all messages matching a particular set of criteria.
25901 @end enumerate
25902
25903 @menu
25904 * Gnus Registry Setup::
25905 * Registry Article Refer Method::
25906 * Fancy splitting to parent::
25907 * Store custom flags and keywords::
25908 * Store arbitrary data::
25909 @end menu
25910
25911 @node Gnus Registry Setup
25912 @subsection Gnus Registry Setup
25913
25914 Fortunately, setting up the Gnus registry is pretty easy:
25915
25916 @lisp
25917 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25918
25919 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25920 @end lisp
25921
25922 This adds registry saves to Gnus newsrc saves (which happen on exit
25923 and when you press @kbd{s} from the @code{*Group*} buffer. It also
25924 adds registry calls to article actions in Gnus (copy, move, etc.)@: so
25925 it's not easy to undo the initialization. See
25926 @code{gnus-registry-initialize} for the gory details.
25927
25928 Here are other settings used by the author of the registry (understand
25929 what they do before you copy them blindly).
25930
25931 @lisp
25932 (setq
25933 gnus-registry-split-strategy 'majority
25934 gnus-registry-ignored-groups '(("nntp" t)
25935 ("nnrss" t)
25936 ("spam" t)
25937 ("train" t))
25938 gnus-registry-max-entries 500000
25939 ;; this is the default
25940 gnus-registry-track-extra '(sender subject))
25941 @end lisp
25942
25943 They say: keep a lot of messages around, track messages by sender and
25944 subject (not just parent Message-ID), and when the registry splits
25945 incoming mail, use a majority rule to decide where messages should go
25946 if there's more than one possibility. In addition, the registry
25947 should ignore messages in groups that match ``nntp'', ``nnrss'',
25948 ``spam'', or ``train.''
25949
25950 You are doubtless impressed by all this, but you ask: ``I am a Gnus
25951 user, I customize to live. Give me more.'' Here you go, these are
25952 the general settings.
25953
25954 @defvar gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups
25955 The groups that will not be followed by
25956 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}. They will still be
25957 remembered by the registry. This is a list of regular expressions.
25958 By default any group name that ends with ``delayed'', ``drafts'',
25959 ``queue'', or ``INBOX'', belongs to the nnmairix backend, or contains
25960 the word ``archive'' is not followed.
25961 @end defvar
25962
25963 @defvar gnus-registry-max-entries
25964 The number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries the
25965 registry will keep.
25966 @end defvar
25967
25968 @defvar gnus-registry-max-pruned-entries
25969 The maximum number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries
25970 the registry will keep after pruning.
25971 @end defvar
25972
25973 @defvar gnus-registry-cache-file
25974 The file where the registry will be stored between Gnus sessions. By
25975 default the file name is @code{.gnus.registry.eioio} in the same
25976 directory as your @code{.newsrc.eld}.
25977 @end defvar
25978
25979 @node Registry Article Refer Method
25980 @subsection Fetching by @code{Message-ID} Using the Registry
25981
25982 The registry knows how to map each @code{Message-ID} to the group it's
25983 in. This can be leveraged to enhance the ``article refer method'',
25984 the thing that tells Gnus how to look up an article given its
25985 Message-ID (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25986
25987 @vindex nnregistry
25988 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
25989
25990 The @code{nnregistry} refer method does exactly that. It has the
25991 advantage that an article may be found regardless of the group it's
25992 in---provided its @code{Message-ID} is known to the registry. It can
25993 be enabled by augmenting the start-up file with something along these
25994 lines:
25995
25996 @example
25997 ;; Keep enough entries to have a good hit rate when referring to an
25998 ;; article using the registry. Use long group names so that Gnus
25999 ;; knows where the article is.
26000 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
26001
26002 (gnus-registry-initialize)
26003
26004 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
26005 '(current
26006 (nnregistry)
26007 (nnweb "gmane" (nnweb-type gmane))))
26008 @end example
26009
26010 The example above instructs Gnus to first look up the article in the
26011 current group, or, alternatively, using the registry, and finally, if
26012 all else fails, using Gmane.
26013
26014 @node Fancy splitting to parent
26015 @subsection Fancy splitting to parent
26016
26017 Simply put, this lets you put followup e-mail where it belongs.
26018
26019 Every message has a Message-ID, which is unique, and the registry
26020 remembers it. When the message is moved or copied, the registry will
26021 notice this and offer the new group as a choice to the splitting
26022 strategy.
26023
26024 When a followup is made, usually it mentions the original message's
26025 Message-ID in the headers. The registry knows this and uses that
26026 mention to find the group where the original message lives. You only
26027 have to put a rule like this:
26028
26029 @lisp
26030 (setq nnimap-my-split-fancy '(|
26031
26032 ;; split to parent: you need this
26033 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
26034
26035 ;; other rules, as an example
26036 (: spam-split)
26037 ;; default mailbox
26038 "mail")
26039 @end lisp
26040
26041 in your fancy split setup. In addition, you may want to customize the
26042 following variables.
26043
26044 @defvar gnus-registry-track-extra
26045 This is a list of symbols, so it's best to change it from the
26046 Customize interface. By default it's @code{(subject sender recipient)},
26047 which may work for you. It can be annoying if your mail flow is large
26048 and people don't stick to the same groups.
26049
26050 When you decide to stop tracking any of those extra data, you can use
26051 the command @code{gnus-registry-remove-extra-data} to purge it from
26052 the existing registry entries.
26053 @end defvar
26054
26055 @defvar gnus-registry-split-strategy
26056 This is a symbol, so it's best to change it from the Customize
26057 interface. By default it's @code{nil}, but you may want to set it to
26058 @code{majority} or @code{first} to split by sender or subject based on
26059 the majority of matches or on the first found. I find @code{majority}
26060 works best.
26061 @end defvar
26062
26063 @node Store custom flags and keywords
26064 @subsection Store custom flags and keywords
26065
26066 The registry lets you set custom flags and keywords per message. You
26067 can use the Gnus->Registry Marks menu or the @kbd{M M x} keyboard
26068 shortcuts, where @code{x} is the first letter of the mark's name.
26069
26070 @defvar gnus-registry-marks
26071 The custom marks that the registry can use. You can modify the
26072 default list, if you like. If you do, you'll have to exit Emacs
26073 before they take effect (you can also unload the registry and reload
26074 it or evaluate the specific macros you'll need, but you probably don't
26075 want to bother). Use the Customize interface to modify the list.
26076
26077 By default this list has the @code{Important}, @code{Work},
26078 @code{Personal}, @code{To-Do}, and @code{Later} marks. They all have
26079 keyboard shortcuts like @kbd{M M i} for Important, using the first
26080 letter.
26081 @end defvar
26082
26083 @defun gnus-registry-mark-article
26084 Call this function to mark an article with a custom registry mark. It
26085 will offer the available marks for completion.
26086 @end defun
26087
26088 You can use @code{defalias} to install a summary line formatting
26089 function that will show the registry marks. There are two flavors of
26090 this function, either showing the marks as single characters, using
26091 their @code{:char} property, or showing the marks as full strings.
26092
26093 @lisp
26094 ;; show the marks as single characters (see the :char property in
26095 ;; `gnus-registry-marks'):
26096 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-chars)
26097
26098 ;; show the marks by name (see `gnus-registry-marks'):
26099 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-names)
26100 @end lisp
26101
26102
26103 @node Store arbitrary data
26104 @subsection Store arbitrary data
26105
26106 The registry has a simple API that uses a Message-ID as the key to
26107 store arbitrary data (as long as it can be converted to a list for
26108 storage).
26109
26110 @defun gnus-registry-set-id-key (id key value)
26111 Store @code{value} under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26112 @end defun
26113
26114 @defun gnus-registry-get-id-key (id key)
26115 Get the data under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26116 @end defun
26117
26118 @defvar gnus-registry-extra-entries-precious
26119 If any extra entries are precious, their presence will make the
26120 registry keep the whole entry forever, even if there are no groups for
26121 the Message-ID and if the size limit of the registry is reached. By
26122 default this is just @code{(marks)} so the custom registry marks are
26123 precious.
26124 @end defvar
26125
26126 @node Other modes
26127 @section Interaction with other modes
26128
26129 @subsection Dired
26130 @cindex dired
26131
26132 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26133 buffers. It is enabled with
26134 @lisp
26135 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26136 @end lisp
26137
26138 @table @kbd
26139 @item C-c C-m C-a
26140 @findex gnus-dired-attach
26141 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
26142 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26143 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26144
26145 @item C-c C-m C-l
26146 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26147 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26148 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26149 buffer.
26150
26151 @item C-c C-m C-p
26152 @findex gnus-dired-print
26153 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26154 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26155 @end table
26156
26157 @node Various Various
26158 @section Various Various
26159 @cindex mode lines
26160 @cindex highlights
26161
26162 @table @code
26163
26164 @item gnus-home-directory
26165 @vindex gnus-home-directory
26166 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26167 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26168
26169 @item gnus-directory
26170 @vindex gnus-directory
26171 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26172 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26173 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26174
26175 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26176 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26177 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26178 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26179
26180 @item gnus-default-directory
26181 @vindex gnus-default-directory
26182 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26183 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26184 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26185 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26186 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26187 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26188
26189 @item gnus-verbose
26190 @vindex gnus-verbose
26191 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26192 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26193 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26194 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26195 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26196
26197 @item gnus-verbose-backends
26198 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26199 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26200 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26201
26202 @item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26203 @vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26204 This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26205 controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26206 are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26207 timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26208 that go into the @samp{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26209 @w{@samp{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26210 @code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26211 displayed in the echo area.
26212
26213 @item nnheader-max-head-length
26214 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26215 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26216 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26217 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26218 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26219 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26220 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26221 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26222 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26223
26224 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
26225 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26226 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26227 read when doing the operation described above.
26228
26229 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26230 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26231 @cindex file names
26232 @cindex invalid characters in file names
26233 @cindex characters in file names
26234 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26235 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26236 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26237
26238 @lisp
26239 @group
26240 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26241 '((?: . ?_)))
26242 @end group
26243 @end lisp
26244
26245 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26246 Windows (phooey) systems.
26247
26248 @item gnus-hidden-properties
26249 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26250 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26251 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26252 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26253
26254 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26255 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26256 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26257 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26258 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26259
26260 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
26261 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26262 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26263
26264 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26265 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26266
26267 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26268 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26269 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26270 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26271 group).
26272
26273 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26274
26275 @item gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26276 @vindex gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26277 Groups in which links in html articles are considered all safe. The
26278 value may be a regexp matching those groups, a list of group names, or
26279 @code{nil}. This overrides @code{mm-w3m-safe-url-regexp}. The default
26280 value is @code{"\\`nnrss[+:]"}. This is effective only when emacs-w3m
26281 renders html articles, i.e., in the case @code{mm-text-html-renderer} is
26282 set to @code{w3m}. @xref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization,
26283 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}.
26284
26285 @end table
26286
26287 @node The End
26288 @chapter The End
26289
26290 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26291 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26292
26293 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26294
26295 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26296
26297 @quotation
26298 @strong{Te Deum}
26299
26300 @sp 1
26301 Not because of victories @*
26302 I sing,@*
26303 having none,@*
26304 but for the common sunshine,@*
26305 the breeze,@*
26306 the largess of the spring.
26307
26308 @sp 1
26309 Not for victory@*
26310 but for the day's work done@*
26311 as well as I was able;@*
26312 not for a seat upon the dais@*
26313 but at the common table.@*
26314 @end quotation
26315
26316
26317 @node Appendices
26318 @chapter Appendices
26319
26320 @menu
26321 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26322 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26323 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26324 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26325 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26326 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26327 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26328 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26329 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26330 @end menu
26331
26332
26333 @node XEmacs
26334 @section XEmacs
26335 @cindex XEmacs
26336 @cindex installing under XEmacs
26337
26338 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26339 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26340 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26341 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26342 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
26343 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26344
26345
26346 @node History
26347 @section History
26348
26349 @cindex history
26350 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26351 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26352
26353 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26354 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26355 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26356 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26357 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26358
26359 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26360 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26361 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26362 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26363 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26364 appropriate name, don't you think?)
26365
26366 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26367 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26368 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26369 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26370
26371 @menu
26372 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
26373 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26374 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26375 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26376 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26377 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26378 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26379 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26380 @end menu
26381
26382
26383 @node Gnus Versions
26384 @subsection Gnus Versions
26385 @cindex ding Gnus
26386 @cindex September Gnus
26387 @cindex Red Gnus
26388 @cindex Quassia Gnus
26389 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26390 @cindex Oort Gnus
26391 @cindex No Gnus
26392 @cindex Ma Gnus
26393 @cindex Gnus versions
26394
26395 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26396 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26397 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26398
26399 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26400 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26401
26402 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26403 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26404
26405 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26406 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26407
26408 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26409 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
26410 1999.
26411
26412 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26413 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26414
26415 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26416
26417 On April 19, 2010 Gnus development was moved to Git. See
26418 http://git.gnus.org for details (http://www.gnus.org will be updated
26419 with the information when possible).
26420
26421 On the January 31th 2012, Ma Gnus was begun.
26422
26423 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name---``(ding)
26424 Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26425 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'', ``Ma Gnus''---don't
26426 panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly.
26427 Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of
26428 its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to
26429 that instead.
26430
26431
26432 @node Why?
26433 @subsection Why?
26434
26435 What's the point of Gnus?
26436
26437 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26438 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26439 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26440 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26441 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26442 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26443 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26444 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26445 keep track of millions of people who post?
26446
26447 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26448 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26449 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26450 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26451 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26452 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26453 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26454 every one of you to explore and invent.
26455
26456 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26457 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26458
26459
26460 @node Compatibility
26461 @subsection Compatibility
26462
26463 @cindex compatibility
26464 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26465 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26466 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26467
26468 Our motto is:
26469 @quotation
26470 @cartouche
26471 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
26472 @end cartouche
26473 @end quotation
26474
26475 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26476 their names.
26477
26478 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26479 Articles}.
26480
26481 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26482 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26483 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26484 important variables have their values copied into their global
26485 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26486 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26487
26488 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26489 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26490 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26491 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26492 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26493 peculiar results.
26494
26495 @cindex hilit19
26496 @cindex highlighting
26497 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26498 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26499 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26500 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26501 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26502 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26503 Away!
26504
26505 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26506 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26507 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26508 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26509
26510 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26511 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26512 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26513 to stop doing it the old way.
26514
26515 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26516
26517 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26518 @findex gnus-bug
26519 @cindex reporting bugs
26520 @cindex bugs
26521 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26522 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26523 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26524
26525 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26526 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26527 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26528 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26529 up at you.
26530
26531
26532 @node Conformity
26533 @subsection Conformity
26534
26535 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26536 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26537 with, of course.
26538
26539 @table @strong
26540
26541 @item RFC (2)822
26542 @cindex RFC 822
26543 @cindex RFC 2822
26544 There are no known breaches of this standard.
26545
26546 @item RFC 1036
26547 @cindex RFC 1036
26548 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26549
26550 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
26551 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26552 We do have some breaches to this one.
26553
26554 @table @emph
26555
26556 @item X-Newsreader
26557 @itemx User-Agent
26558 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26559 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26560 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26561 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26562 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26563 @end table
26564
26565 @item USEFOR
26566 @cindex USEFOR
26567 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26568 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26569 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26570 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26571
26572 @item MIME---RFC 2045--2049 etc
26573 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
26574 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26575
26576 @item Disposition Notifications---RFC 2298
26577 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26578
26579 @item PGP---RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
26580 @cindex RFC 1991
26581 @cindex RFC 2440
26582 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
26583 published as an informational RFC@. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
26584 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26585 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26586 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26587 decryption).
26588
26589 @item PGP/MIME---RFC 2015/3156
26590 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
26591 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26592 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26593
26594 @item S/MIME---RFC 2633
26595 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26596
26597 @item IMAP---RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
26598 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26599 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26600 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26601 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26602 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26603 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26604 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26605
26606 @end table
26607
26608 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26609 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26610 know.
26611
26612
26613 @node Emacsen
26614 @subsection Emacsen
26615 @cindex Emacsen
26616 @cindex XEmacs
26617 @cindex Mule
26618 @cindex Emacs
26619
26620 This version of Gnus should work on:
26621
26622 @itemize @bullet
26623
26624 @item
26625 Emacs 23.1 and up.
26626
26627 @item
26628 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26629
26630 @end itemize
26631
26632 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26633 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26634 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
26635 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26636
26637 @c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26638 @c synced here!
26639
26640 @node Gnus Development
26641 @subsection Gnus Development
26642
26643 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
26644 discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
26645 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26646 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26647 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26648 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26649 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
26650 have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
26651
26652 After futzing around for 10--100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
26653 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
26654 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
26655 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
26656 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26657 mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26658 as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26659 in Emacs.
26660
26661 @cindex Incoming*
26662 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26663 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26664 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26665 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26666 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26667
26668 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26669 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26670 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26671 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26672 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26673 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26674 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26675 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26676 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26677 can't be assumed to do so.
26678
26679 So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26680 direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26681 is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
26682
26683 @cindex Incoming*
26684 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26685 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26686 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26687 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26688 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26689
26690 @node Contributors
26691 @subsection Contributors
26692 @cindex contributors
26693
26694 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
26695 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
26696 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
26697 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
26698 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
26699 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
26700 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
26701 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
26702 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
26703 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
26704
26705 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
26706 wrong show.
26707
26708 @itemize @bullet
26709
26710 @item
26711 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
26712
26713 @item
26714 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el,
26715 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
26716 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
26717 functionality and stuff.
26718
26719 @item
26720 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
26721 well as numerous other things).
26722
26723 @item
26724 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
26725
26726 @item
26727 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
26728
26729 @item
26730 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
26731
26732 @item
26733 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
26734
26735 @item
26736 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
26737 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
26738
26739 @item
26740 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
26741
26742 @item
26743 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
26744
26745 @item
26746 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
26747
26748 @item
26749 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
26750
26751 @item
26752 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bug detection and fixes.
26753
26754 @item
26755 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
26756
26757 @item
26758 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
26759 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
26760
26761 @item
26762 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
26763
26764 @item
26765 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
26766
26767 @item
26768 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
26769
26770 @item
26771 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
26772 .newsrc files.
26773
26774 @item
26775 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
26776
26777 @item
26778 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
26779
26780 @item
26781 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
26782
26783 @item
26784 Fran@,{c}ois Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
26785 well as autoconf support.
26786
26787 @end itemize
26788
26789 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
26790 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
26791
26792 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
26793
26794 Christopher Davis,
26795 Andrew Eskilsson,
26796 Kai Grossjohann,
26797 Kevin Greiner,
26798 Jesper Harder,
26799 Paul Jarc,
26800 Simon Josefsson,
26801 David K@aa{}gedal,
26802 Richard Pieri,
26803 Fabrice Popineau,
26804 Daniel Quinlan,
26805 Michael Shields,
26806 Reiner Steib,
26807 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
26808 Jack Vinson,
26809 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
26810 and
26811 Teodor Zlatanov.
26812
26813 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
26814
26815 Jari Aalto,
26816 Adrian Aichner,
26817 Vladimir Alexiev,
26818 Russ Allbery,
26819 Peter Arius,
26820 Matt Armstrong,
26821 Marc Auslander,
26822 Miles Bader,
26823 Alexei V. Barantsev,
26824 Frank Bennett,
26825 Robert Bihlmeyer,
26826 Chris Bone,
26827 Mark Borges,
26828 Mark Boyns,
26829 Lance A. Brown,
26830 Rob Browning,
26831 Kees de Bruin,
26832 Martin Buchholz,
26833 Joe Buehler,
26834 Kevin Buhr,
26835 Alastair Burt,
26836 Joao Cachopo,
26837 Zlatko Calusic,
26838 Massimo Campostrini,
26839 Castor,
26840 David Charlap,
26841 Dan Christensen,
26842 Kevin Christian,
26843 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
26844 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
26845 Laura Conrad,
26846 Michael R. Cook,
26847 Glenn Coombs,
26848 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
26849 Neil Crellin,
26850 Frank D. Cringle,
26851 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
26852 Andre Deparade,
26853 Ulrik Dickow,
26854 Dave Disser,
26855 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
26856 Joev Dubach,
26857 Michael Welsh Duggan,
26858 Dave Edmondson,
26859 Paul Eggert,
26860 Mark W. Eichin,
26861 Karl Eichwalder,
26862 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
26863 Michael Ernst,
26864 Luc Van Eycken,
26865 Sam Falkner,
26866 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
26867 Sigbjorn Finne,
26868 Sven Fischer,
26869 Paul Fisher,
26870 Decklin Foster,
26871 Gary D. Foster,
26872 Paul Franklin,
26873 Guy Geens,
26874 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
26875 David S. Goldberg,
26876 Michelangelo Grigni,
26877 Dale Hagglund,
26878 D. Hall,
26879 Magnus Hammerin,
26880 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
26881 Raja R. Harinath,
26882 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
26883 P. E. Jareth Hein,
26884 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
26885 Scott Hofmann,
26886 Tassilo Horn,
26887 Marc Horowitz,
26888 Gunnar Horrigmo,
26889 Richard Hoskins,
26890 Brad Howes,
26891 Miguel de Icaza,
26892 Fran@,{c}ois Felix Ingrand,
26893 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
26894 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
26895 Lee Iverson,
26896 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
26897 Rajappa Iyer,
26898 Andreas Jaeger,
26899 Adam P. Jenkins,
26900 Randell Jesup,
26901 Fred Johansen,
26902 Gareth Jones,
26903 Greg Klanderman,
26904 Karl Kleinpaste,
26905 Michael Klingbeil,
26906 Peter Skov Knudsen,
26907 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
26908 Petr Konecny,
26909 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
26910 Thor Kristoffersen,
26911 Jens Lautenbacher,
26912 Martin Larose,
26913 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
26914 Joerg Lenneis,
26915 Carsten Leonhardt,
26916 James LewisMoss,
26917 Christian Limpach,
26918 Markus Linnala,
26919 Dave Love,
26920 Mike McEwan,
26921 Tonny Madsen,
26922 Shlomo Mahlab,
26923 Nat Makarevitch,
26924 Istvan Marko,
26925 David Martin,
26926 Jason R. Mastaler,
26927 Gordon Matzigkeit,
26928 Timo Metzemakers,
26929 Richard Mlynarik,
26930 Lantz Moore,
26931 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
26932 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
26933 Hrvoje Niksic,
26934 Andy Norman,
26935 Fred Oberhauser,
26936 C. R. Oldham,
26937 Alexandre Oliva,
26938 Ken Olstad,
26939 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
26940 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
26941 Ettore Perazzoli,
26942 William Perry,
26943 Stephen Peters,
26944 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
26945 Ulrich Pfeifer,
26946 Matt Pharr,
26947 Andy Piper,
26948 John McClary Prevost,
26949 Bill Pringlemeir,
26950 Mike Pullen,
26951 Jim Radford,
26952 Colin Rafferty,
26953 Lasse Rasinen,
26954 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
26955 Joe Reiss,
26956 Renaud Rioboo,
26957 Roland B. Roberts,
26958 Bart Robinson,
26959 Christian von Roques,
26960 Markus Rost,
26961 Jason Rumney,
26962 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
26963 Jay Sachs,
26964 Dewey M. Sasser,
26965 Conrad Sauerwald,
26966 Loren Schall,
26967 Dan Schmidt,
26968 Ralph Schleicher,
26969 Philippe Schnoebelen,
26970 Andreas Schwab,
26971 Randal L. Schwartz,
26972 Danny Siu,
26973 Matt Simmons,
26974 Paul D. Smith,
26975 Jeff Sparkes,
26976 Toby Speight,
26977 Michael Sperber,
26978 Darren Stalder,
26979 Richard Stallman,
26980 Greg Stark,
26981 Sam Steingold,
26982 Paul Stevenson,
26983 Jonas Steverud,
26984 Paul Stodghill,
26985 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
26986 Kurt Swanson,
26987 Samuel Tardieu,
26988 Teddy,
26989 Chuck Thompson,
26990 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
26991 Philippe Troin,
26992 James Troup,
26993 Trung Tran-Duc,
26994 Jack Twilley,
26995 Aaron M. Ucko,
26996 Aki Vehtari,
26997 Didier Verna,
26998 Vladimir Volovich,
26999 Jan Vroonhof,
27000 Stefan Waldherr,
27001 Pete Ware,
27002 Barry A. Warsaw,
27003 Christoph Wedler,
27004 Joe Wells,
27005 Lee Willis,
27006 and
27007 Lloyd Zusman.
27008
27009
27010 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
27011 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
27012 (550kB and counting).
27013
27014 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
27015 sure.
27016
27017 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
27018 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
27019
27020
27021 @node New Features
27022 @subsection New Features
27023 @cindex new features
27024
27025 @menu
27026 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
27027 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
27028 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
27029 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
27030 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
27031 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
27032 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13.
27033 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
27034 @end menu
27035
27036 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
27037 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
27038 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
27039
27040 @node ding Gnus
27041 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
27042
27043 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
27044
27045 @itemize @bullet
27046
27047 @item
27048 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
27049 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
27050
27051 @item
27052 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
27053 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
27054
27055 @item
27056 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
27057
27058 @item
27059 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
27060 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
27061 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
27062
27063 @item
27064 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
27065 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
27066 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
27067 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27068
27069 @item
27070 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
27071 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27072
27073 @item
27074 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
27075 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
27076 (@pxref{The Active File}).
27077
27078 @item
27079 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
27080 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
27081
27082 @item
27083 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
27084 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
27085 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27086
27087 @item
27088 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
27089 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
27090 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
27091
27092 @item
27093 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
27094 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
27095
27096 @item
27097 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27098 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27099
27100 @item
27101 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27102 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27103
27104 @item
27105 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27106 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27107
27108 @item
27109 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27110 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27111
27112 @item
27113 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27114
27115 @item
27116 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27117 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27118
27119 @item
27120 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27121 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27122
27123 @item
27124 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27125 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27126
27127 @item
27128 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27129
27130 @item
27131 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27132 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27133
27134 @item
27135 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27136 Articles}).
27137
27138 @item
27139 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27140 Buttons}).
27141
27142 @item
27143 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27144 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27145
27146 @end itemize
27147
27148
27149 @node September Gnus
27150 @subsubsection September Gnus
27151
27152 @iftex
27153 @iflatex
27154 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27155 @end iflatex
27156 @end iftex
27157
27158 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27159
27160 @itemize @bullet
27161
27162 @item
27163 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27164 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27165 now obsolete.
27166
27167 @item
27168 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27169 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27170 Threading}).
27171
27172 @lisp
27173 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27174 @end lisp
27175
27176 @item
27177 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27178 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27179
27180 @item
27181 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27182 referred.
27183
27184 @item
27185 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
27186
27187 @item
27188 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27189
27190 @item
27191 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27192
27193 @lisp
27194 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
27195 @end lisp
27196
27197 @item
27198 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27199 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27200
27201 @lisp
27202 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27203 @end lisp
27204
27205 @item
27206 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27207 Groups}).
27208
27209 @item
27210 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27211 Topics}).
27212
27213 @lisp
27214 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27215 @end lisp
27216
27217 @item
27218 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27219
27220 @item
27221 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27222 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27223
27224 @lisp
27225 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27226 @end lisp
27227
27228 @item
27229 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27230 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27231
27232 @item
27233 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27234
27235 @item
27236 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27237 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27238 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27239
27240 @item
27241 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets.
27242
27243 @item
27244 The Gnus cache is much faster.
27245
27246 @item
27247 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27248 Groups}).
27249
27250 @item
27251 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27252 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27253
27254 @item
27255 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27256 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27257
27258 @item
27259 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27260 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27261
27262 @item
27263 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27264 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27265 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27266
27267 @item
27268 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27269 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27270
27271 @item
27272 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27273
27274 @item
27275 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27276
27277 @item
27278 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27279
27280 @item
27281 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27282
27283 @item
27284 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27285 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27286
27287 @item
27288 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27289 Layout}).
27290
27291 @item
27292 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27293 @iftex
27294 @iflatex
27295 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27296 @end iflatex
27297 @end iftex
27298
27299 @item
27300 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27301
27302 @lisp
27303 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27304 @end lisp
27305
27306 @item
27307 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27308
27309 @item
27310 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27311
27312 @item
27313 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27314 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27315
27316 @lisp
27317 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27318 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27319 @end lisp
27320
27321 @item
27322 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27323 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27324
27325 @lisp
27326 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27327 @end lisp
27328
27329 @item
27330 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27331 buffer to allow easier treatment.
27332
27333 @item
27334 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27335
27336 @item
27337 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27338 Articles}).
27339
27340 @lisp
27341 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27342 @end lisp
27343
27344 @item
27345 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27346 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27347
27348 @lisp
27349 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27350 @end lisp
27351
27352 @item
27353 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27354 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27355
27356 @item
27357 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27358 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27359
27360 @lisp
27361 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27362 @end lisp
27363
27364 @item
27365 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27366
27367 @item
27368 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27369
27370 @item
27371 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27372
27373 @end itemize
27374
27375
27376 @node Red Gnus
27377 @subsubsection Red Gnus
27378
27379 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27380
27381 @iftex
27382 @iflatex
27383 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27384 @end iflatex
27385 @end iftex
27386
27387 @itemize @bullet
27388
27389 @item
27390 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27391
27392 @item
27393 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27394 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27395
27396 @item
27397 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27398 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27399 Scoring}).
27400
27401 @item
27402 Article washing status can be displayed in the
27403 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27404
27405 @item
27406 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27407
27408 @item
27409 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27410 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27411
27412 @lisp
27413 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27414 @end lisp
27415
27416 @item
27417 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27418 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27419 been added.
27420
27421 @item
27422 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
27423 Server Internals}).
27424
27425 @item
27426 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27427 Parameters}).
27428
27429 @item
27430 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27431
27432 @item
27433 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27434 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
27435
27436 @item
27437 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27438 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27439 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27440
27441 @item
27442 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27443 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27444
27445 @item
27446 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27447 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27448
27449 @item
27450 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27451 (@pxref{Undo}).
27452
27453 @item
27454 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27455 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27456
27457 @item
27458 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27459 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27460
27461 @lisp
27462 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27463 @end lisp
27464
27465 @item
27466 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27467
27468 @lisp
27469 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27470 @end lisp
27471
27472 @item
27473 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27474 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27475
27476 @item
27477 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27478 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27479
27480 @item
27481 A new command for reading collections of documents
27482 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27483 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27484
27485 @item
27486 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27487 Marks}).
27488
27489 @item
27490 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27491 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27492
27493 @item
27494 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27495 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27496 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
27497
27498 @item
27499 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27500 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27501 Sorting}).
27502
27503 @item
27504 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27505 Groups}).
27506
27507 @item
27508 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27509 Commands}).
27510 @iftex
27511 @iflatex
27512 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27513 @end iflatex
27514 @end iftex
27515
27516 @item
27517 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27518 Variables}).
27519
27520 @item
27521 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27522 Mail}).
27523
27524 @item
27525 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27526 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27527
27528 @item
27529 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27530
27531 @end itemize
27532
27533
27534 @node Quassia Gnus
27535 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27536
27537 New features in Gnus 5.6:
27538
27539 @itemize @bullet
27540
27541 @item
27542 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27543 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27544 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27545
27546 @item
27547 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27548 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27549 group, which is created automatically.
27550
27551 @item
27552 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27553 values.
27554
27555 @item
27556 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-IDs.
27557
27558 @item
27559 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27560 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27561
27562 @item
27563 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27564 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27565
27566 @item
27567 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27568
27569 @item
27570 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27571 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27572
27573 @item
27574 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27575
27576 @item
27577 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27578 details.
27579
27580 @item
27581 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27582 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27583
27584 @item
27585 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27586 control over simplification.
27587
27588 @item
27589 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27590
27591 @item
27592 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27593 limit.
27594
27595 @item
27596 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27597
27598 @item
27599 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27600
27601 @item
27602 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27603 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27604 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27605
27606 @item
27607 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27608 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27609
27610 @item
27611 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27612 text---@kbd{W d}.
27613
27614 @item
27615 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27616 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27617
27618 @item
27619 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27620 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27621
27622 @item
27623 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27624 has been added.
27625
27626 @item
27627 A history of where mails have been split is available.
27628
27629 @item
27630 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27631
27632 @item
27633 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27634 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27635
27636 @item
27637 A new function for citing in Message has been
27638 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27639
27640 @item
27641 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27642
27643 @item
27644 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27645 been added.
27646
27647 @item
27648 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27649 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27650
27651 @item
27652 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27653 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27654
27655 @item
27656 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27657
27658 @item
27659 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27660
27661 @end itemize
27662
27663 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
27664 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27665
27666 New features in Gnus 5.8:
27667
27668 @itemize @bullet
27669
27670 @item
27671 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
27672 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
27673
27674 If you used procmail like in
27675
27676 @lisp
27677 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
27678 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
27679 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
27680 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
27681 @end lisp
27682
27683 this now has changed to
27684
27685 @lisp
27686 (setq mail-sources
27687 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
27688 :suffix ".in")))
27689 @end lisp
27690
27691 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
27692
27693 @item
27694 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
27695 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
27696
27697 @item
27698 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
27699 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
27700
27701 @item
27702 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
27703 called to position point.
27704
27705 @item
27706 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
27707 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
27708
27709 @item
27710 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
27711 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
27712
27713 @item
27714 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
27715 subtly different manner.
27716
27717 @item
27718 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
27719 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
27720 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
27721
27722 @item
27723 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
27724
27725 @end itemize
27726
27727 @node Oort Gnus
27728 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
27729 @cindex Oort Gnus
27730
27731 New features in Gnus 5.10:
27732
27733 @itemize @bullet
27734
27735 @item Installation changes
27736 @c ***********************
27737
27738 @itemize @bullet
27739 @item
27740 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
27741
27742 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
27743 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
27744 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
27745 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
27746 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
27747 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
27748 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
27749 isn't save in general.
27750
27751 @item
27752 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
27753 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
27754 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
27755 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
27756 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
27757 remove-installed-shadows}.
27758
27759 @item
27760 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
27761
27762 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
27763 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
27764 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
27765 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
27766 the second parameter.
27767
27768 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
27769 automatic recognition of XEmacs and Emacs, generates
27770 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
27771 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
27772 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
27773 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
27774 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
27775 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
27776 cycle used under Unix systems.
27777
27778 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
27779 superfluous, so they have been removed.
27780
27781 @item
27782 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
27783
27784 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
27785 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
27786 hierarchy.
27787
27788 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
27789 @c the repository. We should find a better place for this item.
27790 @item
27791 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
27792
27793 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
27794 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
27795 lisp directory into load-path.
27796
27797 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
27798 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
27799
27800 @end itemize
27801
27802 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
27803 @c *****************************************
27804
27805 @itemize @bullet
27806
27807 @item
27808 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
27809 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
27810
27811 @item
27812 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
27813
27814 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
27815 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GnuTLS.
27816
27817 @item
27818 Improved anti-spam features.
27819
27820 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
27821 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
27822 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
27823 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
27824 are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
27825 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
27826
27827 @item
27828 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
27829
27830 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
27831 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
27832 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
27833 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
27834 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
27835
27836 @end itemize
27837
27838 @item Changes in group mode
27839 @c ************************
27840
27841 @itemize @bullet
27842
27843 @item
27844 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
27845 using @kbd{G M}.
27846
27847 @item
27848 Retrieval of charters and control messages
27849
27850 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
27851 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
27852
27853 @item
27854 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
27855
27856 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
27857 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
27858 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
27859 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
27860 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
27861 parameters, a'la:
27862 @lisp
27863 (setq gnus-parameters
27864 '(("mail\\..*"
27865 (gnus-show-threads nil)
27866 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
27867 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
27868 (to-group . "\\1"))))
27869 @end lisp
27870
27871 @item
27872 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
27873
27874 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
27875 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
27876 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
27877 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
27878 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
27879 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
27880 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
27881 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
27882 when getting new mail, remove the function.
27883
27884 @item
27885 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
27886
27887 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
27888 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
27889 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
27890
27891 @item
27892 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
27893 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
27894
27895 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
27896 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
27897 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
27898 @lisp
27899 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
27900 @end lisp
27901
27902 @item
27903 Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
27904 after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
27905 Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
27906
27907 @end itemize
27908
27909 @item Changes in summary and article mode
27910 @c **************************************
27911
27912 @itemize @bullet
27913
27914 @item
27915 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
27916 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
27917 region if the region is active.
27918
27919 @item
27920 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
27921 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
27922
27923 @item
27924 Article Buttons
27925
27926 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
27927 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
27928 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
27929 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
27930
27931 @item
27932 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
27933
27934 @item
27935 Picons
27936
27937 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
27938 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
27939
27940 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
27941 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
27942 @xref{Picons}.
27943
27944 @item
27945 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
27946 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
27947
27948 @item
27949 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
27950
27951 @item
27952 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
27953 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
27954
27955 @item
27956 Warn about email replies to news
27957
27958 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
27959 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
27960 you.
27961
27962 @item
27963 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
27964 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
27965 built.
27966
27967 @item
27968 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
27969 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
27970
27971 @item
27972 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
27973 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
27974
27975 @item
27976 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
27977 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
27978
27979 @item
27980 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
27981
27982 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
27983 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
27984 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
27985 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
27986 citations.
27987
27988 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
27989 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
27990 Outlook (Express) articles.
27991
27992 @item
27993 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
27994
27995 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
27996 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
27997 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
27998 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
27999
28000 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
28001 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
28002 message cited below.
28003
28004 @item
28005 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc.)@: are now displayed graphically in
28006 Emacs too.
28007
28008 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
28009 disable it.
28010
28011 @item
28012 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
28013
28014 @item
28015 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
28016 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
28017
28018 @item
28019 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
28020
28021 @item
28022 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
28023
28024 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
28025 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
28026 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
28027 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
28028 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
28029 groups.
28030
28031 @item
28032 Deleting of attachments.
28033
28034 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
28035 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
28036 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
28037 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
28038 that support editing.
28039
28040 @item
28041 @code{gnus-default-charset}
28042
28043 The default value is determined from the
28044 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
28045 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
28046 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
28047
28048 @item
28049 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
28050
28051 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
28052 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
28053 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
28054
28055 @item
28056 Extended format specs.
28057
28058 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
28059 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
28060 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
28061 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
28062 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
28063 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
28064
28065 @item
28066 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
28067 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
28068
28069 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
28070 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
28071 out other articles.
28072
28073 @item
28074 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
28075
28076 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
28077 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
28078 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
28079 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
28080
28081 @item
28082 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
28083
28084 @end itemize
28085
28086 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28087 @c ****************************************************
28088
28089 @itemize @bullet
28090
28091 @item
28092 Delayed articles
28093
28094 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
28095 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
28096 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
28097
28098 @item
28099 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28100 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28101
28102 @item
28103 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28104 Gcc articles as read.
28105
28106 @item
28107 Externalizing of attachments
28108
28109 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28110 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28111 local files as external parts.
28112
28113 @item
28114 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28115 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28116
28117 @item
28118 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28119
28120 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28121 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28122 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28123 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28124 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28125 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28126 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28127 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28128 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28129
28130 @item
28131 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28132
28133 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28134 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28135 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28136 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28137 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28138 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28139
28140 @item
28141 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28142 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28143 @code{nil}.
28144
28145 @item
28146 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28147
28148 @item
28149 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28150
28151 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28152 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28153 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28154 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28155 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28156 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28157 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28158 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28159 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28160 was inserted directly.
28161
28162 @item
28163 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28164
28165 @c FIXME should that not be 'message-user-agent?
28166 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28167 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28168 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28169 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28170
28171 @item
28172 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28173
28174 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28175 @lisp
28176 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28177 'bbdb-complete-name)
28178 @end lisp
28179
28180 @item
28181 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
28182
28183 Add a new format of match like
28184 @lisp
28185 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28186 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28187 @end lisp
28188 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28189 @lisp
28190 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
28191 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28192 @end lisp
28193
28194 @item
28195 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28196
28197 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28198 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28199 need add those two headers too.
28200
28201 @item
28202 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28203 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28204 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28205 versions.
28206
28207 @item
28208 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28209 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28210 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28211 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28212 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28213
28214 @item
28215 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28216
28217 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28218
28219 @item
28220 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28221
28222 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28223 the valid values.
28224
28225 @item
28226 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28227
28228 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28229 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28230 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28231 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28232 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28233 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28234 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28235 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28236
28237 @item
28238 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
28239 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630--2633).
28240
28241 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28242 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28243 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28244 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28245
28246 @item
28247 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28248 C-m}.
28249
28250 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28251 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28252
28253 @item
28254 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28255 @code{best}.
28256
28257 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28258 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28259 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28260 invalidate the digital signature.
28261
28262 @item
28263 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28264 decompressed when activated.
28265 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28266
28267 @item
28268 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28269
28270 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28271 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28272 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28273 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28274 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28275 controls this.
28276
28277 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28278 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28279 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
28280 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.1)
28281
28282 @item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28283 See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28284 Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28285 @c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
28286
28287 @end itemize
28288
28289 @item Changes in back ends
28290 @c ***********************
28291
28292 @itemize @bullet
28293 @item
28294 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28295
28296 @item
28297 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28298
28299 @item
28300 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28301
28302 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28303
28304 @item
28305 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28306
28307 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28308 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28309 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
28310 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within, e.g., a department. It
28311 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28312 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28313 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28314 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28315 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28316 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28317 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28318
28319 @end itemize
28320
28321 @item Appearance
28322 @c *************
28323
28324 @itemize @bullet
28325
28326 @item
28327 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28328 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28329
28330 @item
28331 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28332 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28333 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28334 message, Message Manual}).
28335
28336 @item
28337 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
28338 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28339 customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28340 feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
28341
28342 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28343 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28344 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28345 in Gnus 5.10.9.
28346 @end itemize
28347
28348
28349 @item Miscellaneous changes
28350 @c ************************
28351
28352 @itemize @bullet
28353
28354 @item
28355 @code{gnus-agent}
28356
28357 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28358 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28359 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28360 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28361 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28362 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28363 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28364 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28365 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28366 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28367 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28368 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28369 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28370 is not needed any more.
28371
28372 @item
28373 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28374
28375 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28376 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28377 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28378
28379 @item
28380 Dired integration
28381
28382 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28383 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28384 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28385 entry.
28386
28387 @item
28388 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28389
28390 @item
28391 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28392
28393 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28394
28395 @end itemize
28396
28397 @end itemize
28398
28399 @node No Gnus
28400 @subsubsection No Gnus
28401 @cindex No Gnus
28402
28403 New features in No Gnus:
28404 @c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28405
28406 @include gnus-news.texi
28407
28408 @node Ma Gnus
28409 @subsubsection Ma Gnus
28410 @cindex Ma Gnus
28411
28412 I'm sure there will be lots of text here. It's really spelled 真
28413 Gnus.
28414
28415 New features in Ma Gnus:
28416
28417 @itemize @bullet
28418
28419 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28420 @c ****************************************************
28421
28422 @itemize @bullet
28423
28424 @item
28425 The new hooks @code{gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook} and
28426 @code{gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook} are run before/after encoding
28427 the message body of the Gcc copy of a sent message. See
28428 @xref{Archived Messages}.
28429
28430 @end itemize
28431
28432 @end itemize
28433
28434 @iftex
28435
28436 @page
28437 @node The Manual
28438 @section The Manual
28439 @cindex colophon
28440 @cindex manual
28441
28442 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28443 either @code{texi2dvi}
28444 @iflatex
28445 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28446 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28447 @end iflatex
28448 to get what you hold in your hands now.
28449
28450 The following conventions have been used:
28451
28452 @enumerate
28453
28454 @item
28455 This is a @samp{string}
28456
28457 @item
28458 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28459
28460 @item
28461 This is a @file{file}
28462
28463 @item
28464 This is a @code{symbol}
28465
28466 @end enumerate
28467
28468 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28469 mean:
28470
28471 @lisp
28472 (setq flargnoze "yes")
28473 @end lisp
28474
28475 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28476
28477 @lisp
28478 (setq flumphel 'yes)
28479 @end lisp
28480
28481 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28482 ever get them confused.
28483
28484 @iflatex
28485 @c @head
28486 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28487 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28488 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28489 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28490 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28491 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28492 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28493 @end iflatex
28494
28495 @end iftex
28496
28497
28498 @node On Writing Manuals
28499 @section On Writing Manuals
28500
28501 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28502 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28503 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28504 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28505 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
28506 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28507 in hand.
28508
28509 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28510 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28511 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28512 started with Gnus.
28513
28514 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
28515 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
28516
28517
28518 @page
28519 @node Terminology
28520 @section Terminology
28521
28522 @cindex terminology
28523 @table @dfn
28524
28525 @item news
28526 @cindex news
28527 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28528 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28529 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28530 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28531 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28532
28533 @item mail
28534 @cindex mail
28535 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28536 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28537 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28538 not posting, and replying is not following up.
28539
28540 @item reply
28541 @cindex reply
28542 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28543
28544 @item follow up
28545 @cindex follow up
28546 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28547 are reading.
28548
28549 @item back end
28550 @cindex back end
28551 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28552 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28553 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28554 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28555 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28556 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28557 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28558 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28559 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28560 number 4711''.
28561
28562 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28563 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28564 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28565 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28566 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28567 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28568
28569 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28570 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28571 access the articles.
28572
28573 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28574 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28575 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28576 confusing.
28577
28578 @item native
28579 @cindex native
28580 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
28581 default, way of getting news. Groups from the native select method
28582 have names like @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}.
28583
28584 @item foreign
28585 @cindex foreign
28586 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same
28587 time. These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends
28588 for getting news. Foreign groups have names like
28589 @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28590
28591 @item secondary
28592 @cindex secondary
28593 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and
28594 being foreign, but they mostly act like they are native, but they, too
28595 have names like @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28596
28597 @item article
28598 @cindex article
28599 A message that has been posted as news.
28600
28601 @item mail message
28602 @cindex mail message
28603 A message that has been mailed.
28604
28605 @item message
28606 @cindex message
28607 A mail message or news article
28608
28609 @item head
28610 @cindex head
28611 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.)@: is
28612 put.
28613
28614 @item body
28615 @cindex body
28616 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28617 body.
28618
28619 @item header
28620 @cindex header
28621 A line from the head of an article.
28622
28623 @item headers
28624 @cindex headers
28625 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28626 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28627
28628 @item @acronym{NOV}
28629 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
28630 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28631 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28632 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28633 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28634 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28635
28636 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28637 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28638 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28639 normal @sc{head} format.
28640
28641 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28642 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28643 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28644 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28645 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28646 references, etc.
28647
28648 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28649 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28650 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28651 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28652 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28653 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28654 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28655
28656 @item level
28657 @cindex levels
28658 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1--9). The ones
28659 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
28660 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1--5 are considered
28661 @dfn{subscribed}; 6--7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
28662 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28663 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28664
28665 @item killed groups
28666 @cindex killed groups
28667 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28668 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28669
28670 @item zombie groups
28671 @cindex zombie groups
28672 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28673
28674 @item active file
28675 @cindex active file
28676 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28677 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28678 is rather large, as you might surmise.
28679
28680 @item bogus groups
28681 @cindex bogus groups
28682 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28683 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28684 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28685
28686 @item activating
28687 @cindex activating groups
28688 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28689 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28690 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28691
28692 @item spool
28693 @cindex spool
28694 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28695 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
28696 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
28697
28698 @item server
28699 @cindex server
28700 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
28701
28702 @item select method
28703 @cindex select method
28704 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
28705 server settings.
28706
28707 @item virtual server
28708 @cindex virtual server
28709 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
28710 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
28711 whole is a virtual server.
28712
28713 @item washing
28714 @cindex washing
28715 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
28716 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
28717 original.
28718
28719 @item ephemeral groups
28720 @cindex ephemeral groups
28721 @cindex temporary groups
28722 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
28723 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
28724 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
28725
28726 @item solid groups
28727 @cindex solid groups
28728 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
28729 group buffer are solid groups.
28730
28731 @item sparse articles
28732 @cindex sparse articles
28733 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
28734 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
28735
28736 @item threading
28737 @cindex threading
28738 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
28739 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
28740
28741 @item root
28742 @cindex root
28743 @cindex thread root
28744 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
28745 articles in the thread.
28746
28747 @item parent
28748 @cindex parent
28749 An article that has responses.
28750
28751 @item child
28752 @cindex child
28753 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
28754
28755 @item digest
28756 @cindex digest
28757 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
28758 specified by RFC 1153.
28759
28760 @item splitting
28761 @cindex splitting, terminology
28762 @cindex mail sorting
28763 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
28764 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
28765 incorrectly called mail filtering.
28766
28767 @end table
28768
28769
28770 @page
28771 @node Customization
28772 @section Customization
28773 @cindex general customization
28774
28775 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
28776 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
28777 for some quite common situations.
28778
28779 @menu
28780 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
28781 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
28782 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
28783 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
28784 @end menu
28785
28786
28787 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
28788 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
28789
28790 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
28791 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
28792 Gnus has to get from the server.
28793
28794 @table @code
28795
28796 @item gnus-read-active-file
28797 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
28798 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
28799 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28800 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
28801 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
28802
28803 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
28804 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
28805 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
28806 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
28807 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
28808 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
28809 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
28810 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
28811 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
28812 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
28813 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
28814
28815 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
28816 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
28817 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
28818 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, and @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}. Note that a
28819 non-@code{nil} value for @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those
28820 variables.
28821 @end table
28822
28823
28824 @node Slow Terminal Connection
28825 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
28826
28827 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
28828 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
28829 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
28830
28831 @table @code
28832
28833 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
28834 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
28835 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
28836 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
28837 horizontal and vertical recentering.
28838
28839 @item gnus-visible-headers
28840 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
28841 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
28842 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
28843 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
28844
28845 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
28846 @lisp
28847 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
28848 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
28849 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
28850 @end lisp
28851
28852 @item gnus-use-full-window
28853 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
28854 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
28855 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
28856 want to read them anyway.
28857
28858 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
28859 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
28860 hidden initially.
28861
28862
28863 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
28864 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
28865 lines, which might save some time.
28866 @end table
28867
28868
28869 @node Little Disk Space
28870 @subsection Little Disk Space
28871 @cindex disk space
28872
28873 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
28874 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
28875
28876 @table @code
28877
28878 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
28879 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
28880 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28881 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28882 default.
28883
28884 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
28885 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
28886 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28887 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28888 default.
28889
28890 @item gnus-save-killed-list
28891 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
28892 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
28893 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
28894 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
28895
28896 @end table
28897
28898
28899 @node Slow Machine
28900 @subsection Slow Machine
28901 @cindex slow machine
28902
28903 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
28904 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
28905
28906 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28907 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
28908
28909 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
28910 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
28911 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
28912
28913
28914 @page
28915 @node Troubleshooting
28916 @section Troubleshooting
28917 @cindex troubleshooting
28918
28919 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
28920 problems, really.
28921
28922 Ahem.
28923
28924 @enumerate
28925
28926 @item
28927 Make sure your computer is switched on.
28928
28929 @item
28930 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
28931 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
28932 Gnus will work.
28933
28934 @item
28935 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
28936 like @c
28937 @samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
28938 @c
28939 you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
28940 files lying around. Delete these.
28941
28942 @item
28943 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
28944 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
28945
28946 @item
28947 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
28948 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
28949 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
28950 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
28951 something like that.
28952 @end enumerate
28953
28954 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
28955
28956 @cindex bugs
28957 @cindex reporting bugs
28958
28959 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
28960 @findex gnus-bug
28961 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
28962 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
28963 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
28964 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
28965
28966 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
28967 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
28968 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
28969 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
28970 time.
28971
28972 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
28973 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
28974 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
28975 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
28976 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
28977 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
28978
28979 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
28980 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
28981 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
28982 the bug report.
28983
28984 @cindex patches
28985 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
28986 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
28987
28988 @cindex edebug
28989 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
28990 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
28991 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
28992 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
28993 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
28994 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
28995 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
28996 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
28997 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
28998 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
28999 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
29000 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
29001 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
29002 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
29003
29004 @cindex elp
29005 @cindex profile
29006 @cindex slow
29007 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
29008 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
29009 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
29010 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
29011 helps isolating the real problem areas).
29012
29013 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP@. The profiler is
29014 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
29015 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
29016 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g., @kbd{M-x
29017 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
29018 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
29019 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
29020 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
29021 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
29022 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
29023 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
29024 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
29025 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
29026 work perfectly.
29027
29028 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
29029 @cindex ding mailing list
29030 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
29031 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
29032 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
29033 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
29034
29035
29036 @page
29037 @node Gnus Reference Guide
29038 @section Gnus Reference Guide
29039
29040 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
29041 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
29042 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
29043 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
29044 it.
29045
29046 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
29047 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
29048 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
29049 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
29050 and general methods of operation.
29051
29052 @menu
29053 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
29054 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
29055 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
29056 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
29057 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
29058 * Group Info:: The group info format.
29059 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
29060 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
29061 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
29062 @end menu
29063
29064
29065 @node Gnus Utility Functions
29066 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
29067 @cindex Gnus utility functions
29068 @cindex utility functions
29069 @cindex functions
29070 @cindex internal variables
29071
29072 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
29073 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
29074 Below is a list of the most common ones.
29075
29076 @table @code
29077
29078 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
29079 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
29080 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
29081
29082 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
29083 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
29084 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
29085
29086 @item gnus-group-real-name
29087 @findex gnus-group-real-name
29088 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
29089 name.
29090
29091 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
29092 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
29093 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
29094 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
29095
29096 @item gnus-get-info
29097 @findex gnus-get-info
29098 Returns the group info list for @var{group} (@pxref{Group Info}).
29099
29100 @item gnus-group-unread
29101 @findex gnus-group-unread
29102 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29103 unknown.
29104
29105 @item gnus-active
29106 @findex gnus-active
29107 The active entry (i.e., a cons cell containing the lowest and highest
29108 article numbers) for @var{group}.
29109
29110 @item gnus-set-active
29111 @findex gnus-set-active
29112 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29113
29114 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29115 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29116 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29117 exit.
29118
29119 @item gnus-continuum-version
29120 @findex gnus-continuum-version
29121 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29122 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29123 versions.
29124
29125 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
29126 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29127 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29128
29129 @item gnus-news-group-p
29130 @findex gnus-news-group-p
29131 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29132
29133 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29134 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29135 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29136
29137 @item gnus-server-to-method
29138 @findex gnus-server-to-method
29139 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29140
29141 @item gnus-server-equal
29142 @findex gnus-server-equal
29143 Says whether two virtual servers are essentially equal. For instance,
29144 two virtual servers may have server parameters in different order, but
29145 this function will consider them equal.
29146
29147 @item gnus-group-native-p
29148 @findex gnus-group-native-p
29149 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29150
29151 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
29152 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29153 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29154
29155 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
29156 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29157 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29158
29159 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
29160 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
29161 Returns the parameter list of @var{group} (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
29162 If given a second parameter, returns the value of that parameter for
29163 @var{group}.
29164
29165 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
29166 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29167 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29168
29169 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
29170 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29171 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29172
29173 @item gnus-check-backend-function
29174 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
29175 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29176 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29177
29178 @lisp
29179 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29180 @result{} t
29181 @end lisp
29182
29183 @item gnus-read-method
29184 @findex gnus-read-method
29185 Prompts the user for a select method.
29186
29187 @end table
29188
29189
29190 @node Back End Interface
29191 @subsection Back End Interface
29192
29193 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29194 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29195 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29196 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29197 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29198 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
29199
29200 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29201 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29202 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29203 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29204 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29205 been opened, the function should fail.
29206
29207 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29208 name. Take this example:
29209
29210 @lisp
29211 (nntp "odd-one"
29212 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29213 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29214 @end lisp
29215
29216 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29217 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29218
29219 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29220 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29221 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29222
29223 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29224 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29225 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29226
29227 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29228 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29229 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29230 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29231 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29232 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29233 return value.
29234
29235 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29236 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
29237 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server'';
29238 they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
29239 more.
29240
29241 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29242 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29243 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29244 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29245 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29246 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29247 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29248 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29249 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29250 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29251
29252 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29253 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29254 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29255 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29256 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29257 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29258 of numbers as long as possible.
29259
29260 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29261 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29262 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29263
29264 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29265 @code{nnchoke}.
29266
29267 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
29268
29269 @menu
29270 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29271 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29272 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29273 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29274 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29275 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29276 @end menu
29277
29278
29279 @node Required Back End Functions
29280 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29281
29282 @table @code
29283
29284 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29285
29286 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29287 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29288 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29289 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29290
29291 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29292 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29293 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29294 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29295
29296 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29297 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29298 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29299 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29300 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29301 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29302 number, do maximum fetches.
29303
29304 Here's an example HEAD:
29305
29306 @example
29307 221 1056 Article retrieved.
29308 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29309 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29310 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29311 Subject: Re: Something very droll
29312 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29313 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29314 Lines: 26
29315 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29316 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29317 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29318 .
29319 @end example
29320
29321 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29322 these in the data buffer.
29323
29324 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29325
29326 @example
29327 headers = *head
29328 head = error / valid-head
29329 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29330 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29331 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29332 header = <text> eol
29333 @end example
29334
29335 @cindex BNF
29336 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29337
29338 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29339 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29340 separated by tabs.
29341
29342 @example
29343 nov-buffer = *nov-line
29344 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29345 field = <text except TAB>
29346 @end example
29347
29348 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29349 @pxref{Headers}.
29350
29351
29352 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29353
29354 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29355 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29356
29357 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29358 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29359 server. In fact, it should do so.
29360
29361 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29362 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29363
29364
29365 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29366
29367 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29368 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29369 reason.
29370
29371 There should be no data returned.
29372
29373
29374 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
29375
29376 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29377 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29378 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29379 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29380
29381 There should be no data returned.
29382
29383
29384 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29385
29386 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29387 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29388 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29389 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29390
29391 There should be no data returned.
29392
29393
29394 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29395
29396 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29397
29398 There should be no data returned.
29399
29400
29401 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29402
29403 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29404 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29405 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29406 it would be nice if that were possible.
29407
29408 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29409 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29410 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29411 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29412 into its article buffer.
29413
29414 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29415 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29416 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29417 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29418 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29419 on successful article retrieval.
29420
29421
29422 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST INFO)
29423
29424 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29425 making @var{group} the current group.
29426
29427 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29428 the current group.
29429
29430 If @var{info}, it allows the backend to update the group info
29431 structure.
29432
29433 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29434
29435 @example
29436 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29437 @end example
29438
29439 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29440 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29441 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29442 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29443 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29444 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29445 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29446 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29447 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29448 highest as 0.
29449
29450 @example
29451 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29452 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29453 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29454 @end example
29455
29456
29457 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29458
29459 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29460 a no-op on most back ends.
29461
29462 There should be no data returned.
29463
29464
29465 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29466
29467 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29468 @emph{all}.
29469
29470 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29471
29472 @example
29473 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29474 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29475 @end example
29476
29477 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29478 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29479 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29480 and the highest as 0.
29481
29482 @example
29483 active-file = *active-line
29484 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29485 name = <string>
29486 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29487 @end example
29488
29489 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29490 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29491 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29492
29493
29494 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29495
29496 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29497 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29498 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29499 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29500 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29501 clear if the posting could not be completed.
29502
29503 There should be no result data from this function.
29504
29505 @end table
29506
29507
29508 @node Optional Back End Functions
29509 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29510
29511 @table @code
29512
29513 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29514
29515 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29516 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29517 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29518
29519 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29520 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29521 former is in the same format as the data from
29522 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29523 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29524
29525 @example
29526 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29527 @end example
29528
29529
29530 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29531
29532 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29533 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29534 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29535 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
29536 should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29537 @code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29538 the network resources).
29539
29540 There should be no result data from this function.
29541
29542
29543 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29544
29545 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29546 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29547 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29548 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29549 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29550 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29551 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29552 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29553
29554 There should be no result data from this function.
29555
29556
29557 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29558
29559 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
29560 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc.)@: internally, and store them in
29561 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29562 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29563 propagate the mark information to the server.
29564
29565 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29566
29567 @example
29568 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
29569 @end example
29570
29571 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29572 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29573 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29574 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29575 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
29576 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend}, and
29577 @code{forward}, but your back end should, if possible, not limit
29578 itself to these.
29579
29580 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29581 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29582 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29583 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29584
29585 An example action list:
29586
29587 @example
29588 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29589 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29590 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29591 @end example
29592
29593 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29594 mark on (currently not used for anything).
29595
29596 There should be no result data from this function.
29597
29598 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29599
29600 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29601 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29602 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29603 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29604 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29605
29606 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29607 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29608 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29609 expirable.
29610
29611 There should be no result data from this function.
29612
29613
29614 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29615
29616 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29617 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29618 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29619 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29620 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29621 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29622 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29623 local if that's practical.
29624
29625 There should be no result data from this function.
29626
29627
29628 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29629
29630 The result data from this function should be a description of
29631 @var{group}.
29632
29633 @example
29634 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29635 name = <string>
29636 description = <text>
29637 @end example
29638
29639 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29640
29641 The result data from this function should be the description of all
29642 groups available on the server.
29643
29644 @example
29645 description-buffer = *description-line
29646 @end example
29647
29648
29649 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29650
29651 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29652 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29653 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29654 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29655 in the active buffer format.
29656
29657 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29658 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29659 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29660 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29661 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29662 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29663 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29664
29665
29666 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29667
29668 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29669
29670 There should be no return data.
29671
29672
29673 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29674
29675 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29676 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29677 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29678 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29679 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29680 they are.
29681
29682 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29683 able to delete.
29684
29685 There should be no result data returned.
29686
29687
29688 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29689
29690 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29691 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29692
29693 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29694 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29695 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29696 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29697 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29698 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29699
29700 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
29701 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
29702 optimizations.
29703
29704 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29705 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29706
29707 There should be no data returned.
29708
29709
29710 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
29711
29712 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
29713 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
29714 this function in short order.
29715
29716 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29717 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29718
29719 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
29720 article for that group.
29721
29722 There should be no data returned.
29723
29724
29725 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
29726
29727 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
29728 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
29729
29730 There should be no data returned.
29731
29732
29733 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
29734
29735 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
29736 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
29737 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
29738
29739 There should be no data returned.
29740
29741
29742 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
29743
29744 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
29745 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
29746
29747 There should be no data returned.
29748
29749 @end table
29750
29751
29752 @node Error Messaging
29753 @subsubsection Error Messaging
29754
29755 @findex nnheader-report
29756 @findex nnheader-get-report
29757 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
29758 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
29759 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
29760 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
29761 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
29762 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
29763
29764 @lisp
29765 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
29766
29767 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
29768 @end lisp
29769
29770 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
29771 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
29772 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
29773 takes one argument---the server symbol.
29774
29775 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
29776 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
29777 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
29778
29779
29780 @node Writing New Back Ends
29781 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
29782
29783 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
29784 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
29785 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
29786 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
29787 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
29788 editing articles.
29789
29790 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
29791 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
29792 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
29793
29794 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
29795 package called @code{nnoo}.
29796
29797 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
29798 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
29799 following macros:
29800
29801 @table @code
29802
29803 @item nnoo-declare
29804 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
29805 parameters. For instance:
29806
29807 @lisp
29808 (nnoo-declare nndir
29809 nnml nnmh)
29810 @end lisp
29811
29812 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
29813 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
29814
29815 @item defvoo
29816 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
29817 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
29818 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
29819
29820 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
29821 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
29822 a function in those back ends.
29823
29824 @lisp
29825 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29826 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29827 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29828 @end lisp
29829
29830 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
29831 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
29832 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
29833
29834 @item nnoo-define-basics
29835 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
29836 have.
29837
29838 @lisp
29839 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29840 @end lisp
29841
29842 @item deffoo
29843 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
29844 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
29845 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
29846
29847 @item nnoo-map-functions
29848 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
29849 functions from the parent back ends.
29850
29851 @lisp
29852 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29853 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29854 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
29855 @end lisp
29856
29857 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
29858 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
29859 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
29860 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
29861
29862 @item nnoo-import
29863 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
29864 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
29865 haven't already been defined.
29866
29867 @lisp
29868 (nnoo-import nndir
29869 (nnmh
29870 nnmh-request-list
29871 nnmh-request-newgroups)
29872 (nnml))
29873 @end lisp
29874
29875 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
29876 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
29877 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
29878 defined now.
29879
29880 @end table
29881
29882 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
29883
29884 @lisp
29885 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
29886 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
29887
29888 ;;; @r{Code:}
29889
29890 (require 'nnheader)
29891 (require 'nnmh)
29892 (require 'nnml)
29893 (require 'nnoo)
29894 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
29895
29896 (nnoo-declare nndir
29897 nnml nnmh)
29898
29899 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29900 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29901 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29902
29903 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
29904 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
29905 nnml-nov-is-evil)
29906
29907 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
29908 nil
29909 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
29910 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
29911 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
29912
29913 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
29914 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
29915
29916 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
29917
29918 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29919
29920 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
29921 (setq nndir-directory
29922 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
29923 server))
29924 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
29925 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
29926 (push `(nndir-current-group
29927 ,(file-name-nondirectory
29928 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29929 defs)
29930 (push `(nndir-top-directory
29931 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29932 defs)
29933 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
29934
29935 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29936 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29937 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29938 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
29939 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
29940
29941 (nnoo-import nndir
29942 (nnmh
29943 nnmh-status-message
29944 nnmh-request-list
29945 nnmh-request-newgroups))
29946
29947 (provide 'nndir)
29948 @end lisp
29949
29950
29951 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29952 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29953
29954 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
29955 @findex gnus-declare-backend
29956 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
29957 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
29958 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
29959
29960 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
29961 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
29962
29963 Here's an example:
29964
29965 @lisp
29966 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
29967 @end lisp
29968
29969 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
29970
29971 The abilities can be:
29972
29973 @table @code
29974 @item mail
29975 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
29976 @item post
29977 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
29978 @item post-mail
29979 This back end supports both mail and news.
29980 @item none
29981 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
29982 different.
29983 @item respool
29984 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
29985 articles and groups.
29986 @item address
29987 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
29988 true for almost all back ends.
29989 @item prompt-address
29990 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
29991 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
29992 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
29993 @end table
29994
29995
29996 @node Mail-like Back Ends
29997 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
29998
29999 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
30000 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
30001 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
30002 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
30003
30004 @lisp
30005 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
30006 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
30007 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
30008 @end lisp
30009
30010 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
30011 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
30012 mail.
30013
30014 This function takes four parameters.
30015
30016 @table @var
30017 @item method
30018 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
30019 the call.
30020
30021 @item exit-function
30022 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
30023
30024 @item temp-directory
30025 Where the temporary files should be stored.
30026
30027 @item group
30028 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
30029 performed for one group only.
30030 @end table
30031
30032 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
30033 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
30034 find the article number assigned to this article.
30035
30036 The function also uses the following variables:
30037 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
30038 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
30039 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
30040 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
30041 this:
30042
30043 @example
30044 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
30045 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
30046 @end example
30047
30048
30049 @node Score File Syntax
30050 @subsection Score File Syntax
30051
30052 Score files are meant to be easily parsable, but yet extremely
30053 malleable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
30054 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
30055
30056 Here's a typical score file:
30057
30058 @lisp
30059 (("summary"
30060 ("Windows 95" -10000 nil s)
30061 ("Gnus"))
30062 ("from"
30063 ("Lars" -1000))
30064 (mark -100))
30065 @end lisp
30066
30067 BNF definition of a score file:
30068
30069 @example
30070 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
30071 element = rule / atom
30072 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
30073 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
30074 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
30075 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
30076 quote = <ascii 34>
30077 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
30078 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
30079 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
30080 date-header = "date"
30081 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30082 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30083 score = "nil" / <integer>
30084 date = "nil" / <natural number>
30085 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
30086 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
30087 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
30088 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
30089 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30090 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30091 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
30092 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30093 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
30094 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
30095 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
30096 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
30097 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30098 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30099 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30100 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30101 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30102 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30103 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30104 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30105 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30106 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30107 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30108 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30109 eval = "eval" space <form>
30110 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30111 @end example
30112
30113 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30114 discarded.
30115
30116 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30117 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30118 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30119 one looong line, then that's ok.
30120
30121 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30122 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30123
30124
30125 @node Headers
30126 @subsection Headers
30127
30128 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30129 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30130 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30131 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30132
30133 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30134 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30135 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30136 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30137 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30138 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30139 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30140
30141 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30142 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30143 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30144 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30145 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30146
30147 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30148 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30149
30150
30151 @node Ranges
30152 @subsection Ranges
30153
30154 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30155 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30156
30157 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30158 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30159 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30160 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30161
30162 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30163 sequence.
30164
30165 @example
30166 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30167 @end example
30168
30169 is transformed into
30170
30171 @example
30172 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30173 @end example
30174
30175 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30176 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30177
30178 @example
30179 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30180 @end example
30181
30182 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30183 is slightly tricky:
30184
30185 @example
30186 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30187 @end example
30188
30189 and
30190
30191 @example
30192 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30193 @end example
30194
30195 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30196
30197 @example
30198 (1 2 3 4 5)
30199 @end example
30200
30201 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30202 also valid:
30203
30204 @example
30205 (1 . 5)
30206 @end example
30207
30208 and is equal to the previous range.
30209
30210 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30211 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30212 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30213 range handling.)
30214
30215 @example
30216 range = simple-range / normal-range
30217 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30218 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30219 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30220 number *[ " " contents ]
30221 @end example
30222
30223 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30224 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30225 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30226 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30227 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30228 sequences.)
30229
30230
30231 @node Group Info
30232 @subsection Group Info
30233
30234 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30235 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30236 describes the group.
30237
30238 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30239 second is a more complex one:
30240
30241 @example
30242 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30243
30244 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30245 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30246 (nnml "")
30247 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30248 @end example
30249
30250 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30251 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30252 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30253 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30254 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30255 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30256 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30257 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30258 this section is about.
30259
30260 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30261 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30262 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30263
30264 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30265
30266 @example
30267 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30268 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30269 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30270 group = quote <string> quote
30271 ralevel = rank / level
30272 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30273 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30274 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30275 read = range
30276 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30277 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30278 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30279 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30280 @end example
30281
30282 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30283 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30284 in pseudo-BNF.
30285
30286 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30287 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30288
30289 @table @code
30290 @item gnus-info-group
30291 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
30292 @findex gnus-info-group
30293 @findex gnus-info-set-group
30294 Get/set the group name.
30295
30296 @item gnus-info-rank
30297 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30298 @findex gnus-info-rank
30299 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
30300 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30301
30302 @item gnus-info-level
30303 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
30304 @findex gnus-info-level
30305 @findex gnus-info-set-level
30306 Get/set the group level.
30307
30308 @item gnus-info-score
30309 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
30310 @findex gnus-info-score
30311 @findex gnus-info-set-score
30312 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30313
30314 @item gnus-info-read
30315 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
30316 @findex gnus-info-read
30317 @findex gnus-info-set-read
30318 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30319
30320 @item gnus-info-marks
30321 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30322 @findex gnus-info-marks
30323 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
30324 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30325
30326 @item gnus-info-method
30327 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
30328 @findex gnus-info-method
30329 @findex gnus-info-set-method
30330 Get/set the group select method.
30331
30332 @item gnus-info-params
30333 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
30334 @findex gnus-info-params
30335 @findex gnus-info-set-params
30336 Get/set the group parameters.
30337 @end table
30338
30339 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30340 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30341
30342 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30343 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30344 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30345 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30346
30347
30348 @node Extended Interactive
30349 @subsection Extended Interactive
30350 @cindex interactive
30351 @findex gnus-interactive
30352
30353 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30354 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30355 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30356
30357 @lisp
30358 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30359 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30360 ...
30361 )
30362 @end lisp
30363
30364 The best thing to do would have been to implement
30365 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30366 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30367 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30368 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30369 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30370 @code{interactive}.
30371
30372 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30373 adds a few more.
30374
30375 @table @samp
30376 @item y
30377 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30378 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30379 variable.
30380
30381 @item Y
30382 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30383 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30384 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30385
30386 @item A
30387 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30388 function.
30389
30390 @item H
30391 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30392 function.
30393
30394 @item g
30395 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30396 function.
30397
30398 @end table
30399
30400
30401 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30402 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30403 @cindex XEmacs
30404 @cindex Emacsen
30405
30406 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30407 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30408 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30409
30410 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30411 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30412 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30413 Gnus, that's very useful.
30414
30415 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30416 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30417 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30418 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30419 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30420 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30421 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30422 following function:
30423
30424 @lisp
30425 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30426 (start-itimer
30427 "gnus-run-at-time"
30428 `(lambda ()
30429 (,function ,@@args))
30430 time repeat))
30431 @end lisp
30432
30433 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30434 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30435 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30436 all over.
30437
30438 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30439 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30440 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30441
30442 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30443 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30444 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30445
30446
30447 @node Various File Formats
30448 @subsection Various File Formats
30449
30450 @menu
30451 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30452 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30453 @end menu
30454
30455
30456 @node Active File Format
30457 @subsubsection Active File Format
30458
30459 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30460 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30461 in each group.
30462
30463 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30464
30465 @example
30466 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30467 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30468 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30469 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30470 no.general 1000 900 y
30471 @end example
30472
30473 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30474
30475 @example
30476 active = *group-line
30477 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30478 group = <non-white-space string>
30479 spc = " "
30480 high-number = <non-negative integer>
30481 low-number = <positive integer>
30482 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30483 @end example
30484
30485 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30486 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30487
30488
30489 @node Newsgroups File Format
30490 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30491
30492 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30493 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30494 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30495 the user.
30496
30497 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30498 Here's the definition:
30499
30500 @example
30501 newsgroups = *line
30502 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30503 group = <non-white-space string>
30504 tab = <TAB>
30505 description = <string>
30506 @end example
30507
30508
30509 @page
30510 @node Emacs for Heathens
30511 @section Emacs for Heathens
30512
30513 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30514 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30515 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30516 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30517 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30518 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30519 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30520 cat instead.
30521
30522 @menu
30523 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30524 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30525 @end menu
30526
30527
30528 @node Keystrokes
30529 @subsection Keystrokes
30530
30531 @itemize @bullet
30532 @item
30533 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30534
30535 @item
30536 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30537 @end itemize
30538
30539 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30540 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30541 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30542 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30543 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30544 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30545
30546 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30547 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30548 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30549 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30550 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30551 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30552 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30553
30554 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30555 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30556 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30557 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30558 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30559 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30560 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30561
30562 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30563 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30564 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30565 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30566 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30567 it.
30568
30569
30570
30571 @node Emacs Lisp
30572 @subsection Emacs Lisp
30573
30574 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30575 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30576 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30577 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30578
30579 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30580 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30581 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30582 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30583 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30584 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30585 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30586 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30587 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30588 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30589
30590 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30591 write the following:
30592
30593 @lisp
30594 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30595 @end lisp
30596
30597 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30598 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30599 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30600 change how Gnus works.
30601
30602 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30603 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30604 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30605 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30606 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30607
30608 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30609 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30610 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30611
30612 Some pitfalls:
30613
30614 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30615 that means:
30616
30617 @lisp
30618 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30619 @end lisp
30620
30621 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server-file} to
30622 @samp{/etc/nntpserver}'', that means:
30623
30624 @lisp
30625 (setq gnus-nntp-server-file "/etc/nntpserver")
30626 @end lisp
30627
30628 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30629 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30630
30631 @page
30632 @include gnus-faq.texi
30633
30634 @node GNU Free Documentation License
30635 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30636 @include doclicense.texi
30637
30638 @node Index
30639 @chapter Index
30640 @printindex cp
30641
30642 @node Key Index
30643 @chapter Key Index
30644 @printindex ky
30645
30646 @bye
30647
30648 @iftex
30649 @iflatex
30650 \end{document}
30651 @end iflatex
30652 @end iftex
30653
30654 @c Local Variables:
30655 @c mode: texinfo
30656 @c coding: utf-8
30657 @c End: